Sie sind auf Seite 1von 360

VOLVO XC60

Owner's Manual Web Edition


Welcome to the world-wide family of Volvo owners. We trust that you vehicle if you may be affected by alcohol, medication or any impair-
will enjoy many years of safe driving in your Volvo, an automobile ment that could hinder your ability to drive.
designed with your safety and comfort in mind. We encourage you
Your Volvo is designed to meet all applicable federal safety and
to familiarize yourself with the equipment descriptions and operating
emission standards. If you have any questions regarding your vehicle,
instructions in this manual.
please contact your Volvo retailer or see the section "Contacting
We also urge you and your passengers to wear seat belts at all times Volvo" in this manual's "Introduction" chapter for information on get-
in this (or any other) vehicle. And, of course, please do not operate a ting in touch with Volvo in the United States and Canada.
Contents

00 01 02
00 Introduction 01 Safety 02 Locks and alarm
Important information................................. 8 Occupant safety........................................ 16 Remote key and key blade....................... 56
Environment.............................................. 12 Reporting safety defects........................... 17 Keyless drive............................................. 63
Important warnings................................... 13 Seat belts ................................................. 18 Locks........................................................ 66
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) .... 21 Alarm......................................................... 69
Occupant Weight Sensor ......................... 26
Side impact protection (SIPS) airbags ..... 30
Inflatable Curtain (IC) ............................... 32
Whiplash Protection System – WHIPS..... 33
Rollover Protection System (ROPS) ......... 35
Crash mode.............................................. 36
Child safety............................................... 37
Child restraint systems............................. 39
Infant seats............................................... 41
Convertible seats...................................... 43
Booster cushions...................................... 45
ISOFIX/LATCH lower anchors.................. 46
Top tether anchors.................................... 47
Child restraint registration and recalls...... 48
Integrated booster cushion....................... 49
Child safety locks...................................... 52

4
Contents

03 04 05
03 Your driving environment 04 Comfort and driving pleasure 05 Infotainment
Instruments and controls.......................... 74 Menus and messages............................. 126 Introduction............................................. 200
Ignition modes.......................................... 81 The MY CAR menus............................... 128 Getting started ....................................... 202
Seats......................................................... 82 Climate system....................................... 134 General infotainment functions .............. 207
Steering wheel.......................................... 88 Trip computer......................................... 142 Radio....................................................... 210
Lighting..................................................... 89 Stability system....................................... 144 Media player........................................... 219
Wipers and washers................................. 95 Active chassis system–Four C*............... 146 AUX/USB sockets................................... 223
Power windows......................................... 98 Cruise control.......................................... 147 BluetoothŸ media ................................... 226
Mirrors..................................................... 100 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)*.............. 149 Bluetooth® hands-free connection ........ 229
Compass*............................................... 102 Distance Alert* ....................................... 159 Cell phone voice control......................... 237
Laminated panoramic roof*.................... 103 City Safety™ .......................................... 162 Infotainment system menus ................... 241
HomeLink® Wireless Control System*... 106 Collision warning with Full Auto-brake and
Starting the engine.................................. 109 Pedestrian Detection*............................. 168
Transmission........................................... 112 Driver Alert System* ............................... 175
Brakes..................................................... 115 Park assist*............................................. 181
Parking brake.......................................... 118 Rear Park Assist Camera (PAC)* ............ 185
Hill Descent Control (HDC)*.................... 121 Blind Spot Information System*.............. 189
Passenger compartment convenience... 193

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 5


Contents

06 07 08
06 During your trip 07 Wheels and tires 08 Maintenance and
Driving recommendations....................... 246 General information ............................... 270 specifications
Refueling................................................. 250 Tire inflation............................................. 273 Volvo maintenance.................................. 300
Loading................................................... 255 Inflation pressure—U.S. models ............ 275 Maintaining your car............................... 301
Cargo area ............................................. 259 Inflation pressure—Canadian models..... 276 Hood and engine compartment.............. 303
Towing a trailer....................................... 262 Tire designations .................................... 277 Engine oil................................................ 304
Emergency towing.................................. 265 Glossary of tire terminology ................... 279 Fluids...................................................... 306
Vehicle loading ....................................... 280 Replacing bulbs...................................... 308
Uniform Tire Quality Grading ................. 282 Wiper blades and washer fluid................ 315
Snow chains, snow tires, studded tires . 283 Battery..................................................... 317
Temporary Spare ................................... 284 Fuses...................................................... 320
Tire Sealing System................................ 285 Vehicle care............................................. 328
Changing a wheel .................................. 291
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) 294

6
Contents

09 10
09 Specifications 10 Index
Label information.................................... 336 Index....................................................... 350
Specifications......................................... 338
Overview of information and warning sym-
bols......................................................... 345
Volvo programs....................................... 348

7
Introduction

Important information

Contacting Volvo About this manual Decals


In the USA: There are various types of decals in the vehicle
• Before you operate your vehicle for the first whose purpose is to provide important infor-
Volvo Cars of North America, LLC time, please familiarize yourself with the
mation in a clear and concise way. The impor-
information found in the chapters "Your
Customer Care Center tance of these decals is explained as follows,
Driving Environment" and "During Your
in descending order of importance.
1 Volvo Drive, Trip."
P.O. Box 914 • Information contained in the balance of the Risk of injury
manual is extremely useful and should be
Rockleigh, New Jersey 07647 read after operating the vehicle for the first
1-800-458-1552 time.

www.volvocars.us • The manual is structured so that it can be


used for reference. For this reason, it
In Canada: should be kept in the vehicle for ready
access.
Volvo Cars of Canada Corp
Footnotes
National Customer Service Certain pages of this manual contain informa-
175 Gordon Baker Road tion in the form of footnotes at the bottom of
the page. This information supplements the
North York, Ontario M2H 2N7 text that the footnote number refers to (a letter
1-800-663-8255 is used if the footnote refers to text in a table).
G031590

www.volvocanada.com Display texts


There are several displays in the driver’s field Black ISO symbols on a yellow warning back-
of vision that show messages generated by ground, white text/image on a black back-
various systems and functions in the vehicle. ground. Decals of this type are used to indicate
These texts are indicated in the Owner’s Man- potential danger. Ignoring a warning of this
ual by being in slightly larger type than the sur- type could result in serious injury or death.
rounding text and are printed in gray, (for
example: Doors automatic lock).

8
Introduction

Important information

Risk of damage to the vehicle Information Types of lists used in the manual
Procedures
Procedures (step-by-step instructions), or
actions that must be carried out in a certain
order, are arranged in numbered lists in this
manual.
If there is a series of illustrations associated
with step-by-step instructions, each step
in the procedure is numbered in the same
way as the corresponding illustration.
Lists in which letters are used can be found
with series of illustrations in cases where
G031592

G031593
the order in which the instructions are car-
ried out is not important.
Arrows with or without numbers are used
White ISO symbols and white text/image on a White ISO symbols and white text/image on a
to indicate the direction of a movement.
black or blue warning background and space black background. These decals provide gen-
for a message. If the information on decals of eral information. If there are no illustrations associated with a
this type is ignored, damage to the vehicle step-by-step list, the steps in the procedure
could result. NOTE are indicated by ordinary numbers.
Position lists
The decals shown in the Owner’s Manual
are examples only and are not intended to Red circles containing a number are used
be reproductions of the decals actually used in general overview illustrations in which
in the vehicle. The purpose is to give an indi- certain components are pointed out. The
cation of how they look and their approxi- corresponding number is also used in the
mate location in the vehicle. The applicable position list's description of the various
information for your particular vehicle can components.
be found on the respective decals in the
vehicle.

9
Introduction

Important information

Bullet lists NOTE WARNING


Bullets are used to differentiate a number of
components/functions/points of information • All information, illustrations and specifi- CALIFORNIA proposition 65
that can be listed in random order. cations contained in this manual are Engine exhaust, some of its constituents,
based on the latest product information and certain vehicle components contain or
For example: available at the time of publication. emit chemicals known to the state of Cali-
• Coolant • Volvo reserves the right to make model fornia to cause cancer, and birth defects or
changes at any time, or to change spec- other reproductive harm. In addition, certain
• Engine oil ifications or design without notice and fluids contained in vehicles and certain
products of component wear contain or
Continued without incurring obligation.
emit chemicals known to the State of Cali-
` `This symbol can be found at the lower right • Do not export your Volvo to another fornia to cause cancer, and birth defects or
corner of an odd-numbered (right-hand) page country before investigating that coun- other reproductive harm.
to indicate that the current topic is continued try's applicable safety and emission
on the following page. control requirements. In some cases it
may be difficult or impossible to comply WARNING
Options and accessories with these requirements. Modifications Certain components of this vehicle such as
Optional or accessory equipment described in to the emission control system(s) may air bag modules, seat belt pretensioners,
this manual is indicated by an asterisk. render your Volvo not certifiable for adaptive steering columns, and button cell
legal operation in the U.S., Canada and batteries may contain Perchlorate material.
Optional or accessory equipment may not be Special handling may apply for service or
other countries.
available in all countries or markets. Please vehicle end of life disposal.
note that some vehicles may be equipped dif-
See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/
ferently, depending on special legal require- WARNING perchlorate.
ments.
If your vehicle is involved in an accident,
Contact your Volvo retailer for additional infor- unseen damage may affect its drivability
mation. and safety.

10
Introduction

Important information

Shiftlock Points to keep in mind Vehicle event data (Black box)


When your vehicle is parked, the gear selector • Do not export your Volvo to another coun- Your vehicle's driving and safety systems
is locked in the P (Park) position. To release the try before investigating that country's employ computers that monitor, and share
selector from this position, the ignition must be applicable safety and exhaust emission with each other, information about your vehi-
in mode II (see page 81) or the engine must requirements. In some cases it may be dif- cle's operation. One or more of these comput-
be running. Depress the brake pedal, press the ficult or impossible to comply with these ers may store what they monitor, either during
button on the front side of the gear selector and requirements. Modifications to the emis- normal vehicle operation or in a crash or near-
move the selector from P (Park). sion control system(s) may render your
crash event. Stored information may be read
Volvo not certifiable for legal operation in
and used by:
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) the U.S., Canada and other countries.
The ABS system performs a brief self-diagnos- • All information, illustrations and specifica- • Volvo Car Corporation
tic test when the engine has been started and tions contained in this manual are based on • service and repair facilities
driver releases the brake pedal. Another auto- the latest product information available at • law enforcement or government agencies
matic test may be performed when the vehicle the time of publication. Please note that
first reaches a speed of approximately 6 mph some vehicles may be equipped differ- • others who may assert a legal right to
ently, depending on special legal require- know, or who obtain your consent to know
(10 km/h). The brake pedal will pulsate several
ments. Optional equipment described in such information.
times and a sound may be audible from the
ABS control module. This is normal. this manual may not be available in all mar-
kets.
Fuel filler door • Volvo reserves the right to make model
Press the button on the light switch panel (see changes at any time, or to change specifi-
the illustration on page 252) when the vehicle cations or design without notice and with-
is at a standstill to unlock the fuel filler door. out incurring obligation.
Please note that the fuel filler door will remain
unlocked until the vehicle begins to move for-
ward. An audible click will be heard when the
fuel filler door relocks.

Fuel filler cap


The fuel filler door, located on the right rear
quarter panel, is connected to your vehicle's
central locking system.

11
Introduction

Environment

Volvo and the environment continuous environmental refinement of con- Recycling


Volvo is committed to the well being of its cus- ventional gasoline-powered internal combus- As part of Volvo’s commitment to the environ-
tomers. As a natural part of this commitment, tion engines, Volvo is actively looking at ment, it is essential for the vehicle to be recy-
we care about the environment in which we all advanced technology alternative-fuel vehicles. cled in an environmentally sound way. Almost
live. Caring for the environment means an the entire vehicle can be recycled and for that
everyday involvement in reducing our environ- When you drive a Volvo, you become our part- reason, the vehicle’s final owner is requested
mental impact. Volvo's environmental activities ner in the work to lessen the car's impact on to contact a Volvo retailer for information about
are based on a holistic view, which means we the environment. To reduce your vehicle's approved and certified recycling facilities.
consider the overall environmental impact of a environmental impact, you can:
product throughout its complete life cycle. In • Maintain proper air pressure in your tires.
this context, design, production, product use, Tests have shown decreased fuel econ-
and recycling are all important considerations. omy with improperly inflated tires.
In production, Volvo has partly or completely • Follow the recommended maintenance
phased out several chemicals including CFCs, schedule in your Warranty and Service
lead chromates, asbestos, and cadmium; and Records Information booklet.
reduced the number of chemicals used in our
plants 50% since 1991.
• Drive at a constant speed whenever pos-
sible.
Volvo was the first in the world to introduce into • See a trained and qualified Volvo service
production a three-way catalytic converter with technician as soon as possible for inspec-
a Lambda sond, now called the heated oxygen tion if the check engine (malfunction indi-
sensor, in 1976. The current version of this cator) light illuminates, or stays on after the
highly efficient system reduces emissions of vehicle has started.
harmful substances (CO, HC, NOx) from the • Properly dispose of any vehicle-related
exhaust pipe by approximately 95 – 99% and waste such as used motor oil, used batter-
the search to eliminate the remaining emis- ies, brake pads, etc.
sions continues. Volvo is the only automobile
manufacturer to offer CFC-free retrofit kits for
• When cleaning your vehicle, please use
genuine Volvo car care products. All Volvo
the air conditioning system of all models as far
car care products are formulated to be
back as the 1975 model 240. Advanced elec- environmentally friendly.
tronic engine controls and cleaner fuels are
bringing us closer to our goal. In addition to

12
Introduction

Important warnings

Driver distraction cellular telephone use by a driver while the • Accessories that have not been approved
A driver has a responsibility to do everything vehicle is moving. by Volvo may or may not be specifically
possible to ensure his or her own safety and • If your vehicle is equipped with a naviga- tested for compatibility with your vehicle.
the safety of passengers in the vehicle and oth- tion system, set and make changes to your Additionally, an inexperienced installer
travel itinerary only with the vehicle parked. may not be familiar with some of your car's
ers sharing the roadway. Avoiding distractions
systems.
is part of that responsibility. • Never program your audio system while
the vehicle is moving. Program radio pre- • Any of your car's performance and safety
Driver distraction results from driver activities systems could be adversely affected if you
that are not directly related to controlling the sets with the vehicle parked, and use your
programmed presets to make radio use install accessories that Volvo has not tes-
vehicle in the driving environment. Your new ted, or if you allow accessories to be instal-
quicker and simpler.
Volvo is, or can be, equipped with many fea- led by someone unfamiliar with your vehi-
ture-rich entertainment and communication • Never use portable computers or personal cle.
systems. These include hands-free cellular tel- digital assistants while the vehicle is mov-
ephones, navigation systems, and multipur- ing. • Damage caused by unapproved or
improperly installed accessories may not
pose audio systems. You may also own other be covered by your new vehicle warranty.
portable electronic devices for your own con- Accessory installation See your Warranty and Service Records
venience. When used properly and safely, they • We strongly recommend that Volvo owners Information booklet for more warranty
enrich the driving experience. Improperly used, install only genuine, Volvo-approved information. Volvo assumes no responsi-
any of these could cause a distraction. accessories, and that accessory installa- bility for death, injury, or expenses that
For all of these systems, we want to provide the tions be performed only by a trained and may result from the installation of non-gen-
following warning that reflects the strong Volvo qualified Volvo service technician. uine accessories.
concern for your safety. Never use these devi- • Genuine Volvo accessories are tested to
ces or any feature of your vehicle in a way that ensure compatibility with the performance,
distracts you from the task of driving safely. safety, and emission systems in your vehi-
Distraction can lead to a serious accident. In cle. Additionally, a trained and qualified
addition to this general warning, we offer the Volvo service technician knows where
following guidance regarding specific newer accessories may and may not be safely
features that may be found in your vehicle: installed in your Volvo. In all cases, please
consult a trained and qualified Volvo serv-
• Never use a hand-held cellular telephone ice technician before installing any acces-
while driving. Some jurisdictions prohibit sory in or on your vehicle.

13
Occupant safety...................................................................................... 16
Reporting safety defects......................................................................... 17
Seat belts ............................................................................................... 18
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) ................................................... 21
Occupant Weight Sensor ....................................................................... 26
Side impact protection (SIPS) airbags ................................................... 30
Inflatable Curtain (IC) ............................................................................. 32
Whiplash Protection System – WHIPS................................................... 33
Rollover Protection System (ROPS) ....................................................... 35
Crash mode............................................................................................ 36
Child safety............................................................................................. 37
Child restraint systems........................................................................... 39
Infant seats.............................................................................................. 41
Convertible seats.................................................................................... 43
Booster cushions.................................................................................... 45
ISOFIX/LATCH lower anchors................................................................. 46
Top tether anchors.................................................................................. 47
Child restraint registration and recalls.................................................... 48
Integrated booster cushion..................................................................... 49
Child safety locks.................................................................................... 52

14
SAFETY
01 Safety

01 Occupant safety

Volvo's concern for safety • Never drink and drive.


Safety is Volvo's cornerstone. Our concern • If you are taking any medication, consult
dates back to 1927 when the first Volvo rolled your physician about its potential effects
off the production line. Three-point seat belts on your driving abilities.
(a Volvo invention), safety cages, and energy- • Take a driver-retraining course.
absorbing impact zones were designed into
Volvo vehicles long before it was fashionable
• Have your eyes checked regularly.
or required by government regulation. • Keep your windshield and headlights
clean.
We will not compromize our commitment to
safety. We continue to seek out new safety
• Replace wiper blades when they start to
leave streaks.
features and to refine those already in our vehi-
cles. You can help. We would appreciate hear- • Take into account the traffic, road, and
ing your suggestions about improving automo- weather conditions, particularly with
bile safety. We also want to know if you ever regard to stopping distance.
have a safety concern with your vehicle. Call us
in the U.S. at: 1-800-458-1552 or in Canada at:
1-800-663-8255.

Occupant safety reminders


How safely you drive doesn't depend on how
old you are but rather on:
• How well you see.
• Your ability to concentrate.
• How quickly you make decisions under
stress to avoid an accident.
The following suggestions are intended to help
you cope with the ever changing traffic envi-
ronment.

16
01 Safety

Reporting safety defects 01

Reporting safety defects in the U.S. http://www.safercar.gov Reporting safety defects in Canada
If you believe that your vehicle has a If you believe your vehicle has a defect that
Volvo strongly recommends that if could cause a crash or could cause injury or
defect which could cause a crash or your vehicle is covered under a serv- death, you should immediately inform Trans-
could cause injury or death, you ice campaign, safety or emission port Canada in addition to notifying Volvo Cars
should immediately inform the recall or similar action, it should be of Canada Corp.
National Highway Traffic Safety completed as soon as possible. To contact Transport Canada, call
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to Please check with your local retailer (800) 333 – 0510, or (613) 993 – 9851 if you are
notifying Volvo Cars of North Amer- or Volvo Cars of North America, LLC calling from the Ottawa region.
ica, LLC. If NHTSA receives similar if your vehicle is covered under these
complaints, it may open an investiga- conditions.
tion, and if it finds that a safety defect
exists in a group of vehicles, it may NHTSA can be reached at:
order a recall and remedy campaign. Internet:
However, NHTSA cannot become
http://www.nhtsa.gov
involved in individual problems
between you, your retailer, or Volvo Telephone:
Cars of North America, LLC. To con- 1-888-DASH-2-DOT
tact NHTSA, you may either call the (1-888-327-4236).
Auto Safety Hotline toll-free at
1-888-327-4236
(TTY: 1-800-424-9153) or write to:
NHTSA, U.S. Department of Trans-
portation, Washington D.C. 20590.
You can also obtain other information
about motor vehicle safety from:

17
01 Safety

01 Seat belts

General information in the event of a collision, limits the peak forces NOTE
exerted by the seat belt on the occupant.
Each seat belt (except for the driver's belt)
Fastening a seat belt is equipped with the ALR/ELR function,
which is designed to help keep the seat belt
Buckling taut. ALR/ELR activates if the seat belt is
Pull the belt out far enough to insert the latch pulled out as far as possible. If this is done,
plate into the receptacle until a distinct click is a sound from the seat belt retractor will be
heard. The seat belt retractor is normally audible, which is normal, and the seat belt
"unlocked" and you can move freely, provided will be pulled taut and locked in place. This
that the shoulder belt is not pulled out too far. function is automatically disabled when the
seat belt is unbuckled and fully retracted.
Seat belt retractor
The seat belt retractor will lock up in the fol-
See also page 38 for information about using
lowing situations:
Adjusting the seat belt a seat belt's ALR/ELR function to anchor a
• if the belt is pulled out rapidly child seat.
Seat belts should always be worn by all occu- • during braking and acceleration
pants of your vehicle. Children should be prop- When wearing the seat belt remember:
erly restrained, using an infant, car, or booster • if the vehicle is leaning excessively • The belt should not be twisted or turned.
seat determined by age, weight and height. • when driving in turns • The lap section of the belt must be posi-
Volvo also believes no child should sit in the • if the Automatic Locking Retractor/Emer- tioned low on the hips (not pressing against
gency Locking Retractor (ALR/ELR) is acti- the abdomen).
front seat of a vehicle.
vated • Make sure that the shoulder belt is rolled
Most states and provinces make it mandatory up into its retractor and that the shoulder
for occupants of a vehicle to use seat belts. and lap belts are taut.
Seat belt pretensioners Unbuckling the seat belt
All seat belts are equipped with pretensioners To remove the seat belt, press the red section
that reduce slack in the belts. These preten- on the seat belt receptacle. Before exiting the
sioners are triggered in situations where the vehicle, check that the seat belt retracts fully
front or side impact airbags deploy, and in cer- after being unbuckled. If necessary, guide the
tain impacts from the rear. The front seat belts belt back into the retractor slot.
also include a tension reducing device which,

18
01 Safety

Seat belts 01

Seat belt maintenance WARNING Seat belt reminder


Check periodically that the seat belts are in
good condition. Use water and a mild deter- • Never repair the belt yourself; have this
gent for cleaning. Check seat belt mechanism work done by a trained and qualified
Volvo service technician only.
function as follows: attach the seat belt and pull
rapidly on the strap. • Any device used to induce slack into the
shoulder belt portion of the three-point
belt system will have a detrimental
WARNING
effect on the amount of protection avail-
Never use a seat belt for more than one able to you in the event of a collision.
occupant. Never wear the shoulder portion
of the belt under the arm, behind the back • The seat back should not be tilted too

G017726
or otherwise out of position. Such use could far back. The shoulder belt must be taut
cause injury in the event of an accident. As in order to function properly.
seat belts lose much of their strength when • Do not use child safety seats or child Seat belt reminder light in ceiling console
exposed to violent stretching, they should booster cushions/backrests in the front
be replaced after any collision, even if they The seat belt reminder consists of an audible
passenger's seat. We also recommend
appear to be undamaged. that children who have outgrown these signal, an indicator light near the rearview mir-
devices sit in the rear seat with the seat ror and a symbol in the instrument panel that
belt properly fastened. alert all occupants of the vehicle to fasten their
seat belts. The audible signal and indicator
light will be on for a total of 6 seconds from the
time the ignition is switched on, regardless of
whether or not the seat belts are fastened.

If the front seat belts are unbuckled while the


vehicle is in motion, the audible signal and
warning light will be active for a total of 6 sec-
onds.

Rear seats
The seat belt reminder in the rear seat has two
additional functions:

``

19
01 Safety

01 Seat belts

• It provides information about which seat Seat belt use during pregnancy a distance as possible between their belly and
belts are fastened in the rear seat. A mes- the steering wheel.
sage will appear in the information display
when a belt is being used. This message Child seats
will disappear after approximately 6 sec- Please refer to page 39 for information on
onds or can be erased by pressing the securing child seats with the seat belts.
READ button on the left steering wheel
lever.
• It also provides a reminder if one of the
occupants of the rear seat has unbuckled
his/her seat belt while the vehicle is in
motion. A visual and audible signal will be

G020998
given. These signals will stop when the
seat belt has been re-buckled or can be
stopped by pressing the READ button. The seat belt should always be worn during
• The message Unbelted in rear seat will pregnancy. But it is crucial that it be worn in the
appear in the information display if one of correct way. The diagonal section should wrap
the rear doors has been opened. over the shoulder then be routed between the
The message in the information display can breasts and to the side of the belly. The lap
always be accessed, even if it has been erased, section should lay flat over the thighs and as
by pressing the READ button to display stored low as possible under the belly. It must never
messages. be allowed to ride upward. Remove all slack
from the belt and ensure that it fits close to the
body without any twists.
As a pregnancy progresses, pregnant drivers
should adjust their seats and steering wheel
such that they can easily maintain control of the
vehicle as they drive (which means they must
be able to easily operate the foot pedals and
steering wheel). Within this context, they
should strive to position the seat with as large

20
01 Safety

Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) 01

General information properly, the general warning symbol illumi- WARNING


nates and a text message will be displayed.
See also page 76 and page 78 for more If your vehicle has been subjected to flood
information about indicator and warning sym- conditions (e.g., soaked carpeting/standing
water on the floor of the vehicle) or if your
bols. vehicle has become flood-damaged in any
way, do not attempt to start the vehicle or
WARNING insert the remote key into the ignition slot
before disconnecting the battery (see
• If the SRS warning light stays on after below). This may cause airbag deployment
the engine has started or if it illuminates which could result in personal injury. Have
while you are driving, have the vehicle the vehicle towed to a trained and qualified
inspected by a trained and qualified Volvo service technician for repairs.
Volvo service technician as soon as
Automatic transmission:
possible.
Warning symbols in the instrument panel Before attempting to tow the vehicle:
• Never try to repair any component or
As an enhancement to the three-point seat part of the SRS yourself. Any interfer- 1. Switch off the ignition for at least
belts, your Volvo is equipped with a Supple- ence in the system could cause mal- 10 minutes and disconnect the battery.
mental Restraint System (SRS). Volvo's SRS function and serious injury. All work on 2. Follow the instructions for manually
these systems should be performed by overriding the shiftlock system on page
consists of seat belt pretensioners, front air-
a trained and qualified Volvo service 113.
bags, side impact airbags, a front passenger
technician.
occupant weight sensor, and inflatable cur-
tains. All of these systems are monitored by the
SRS control module. An SRS warning light in
the instrument panel (see the illustration) illu-
minates when the ignition is in modes I, II, or
III, and will normally go out after approximately
6 seconds if no faults are detected in the sys-
tem.
Where applicable, a text message will also be
displayed when the SRS warning light illumi-
nates. If this warning symbol is not functioning

``

21
01 Safety

01 Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)

Front airbags The passenger's side front airbag is folded


behind a panel located above the glove com-
partment.

WARNING
• The airbags in the vehicle are designed
to be a SUPPLEMENT to–not a replace-
ment for–the three-point seat belts. For
maximum protection, wear seat belts at
all times. Be aware that no system can
prevent all possible injuries that may
G018665
occur in an accident.
Location of the passenger's side front airbag
• Never drive with your hands on the
As the movement of the seats' occupants com- steering wheel pad/airbag housing.
The front airbag system presses the airbags, some of the gas is expel-
The front airbags supplement the three-point led at a controlled rate to provide better cush-
• The front airbags are designed to help
seat belts. For these airbags to provide the prevent serious injury. Deployment
ioning. Both seat belt pretensioners also occurs very quickly and with consider-
protection intended, seat belts must be worn deploy, minimizing seat belt slack. The entire able force. During normal deployment
at all times. process, including inflation and deflation of the and depending on variables such as
The front airbag system includes gas genera- airbags, takes approximately one fifth of a sec- seating position, one may experience
tors surrounded by the airbags, and decelera- ond. abrasions, bruises, swellings, or other
tion sensors that activate the gas generators, The location of the front airbags is indicated by injuries as a result from deployment of
causing the airbags to be inflated with nitrogen SRS AIRBAG embossed on the steering wheel one or both of the airbags.
gas. pad and above the glove compartment, and by • When installing any accessory equip-
decals on both sun visors and on the front and ment, make sure that the front airbag
far right side of the dash. system is not damaged. Any interfer-
ence in the system could cause mal-
The driver's side front airbag is folded and function.
located in the steering wheel hub.

22
01 Safety

Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) 01

Front airbag deployment WARNING Rockleigh, New Jersey 07647


• The front airbags are designed to deploy 1-800-458-1552
during certain frontal or front-angular col- • Do not use child safety seats or child
lisions, impacts, or decelerations, depend- booster cushions/backrests in the front www.volvocars.us
ing on the crash severity, angle, speed and passenger's seat. We also recommend
that occupants under 4 feet 7 inches In Canada
object impacted. The airbags may also
deploy in certain non-frontal collisions (140 cm) in height who have outgrown Volvo Cars of Canada Corp.
where rapid deceleration occurs. these devices sit in the rear seat with the
seat belt fastened1. National Customer Service
• The SRS sensors, which trigger the front 175 Gordon Baker Road
airbags, are designed to react to both the • Never drive with the airbags deployed.
impact of the collision and the inertial The fact that they hang out can impair North York, Ontario M2H 2N7
forces generated by it, and to determine if the steering of your vehicle. Other
the intensity of the collision is sufficient for safety systems can also be damaged. 1-800-663-8255
the seat belt pretensioners and/or airbags • The smoke and dust formed when the www.volvocanada.com
to be deployed. airbags are deployed can cause skin
However, not all frontal collisions activate the and eye irritation in the event of pro-
front airbags. longed exposure.

• If the collision involves a nonrigid object


(e.g., a snow drift or bush), or a rigid, fixed Should you have questions about any compo-
object at a low speed, the front airbags will nent in the SRS system, please contact a
not necessarily deploy. trained and qualified Volvo service technician
or Volvo customer support:
• Front airbags do not normally deploy in a
side impact collision, in a collision from the In the USA
rear or in a rollover situation.
Volvo Cars of North America, LLC
• The amount of damage to the bodywork
does not reliably indicate if the airbags Customer Care Center
should have deployed or not. 1 Volvo Drive
P.O. Box 914

1 See also the Occupant Weight Sensor information on page 26.


``

23
01 Safety

01 Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)

NOTE Airbag decals WARNING


• Deployment of front airbags occurs only • Children must never be allowed in the
one time during an accident. In a colli- front passenger's seat.
sion where deployment occurs, the air- • Occupants in the front passenger's seat
bags and seat belt pretensioners acti- must never sit on the edge of the seat,
vate. Some noise occurs and a small sit leaning toward the instrument panel
amount of powder is released. The or otherwise sit out of position.
release of the powder may appear as
smoke-like matter. This is a normal • The occupant's back must be as upright
characteristic and does not indicate fire. as comfort allows and be against the

G008335
seat back with the seat belt properly
• Volvo's front airbags use special sen- fastened.
sors that are integrated with the front Airbag decal on the outside of both sun visors
seat buckles. The point at which the air- • Feet must be on the floor, e.g., not on
bag deploys is determined by whether the dash, seat or out of the window.
or not the seat belt is being used, as well
as the severity of the collision.
• Collisions can occur where only one of
the airbags deploys. If the impact is less
severe, but severe enough to present a
clear injury risk, the airbags are trig-
gered at partial capacity. If the impact is
more severe, the airbags are triggered
at full capacity.

Passenger's side airbag decal

24
01 Safety

Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) 01

WARNING
• No objects or accessory equipment,
e.g. dashboard covers, may be placed
on, attached to, or installed near the air
bag hatch (the area above the glove
compartment) or the area affected by
airbag deployment (see the illustration
on page 22).
• There should be no loose articles, such
as coffee cups on the floor, seat, or
dashboard area.
• Never try to open the airbag cover on
the steering wheel or the passenger's
side dashboard. This should only be
done by a trained and qualified Volvo
service technician.
• Failure to follow these instructions can
result in injury to the vehicle occupants.

25
01 Safety

01 Occupant Weight Sensor

General information The OWS works with sensors that are part of airbag is disabled. The PASSENGER AIRBAG
the front passenger's seat and seat belt. The OFF indicator lamp is located in the overhead
sensors are designed to detect the presence of console, near the base of the rearview mirror.
a properly seated occupant and determine if
2
the passenger's side front airbag should be NOTE
enabled (may inflate) or disabled (will not
inflate). When the ignition is switched on, the OWS
indicator light will go on for up to 10 seconds
The OWS will disable (will not inflate) the pas- while the system performs a self-diagnostic
senger's side front airbag when: test.

• the front passenger's seat is unoccupied,


2 or has small/medium objects in the front However, if a fault is detected in the system:
G017724 seat, • The OWS indicator light will stay on
Occupant Weight Sensor (OWS) indicator light • the system determines that an infant is • The SRS warning light (see page 21) will
present in a rear-facing infant seat that is come on and stay on
Disabling the passenger's side front installed according to the manufacturer's
instructions, • The message Pass. Airbag OFF Service
airbag urgent will be displayed in the information
Volvo recommends that ALL occupants (adults • the system determines that a small child is display.
and children) shorter than 4 feet 7 inches present in a forward-facing child restraint
(140 cm) be seated in the back seat of any that is installed according to the manufac-
turer's instructions,
WARNING
vehicle with a front passenger side airbag, and
be properly restrained for their size and weight. • the system determines that a small child is If a fault in the system is detected and indi-
For child safety recommendations, see present in a booster seat, cated as described, be aware that the pas-
page 38. senger's side front airbag will not deploy in
• a front passenger takes his/her weight off the event of a collision. In this case, the SRS
The Occupant Weight Sensor (OWS) is of the seat for a period of time, system and Occupant Weight Sensor
designed to meet the regulatory requirements • a child or a small person occupies the front should be inspected by a trained and quali-
of Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard passenger's seat. fied Volvo service technician as soon as
(FMVSS) 208 and is designed to disable (will possible.
The OWS uses a PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
not inflate) the passenger's side front airbag
indicator lamp which will illuminate and stay on
under certain conditions.
to remind you that the passenger's side front

26
01 Safety

Occupant Weight Sensor 01

WARNING Passeng- OWS indi- Passeng- BAG OFF indicator lamp will be off and remain
off.
• Never try to open, remove, or repair any er's seat cator light er's side
components in the OWS system. This occu- status front air- If a person of adult size is sitting in the front
could result in system malfunction. pancy sta- bag status passenger's seat, but the PASSENGER AIR-
Maintenance or repairs should only be tus BAG OFF indicator lamp is on, it is possible that
carried out by an a trained and qualified the person isn't sitting properly in the seat. If
Volvo service technician. Seat unoc- OWS indica- Passenger's this happens:
cupied tor light side front
• The front passenger's seat should not
lights up. airbag disa- • Turn the vehicle off and ask the person to
be modified in any way. This could place the seatback in an upright position.
bled
reduce pressure on the seat cushion,
which might interfere with the OWS sys-
• Have the person sit upright in the seat,
Seat occu- OWS indica- Passenger's centered on the seat cushion, with the per-
tem's function. pied by low tor light side front son's legs comfortably extended.
weight lights up airbag disa- • Restart the vehicle and have the person
occupant/ bled remain in this position for about two
objectA minutes. This will allow the system to
detect that person and enable the pas-
Seat occu- OWS indica- Passenger's senger's frontal airbag.
pied by tor light is side front
heavy occu- not lit airbag ena- • If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
pant/object bled lamp remains on even after this, the person
should be advised to ride in the rear seat.
A Volvo recommends that children always be properly
restrained in appropriate child restraints in the rear seats. Do This condition reflects limitations of the OWS
not assume that the passenger's side front airbag is disabled classification capability. It does not indicate
unless the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp is lit.
Make sure the child restraint is properly installed. If there is OWS malfunction.
any doubt as to the status of the passenger's side front air-
bag, move the child restraint to the rear seat.
Modifications
The OWS is designed to enable (may inflate) If you are considering modifying your vehicle in
the passenger's side front airbag in the event any way to accommodate a disability, for
of a collision anytime the system senses that a example by altering or adapting the driver's or
person of adult size is sitting properly in the front passenger's seat(s) and/or airbag sys-
front passenger's seat. The PASSENGER AIR- tems, please contact Volvo at:

``

27
01 Safety

01 Occupant Weight Sensor

In the USA WARNING WARNING


Volvo Cars of North America, LLC • No objects that add to the total weight • Keep the following points in mind with
Customer Care Center on the seat should be placed on the respect to the OWS system. Failure to
front passenger's seat. If a child is follow these instructions could
1 Volvo Drive seated in the front passenger's seat adversely affect the system's function
P.O. Box 914 with any additional weight, this extra and result in serious injury to the occu-
weight could cause the OWS system to pant of the front passenger's seat:
Rockleigh, New Jersey 07647 enable the airbag, which might cause it • The full weight of the front seat passen-
1-800-458-1552 to deploy in the event of a collision, ger should always be on the seat cush-
thereby injuring the child. ion. The passenger should never lift
In Canada
• The seat belt should never be wrapped him/herself off the seat cushion using
Volvo Cars of Canada Corp. around an object on the front passeng- the armrest in the door or the center
National Customer Service er's seat. This could interfere with the console, by pressing the feet on the
OWS system's function. floor, by sitting on the edge of the seat
175 Gordon Baker Road North York, Ontario cushion, or by pressing against the
• The front passenger's seat belt should
M2H 2N7 never be used in a way that exerts more backrest in a way that reduces pressure
pressure on the passenger than normal. on the seat cushion. This could cause
1-800-663-8255
This could increase the pressure exer- OWS to disable the front, passenger's
ted on the weight sensor by a child, and side airbag.
could result in the airbag being enabled,
which might cause it to deploy in the
event of a collision, thereby injuring the
child.

28
01 Safety

Occupant Weight Sensor 01

WARNING
• Do not place any type of object on the
front passenger's seat in such a way
that jamming, pressing, or squeezing
occurs between the object and the front
seat, other than as a direct result of the
correct use of the Automatic Locking
Retractor/Emergency Locking Retrac-
tor (ALR/ELR) seat belt (see page 38).
• No objects should be placed under the
front passenger's seat. This could inter-
fere with the OWS system's function.

29
01 Safety

01 Side impact protection (SIPS) airbags

General information NOTE


SIPS airbag deployment (one airbag) occurs
only on the side of the vehicle affected by
the impact. The airbags are not designed to
deploy in all side impact situations.

Components in the SIPS airbag system


This SIPS airbag system consists of a gas gen-
erator, the side airbag modules built into the

G024377
outboard sides of both front seat backrests,
and electronic sensors/wiring.
G032949
Driver's side SIPS airbag
Location of the side impact (SIPS) airbags (front
seats only)

As an enhancement to the structural side


impact protection built into your vehicle, it is
also equipped with Side Impact Protection
System (SIPS) airbags.
The SIPS airbag system is designed to help
increase occupant protection in the event of
certain side impact collisions. The SIPS air-

G024378
bags are designed to deploy only during cer-
tain side-impact collisions, depending on the
crash severity, angle, speed and point of Passenger's side SIPS airbag
impact.
SIPS airbag deployment (one airbag) occurs
only on the side of the vehicle affected by the
impact. The airbags are not designed to deploy
in all side impact situations.

30
01 Safety

Side impact protection (SIPS) airbags 01

WARNING
• The SIPS airbag system is a supple-
ment to the structural Side Impact Pro-
tection System and the three-point seat
belt system. It is not designed to deploy
during collisions from the front or rear of
the vehicle or in rollover situations.
• The use of seat covers on the front seats
may impede SIPS airbag deployment.
• No objects, accessory equipment or
stickers may be placed on, attached to
or installed near the SIPS airbag system
or in the area affected by SIPS airbag
deployment.
• Never try to open or repair any compo-
nents of the SIPS airbag system. This
should be done only by a trained and
qualified Volvo service technician.
• In order for the SIPS airbag to provide
its best protection, both front seat
occupants should sit in an upright posi-
tion with the seat belt properly fastened.
• Failure to follow these instructions can
result in injury to the occupants of the
vehicle in the event of an accident.

31
01 Safety

01 Inflatable Curtain (IC)

General information WARNING WARNING


• The IC system is a supplement to the In order for the IC to provide its best pro-
Side Impact Protection System. It is not tection, both front seat occupants and both
designed to deploy during collisions outboard rear seat occupants should sit in
from the front or rear of the vehicle or in an upright position with the seat belt prop-
rollover situations. erly fastened; adults using the seat belt and
children using the proper child restraint sys-
• Never try to open or repair any compo- tem. Only adults should sit in the front seats.
nents of the IC system. This should be Children must never be allowed in the front
done only by a trained and qualified passenger seat, see page 38 for guide-
Volvo service technician. lines. Failure to follow these instructions can
result in injury to the vehicle occupants in an
• Never hang heavy items from the ceiling
accident.
handles. This could impede deployment
of the Inflatable Curtain.
This system consists of inflatable curtains • The cargo area and rear seat should not
located along the sides of the roof liners, be loaded to a level higher than 2 in.
stretching from the center of both front side (5 cm) below the upper edge of the rear
windows to the rear edge of the rear side door side windows. Objects placed higher
windows. It is designed to help protect the than this level could impede the func-
heads of the occupants of the front seats and tion of the Inflatable Curtain.
the occupant of the outboard rear seating posi-
tions in certain side impact collisions.
In certain side impacts, both the Inflatable Cur-
tain (IC) and the Side Impact Airbag System
(SIPS airbag) will deploy. The IC and the SIPS
airbag deploy simultaneously.

NOTE
If the inflatable curtain deploys, it remains
inflated for approximately 3 seconds.

32
01 Safety

Whiplash Protection System – WHIPS 01

General information Whiplash Protection System (WHIPS) – WARNING


front seats only
The WHIPS system consists of specially • Occupants in the front seats must never
sit out of position. The occupant's back
designed hinges and brackets on the front seat
must be as upright as comfort allows
backrests designed to help absorb some of the
and be against the seat back with the
energy generated in a collision from the rear seat belt properly fastened.
(when the vehicle is rear-ended).
• If your vehicle has been involved in a
In the event of a collision of this type, the hinges rear-end collision, the front seat back-
and brackets of the front seat backrests are rests must be inspected by a trained
designed to change position slightly to allow and qualified Volvo service technician,
the backrest/head restraint to help support the even if the seats appear to be undam-
occupant's head before moving slightly rear- aged. Certain components in the
ward. This movement helps absorb some of WHIPS system may need to be
the forces that could result in whiplash. replaced.
• Do not attempt to service any compo-
WARNING nent in the WHIPS system yourself.
• The WHIPS system is designed to sup-
plement the other safety systems in
your vehicle. For this system to function
properly, the three-point seat belt must
be worn. Please be aware that no sys-
tem can prevent all possible injuries that
may occur in an accident.
• The WHIPS system is designed to func-
tion in certain collisions from the rear,
depending on the crash severity, angle
and speed.

``

33
01 Safety

01 Whiplash Protection System – WHIPS

WARNING WARNING
• Boxes, suitcases, etc. wedged behind Any contact between the front seat back-
the front seats could impede the func- rests and the folded rear seat or a rear-fac-
tion of the WHIPS system. ing child seat could impede the function of
the WHIPS system. If the rear seat is folded
• If the rear seat backrests are folded down, the occupied front seats must be
down, cargo must be secured to pre- adjusted forward so that they do not touch
vent it from sliding forward against the the folded rear seat.
front seat backrests in the event of a
collision from the rear. This could inter-
fere with the action of the WHIPS sys-
tem.

34
01 Safety

Rollover Protection System (ROPS) 01

Volvo’s Rollover Protection System utilizes the


Roll Stability Control (RSC) function, which is
designed to help minimize the risk of a rollover
in emergency maneuvers or if a skid should
occur.
RSC uses a gyroscopic sensor that registers
the amount of change in the lateral angle at
which the vehicle is leaning. Using this infor-
mation, RSC calculates the likelihood of a roll-
over. If there is an imminent risk of a rollover,
the Dynamic Stability and Traction Control sys-
tem (DSTC) is activated, power to the engine is
cut and the brakes are applied to one or more
of the wheels until the vehicle regains stability.
For additional information on DSTC, see
page 144.

WARNING
The vehicle’s stability systems, including
ROPS and RSC, do not replace the driver’s
responsibility for operating the vehicle in a
safe manner. Speed and driving style
should always be adapted to the current
road, traffic and weather conditions. Posted
speed limits should always be respected.

35
01 Safety

01 Crash mode

function in the vehicle, such as the fuel lines, 2. Close the driver's door and reinsert the
sensors for one of the safety systems, the remote key in the ignition slot.
brake system, etc.
3. Try to start the vehicle.

WARNING If the message Safety mode See manual is


still displayed, the vehicle should not be driven
• Never attempt to repair the vehicle and must be towed. Concealed faults may
yourself or to reset the electrical system make the vehicle difficult to control.
after the vehicle has displayed Safety
mode See manual. This could result in Moving the vehicle
injury or improper system function. If the message Normal mode is displayed
• Restoring the vehicle to normal operat- when Safety mode See manual is no longer
ing status should only be done by a displayed, the vehicle may be moved carefully
Driving after a collision trained and qualified Volvo service tech- from its present position, if for example, it is
If the vehicle has been involved in a collision, nician. blocking traffic. It should, however, not be
the text Safety mode See manual may • After Safety mode See manual has moved farther than is absolutely necessary.
appear in the information display. This indi- been displayed, if you detect the odor
cates that the vehicle's functionality has been of fuel vapor, or see any signs of fuel WARNING
reduced. leakage, do not attempt to start the
Even if the vehicle appears to be drivable
vehicle. Leave the vehicle immediately. after Safety mode has been set, it should
NOTE not be driven or towed (pulled by another
Attempting to start the vehicle vehicle). There may be concealed damage
This text can only be shown if the display is that could make it difficult or impossible to
undamaged and the vehicle's electrical sys- If damage to the vehicle is minor and there is
control. The vehicle should be transported
tem is intact. no fuel leakage, you may attempt to start the on a flatbed tow truck to a trained and quali-
vehicle. To do so: fied Volvo service technician for inspection/
Safety mode is a feature that is triggered if one 1. Remove the remote key from the ignition repairs.
or more of the safety systems (e.g. front or side slot and open the driver's door. If a mes-
airbags, an inflatable curtain, or one or more of sage is displayed that the ignition is on,
the seat belt pretensioners) has deployed. The press the start button.
collision may have damaged an important

36
01 Safety

Child safety 01

Children should be seated safely restrained to help reduce the chance of injuring When a child has outgrown the child safety
Volvo recommends the proper use of restraint or increasing the injury of a child. seat, you should use the rear seat with the
systems for all occupants including children. standard seat belt fastened. The best way to
All states and provinces have legislation gov-
Remember that, regardless of age and size, a help protect the child here is to place the child
erning how and where children should be car-
child should always be properly restrained in a on a cushion so that the seat belt is properly
ried in a vehicle. Find out the regulations exist-
vehicle. located on the hips (see the illustration on page
ing in your state or province. Recent accident
45). Legislation in your state or province may
Your vehicle is also equipped with ISOFIX/ statistics have shown that children are safer in
mandate the use of a child seat or cushion in
LATCH attachments, which make it more con- rear seating positions than front seating posi-
combination with the seat belt, depending on
venient to install child seats. tions when properly restrained. A child restraint
the child's age and/or size. Please check local
system can help protect a child in a vehicle.
Some restraint systems for children are regulations.
Here's what to look for when selecting a child
designed to be secured in the vehicle by lap restraint system: A specially designed and tested booster cush-
belts or the lap portion of a lap-shoulder belt. ion and backrest can be obtained from your
Such child restraint systems can help protect It should have a label certifying that it meets
Volvo retailer.
children in vehicles in the event of an accident applicable Federal Motor Vehicle Safety
only if they are used properly. However, chil- Standards (FMVSS 213) – or in Canada, USA: for children weighing 33 – 80 lbs.
dren could be endangered in a crash if the child CMVSS 213. (15 – 36 kg) and 38 – 54 inches (97 – 137 cm)
restraints are not properly secured in the vehi- in height
Make sure the child restraint system is
cle. Failure to follow the installation instructions approved for the child's height, weight and Canada: for children weighing 40 – 80 lbs.
for your child restraint can result in your child development – the label required by the stand- (18 – 36 kg) and 40 – 54 inches (102 – 137 cm)
striking the vehicle's interior in a sudden stop. ard or regulation, or instructions for infant in height
Holding a child in your arms is NOT a suitable restraints, typically provide this information.
substitute for a child restraint system. In an In using any child restraint system, we urge you
accident, a child held in a person's arms can to carefully look over the instructions that are
be crushed between the vehicle's interior and provided with the restraint. Be sure you under-
an unrestrained person. The child could also be stand them and can use the device properly
injured by striking the interior, or by being ejec- and safely in this vehicle. A misused child
ted from the vehicle during a sudden maneuver restraint system can result in increased injuries
or impact. The same can also happen if the for both the infant or child and other occupants
infant or child rides unrestrained on the seat. in the vehicle.
Other occupants should also be properly

``

37
01 Safety

01 Child safety

WARNING 3. Insert the seat belt latch plate into the injuries during certain types of accidents.
buckle (lock) in the usual way. Volvo recommends that you do not dis-
• Do not use child safety seats or child connect the airbag system in your vehicle.
booster cushions/backrests in the front 4. Release the seat belt and pull it taut around
passenger's seat. We also recommend the child seat. • Volvo strongly recommends that everyone
in the vehicle be properly restrained.
that children under 4 feet 7 inches A sound from the seat belt retractor will be
(140 cm) in height who have outgrown audible at this time and is normal. The belt will
• Volvo recommends that ALL occupants
these devices sit in the rear seat with the (adults and children) shorter than 4 feet
now be locked in place. This function is auto-
seat belt fastened. 7 inches (140 cm) be seated in the back
matically disabled when the seat belt is seat of any vehicle with a front passenger
• On hot days, the temperature in the unlocked and the belt is fully retracted. side airbag.
vehicle interior can rise very quickly.
Exposure to these high temperatures Volvo's recommendations Drive safely!
for even a short period of time can Why does Volvo believe that no child should sit
cause heat-related injury or death. in the front seat of a vehicle? It's quite simple
Small children are particularly at risk. really. A front airbag is a very powerful device
designed, by law, to help protect an adult.

Automatic Locking Retractor/ Because of the size of the airbag and its speed
Emergency Locking Retractor (ALR/ of inflation, a child should never be placed in
the front seat, even if he or she is properly bel-
ELR)
ted or strapped into a child safety seat. Volvo
To make child seat installation easier, each has been an innovator in safety for over sev-
seat belt (except for the driver's belt) is equip- enty-five years, and we'll continue to do our
ped with a locking mechanism to help keep the part. But we need your help. Please remember
seat belt taut. to put your children in the back seat, and
When attaching the seat belt to a child buckle them up.
seat: Volvo has some very specific
1. Attach the seat belt to the child seat recommendations:
according to the child seat manufacturer's
• Always wear your seat belt.
instructions.
• Airbags are a SUPPLEMENTAL safety
2. Pull the seat belt out as far as possible. device which, when used with a three-
point seat belt can help reduce serious

38
01 Safety

Child restraint systems 01

Child restraints

G022847

G023269
G022840
Convertible seat Booster cushion
Infant seat
WARNING WARNING
There are three main types of child restraint
systems: infant seats, convertible seats, and A child seat should never be used in the Always refer to the child restraint manufac-
booster cushions. They are classified accord- front passenger seat of any vehicle with a turer's instructions for detailed information
ing to the child's age and size. front passenger airbag – not even if the on securing the restraint.
"Passenger airbag off" symbol near the
The following section provides general infor- rear-view mirror is illuminated (on vehicles
mation on securing a child restraint using a equipped with Occupant Weight Sensor). If
three-point seat belt. Refer to page 46–47 the severity of an accident were to cause the
for information on securing a child restraint airbag to inflate, this could lead to serious
injury or death to a child seated in this posi-
using ISOFIX/LATCH lower anchors and/or top tion.
tether anchorages.

``

39
01 Safety

01 Child restraint systems

WARNING
• When not in use, keep the child restraint
system secured or remove it from the
passenger compartment to help pre-
vent it from injuring passengers in the
event of a sudden stop or collision.
• A small child's head represents a con-
siderable part of its total weight and its
neck is still very weak. Volvo recom-
mends that children up to age 4 travel,
properly restrained, facing rearward. In
addition, Volvo recommends that chil-
dren should ride rearward facing, prop-
erly restrained, as long as possible.

40
01 Safety

Infant seats 01

Securing an infant seat with a seat belt WARNING


A child seat should never be used in the
front passenger seat of any vehicle with a
front passenger airbag – not even if the
"Passenger airbag off" symbol near the
rear-view mirror is illuminated (on vehicles
equipped with Occupant Weight Sensor). If
the severity of an accident were to cause the
airbag to inflate, this could lead to serious
injury or death to a child seated in this posi-
tion.

G023270
G022844
Positioning the seat belt through the infant seat 3. Fasten the seat belt by inserting the latch
Do not place the infant seat in the front passeng- plate into the buckle (lock) until a distinct
er's seat WARNING click is audible.

• An infant seat must be in the rear-facing


NOTE position only.
Refer to page 46–47 for information on • The infant seat should not be positioned
securing a child restraint using ISOFIX/ behind the driver's seat unless there is
LATCH lower anchors and/or top tether adequate space for safe installation.
anchorages.

1. Place the infant seat in the rear seat of the


vehicle.
2. Attach the seat belt to the infant seat

G023271
according to the manufacturer's instruc-
tions. Fasten the seat belt

``

41
01 Safety

01 Infant seats

G022846

G022850
Pull out the shoulder section of the seat belt Ensure that the seat is securely in place
4. Pull the shoulder section of the seat belt 6. Push and pull the infant seat along the seat
out as far as possible to activate the belt's belt path to ensure that it is held securely
automatic locking function. in place by the seat belt.

NOTE WARNING
The locking retractor will automatically It should not be possible to move the child
release when the seat belt is unbuckled and restraint (child seat) more than 1 in. (2.5 cm)
allowed to retract fully. in any direction along the seat belt path.

5. Press the infant seat firmly in place, let the The infant seat can be removed by unbuckling
seat belt retract and pull it taut. A sound the seat belt and letting it retract completely.
from the seat belt retractor's automatic
locking function will be audible at this time
and is normal. The seat belt should now be
locked in place.

42
01 Safety

Convertible seats 01

Securing a convertible seat with a seat WARNING


belt
• A small child's head represents a con-
siderable part of its total weight and its
neck is still very weak. Volvo recom-
mends that children up to age 4 travel,
properly restrained, facing rearward. In
addition, Volvo recommends that chil-
dren should ride rearward facing, prop-
erly restrained, as long as possible.
• Convertible child seats should be instal-

G022847
led in the rear seat only.
G018630
Route the seat belt through the convertible seat • A rear-facing convertible seat should not
be positioned behind the driver's seat
WARNING unless there is adequate space for safe
Do not place the convertible seat in the front pas-
senger's seat installation.
Always use a convertible seat that is suita-
ble for the child's age and size. See the con-
NOTE vertible seat manufacturer's recommenda- 2. Attach the seat belt to the convertible seat
tions. according to the manufacturer's instruc-
Refer to pages 46 and 47 for information
tions.
on securing a child restraint using ISOFIX/
LATCH lower anchors and/or top tether 1. Place the convertible seat in the rear seat
anchorages. of the vehicle.

Convertible seats can be used in either a for-


ward or rearward-facing position, depending
on the age and size of the child.

``

43
01 Safety

01 Convertible seats

time and is normal. The seat belt should


now be locked in place.

G022848

G022850
Fasten the seat belt Ensure that the seat is securely in place

G022849
3. Fasten the seat belt by inserting the latch
plate into the buckle (lock) until a distinct Pull out the shoulder section of the seat belt WARNING
click is audible. A child seat should never be used in the
6. Push and pull the convertible seat along
4. Pull the shoulder section of the seat belt the seat belt path to ensure that it is held front passenger seat of any vehicle with a
front passenger airbag – not even if the
out as far as possible to activate the belt's securely in place by the seat belt. "Passenger airbag off" symbol near the
automatic locking function. rear-view mirror is illuminated. If the severity
WARNING of an accident were to cause the airbag to
NOTE inflate, this could lead to serious injury or
It should not be possible to move the child death to a child seated in this position.
The locking retractor will automatically restraint (child seat) more than 1 in. (2.5 cm)
release when the seat belt is unbuckled and in any direction along the seat belt path.
allowed to retract fully.
The convertible seat can be removed by
5. Press the convertible seat firmly in place, unbuckling the seat belt and letting it retract
let the seat belt retract and pull it taut. A completely.
sound from the seat belt retractor's auto-
matic locking function will be audible at this

44
01 Safety

Booster cushions 01

Securing a booster cushion

G022852
G022851
Positioning the seat belt
Position the child correctly on the booster cushion 4. Ensure that the seat belt is pulled taut and
Booster cushions are recommended for chil- fits snugly around the child.
dren who have outgrown convertible seats.
WARNING
1. Place the booster cushion in the rear seat
of the vehicle. • The hip section of the three-point seat
belt must fit snugly across the child's
2. With the child properly seated on the hips, not across the stomach.
booster cushion, attach the seat belt to or
around the cushion according to the man- • The shoulder section of the three-point
ufacturer's instructions. seat belt should be positioned across
the chest and shoulder.
3. Fasten the seat belt by inserting the latch
plate into the buckle (lock) until a distinct
• The shoulder belt must never be placed
behind the child's back or under the
click is audible. arm.

45
01 Safety

01 ISOFIX/LATCH lower anchors

Using the ISOFIX/LATCH lower child 3. Fasten the attachment on the child
seat anchors restraint's lower straps to the ISOFIX/
LATCH/LATCH lower anchors.
4. Firmly tension the lower child seat straps
according to the manufacturer's instruc-
tions.

WARNING
Volvo's ISOFIX/LATCH anchors conform to

G018631
FMVSS/CMVSS standards. Always refer to
the child restraint system's manual for
weight and size ratings. Fasten the attachment correctly to the ISOFIX/
LATCH lower anchors
NOTE
Lower anchors for ISOFIX/LATCH-equipped WARNING
child seats are located in the rear, outboard • The rear seat's center position is not
seats, hidden below the backrest cushions. equipped with ISOFIX/LATCH lower • Be sure to fasten the attachment cor-
anchors. When installing a child rectly to the anchor (see the illustration).
Symbols on the seat back upholstery mark the
restraint in this position, attach the If the attachment is not correctly fas-
anchor positions as shown. To access the
restraint's top tether strap (if it is so tened, the child restraint may not be
anchors, kneel on the seat cushion and locate properly secured in the event of a colli-
the anchors by feel. Always follow your child equipped) to the top tether anchorage
point and secure the restraint with the sion.
seat manufacturer's installation instructions,
and use both ISOFIX/LATCH lower anchors
vehicle's center seat belt. • The ISOFIX/LATCH lower child restraint
• Always follow your child seat manufac- anchors are only intended for use with
and top tethers whenever possible.
turer's installation instructions, and use child seats positioned in the outboard
To access the anchors both ISOFIX/LATCH lower anchors and seating positions. These anchors are
1. Put the child restraint in position. top tethers whenever possible. not certified for use with any child
restraint that is positioned in the center
2. Kneel on the child restraint to press down seating position. When securing a child
the seat cushion and locate the anchors by restraint in the center seating position,
feel. use only the vehicle's center seat belt.

46
01 Safety

Top tether anchors 01

Child restraint anchorages Refer also to the child seat manufacturer's WARNING
instructions for information on securing the
child seat. • Never route a top tether strap over the
top of the head restraint. The strap
should be routed beneath the head
NOTE restraint.
On models equipped with the optional • Child restraint anchorages are designed
cargo area cover, this cover should be to withstand only those loads imposed
removed before a child seat is attached to
by correctly fitted child restraints. Under
the child restraint anchors.
no circumstances are they to be used
for adult seat belts or harnesses. The
anchorages are not able to withstand
excessive forces on them in the event of
collision if full harness seat belts or adult
Your Volvo is equipped with child restraint top seat belts are installed to them. An adult
tether anchorages in the rear seat. They are who uses a belt anchored in a child
located on the rear side of the backrests. restraint anchorage runs a great risk of
suffering severe injuries should a colli-
Securing a child seat sion occur.
1. Place the child restraint on the rear seat. • Do not install rear speakers that require
the removal of the top tether anchors or
2. Route the top tether strap under the head
interfere with the proper use of the top
restraint and attach it to the anchor.
tether strap.
3. Attach lower tether straps to the lower ISO-
FIX/LATCH anchors. If the child restraint is
not equipped with lower tether straps, or
the restraint is used in the center seating
position, follow instructions for securing a
child restraint using the Automatic Locking
Retractor seat belt (see page 38).
4. Firmly tension all straps.

47
01 Safety

01 Child restraint registration and recalls

Registering a child restraint


Child restraints could be recalled for safety
reasons. You must register your child restraint
to be reached in a recall. To stay informed
about child safety seat recalls, be sure to fill out
and return the registration card that comes
with new child restraints.
Child restraint recall information is readily avail-
able in both the U.S. and Canada. For recall
information in the U.S., call the U.S. Govern-
ment's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393.
In Canada, visit Transport Canada's Child
Safety website at http://www.tc.gc.ca/
roadsafety/childsafety/menu.htm.

48
01 Safety

Integrated booster cushion 01

Integrated two-stage booster in proper positioning of the shoulder strap,


cushion*1 then the child should be placed in a properly
Volvo's optional integrated booster cushions secured child restraint (see page 39). The
are located in the outboard seating positions. shoulder belt must never be placed behind the
These booster cushions have been specially child's back or under the arm.
designed to help safeguard children in the rear
seat. They should be stowed (folded down into
the seat cushion) when not in use. When using
an integrated booster cushion, the child must
be secured with the vehicle's three-point seat
belt.
Use these booster cushions only with Incorrect seating position: the child's head is
children whose weight is between: above the head restraint and the shoulder belt is
not across the collarbone
• Stage 1: 48 – 80 lbs (22 – 36 kg) Before driving, check that:
• Stage 2: 33 – 55 lbs (15 – 25 kg) • The integrated two-stage booster cushion
and whose height is between: Correct seating position: child's head is below the is set in the correct position for according
head restraint and the shoulder belt is across the to the child's height and weight (see the
• Stage 1: 45 – 55 in. (115 – 140 cm) collarbone table below) and is locked in position.
• Stage 2: 37 – 47 in. (95 – 120 cm) Stage 1 Stage 2
In Canada, Transport Canada's Weight 48 – 80 lbs 33 – 55 lbs
weight recommendation is 40 – 80 lbs
22 – 36 kg 15 – 25 kg
(18 – 36 kg).
The booster cushions are designed to raise the Height 45 – 55 in. 37 – 47 in.
child higher, so that the shoulder strap crosses 115 – 140 cm 95 – 120 cm
over the child's collarbone, not over the child's
neck. If using a booster cushion does not result

1 Canada only: This cushion may be referred to as a built-in booster cushion.


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 49


01 Safety

01 Integrated booster cushion

• That the seat belt is properly positioned


and is taut.
• The shoulder section of the seat belt is
across the child's collarbone, not over the
neck.
• The lap section of the seat belt is across
the child's hips and not the abdomen.

Using an integrated booster cushion


Stage 1

Pull the handle (1) forward and upward (2) With the booster cushion in the stage 1
to release the booster cushion. position, press the button (see the arrow in
illustration 1).
Press the booster cushion rearward to lock
it in position. Lift the front edge of the booster cushion
Stage 2 and press it rearward toward the backrest
to lock it in position.

50
01 Safety

Integrated booster cushion 01

Stowing the two-stage integrated NOTE WARNING


booster cushion
The booster cushion cannot be moved from DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY can
the stage 2 (upper) position to the stage 1 occur
(lower) position. It must first be folded down
completely to the stowed position, and then Follow all instructions on the
adjusted to stage 1. booster cushion and in the vehi-
cle's owner's manual.
Pull the handle forward to release the
booster cushion. MAKE SURE THE BOOSTER
CUSHION IS SECURELY
Press down on the center of the booster
cushion to return it to the stowed position.
LOCKED BEFORE THE CHILD IS
SEATED.
NOTE • Use this booster cushion only with chil-
dren whose height and weight are
The booster cushion must be in the stowed within the permitted limits shown in the
position before the rear seat backrests are table (see page 49).
folded down.
• In the event of a collision while the inte-
grated booster cushion was occupied,
CAUTION the entire booster cushion and seat belt
Be sure there are no loose objects under the must be replaced. The booster cushion
booster cushion before it is stowed. should also be replaced if it is badly
worn or damaged in any way. This work
should be performed by a trained and
qualified Volvo service technician only.

The booster cushion can be folded down com-


pletely (stowed) from either the stage 1 or stage
2 positions.

51
01 Safety

01 Child safety locks

Child safety locks

G021077

Child safety locks – rear doors


The controls are located on the rear door
jambs. Use the remote control's key blade or a
screwdriver to adjust these controls.
The rear doors can only be opened from
the outside when the slot is in the horizon-
tal position.
The rear doors can be opened from the
inside when the slot is in the vertical posi-
tion.

52
01 Safety

01

53
Remote key and key blade..................................................................... 56
Keyless drive........................................................................................... 63
Locks....................................................................................................... 66
Alarm....................................................................................................... 69

54
LOCKS AND ALARM
02 Locks and alarm

Remote key and key blade

Introduction produced. This code is available at an author- into Information Number of keys. See
Two remote keys or optional Personal Car ized Volvo retailer. page 128 for a description of the menu sys-
02
Communicators (PCC) are provided with your tem.
Loss of a remote key
vehicle. They enable you to unlock the doors USA-5WK49264
If either of the remote keys is lost, the other
and tailgate, and also function as ignition keys
should be taken with the car to a Volvo retailer. FCC ID:KR55WK49264 + Siemens VDO
to start the vehicle or operate electrical com-
As an anti-theft measure, the code of the lost 5WK49236
ponents. The remote keys contain detachable
remote key must be erased from the system.
metal key blades for manually locking or FCC ID:KR55WK49236, 5WK49266
unlocking the driver's door and the glove com-
partment. Up to six remotes can be pro- NOTE FCC ID:KR55WK49266 + Siemens VDO
grammed for use on the same vehicle. Additional or duplicate remote control keys 5WK49233
can be obtained from any Authorized Volvo FCC ID:KR55WK49233
The PCCs have enhanced functionality com-
Retailer.
pared with the standard remote key. This device complies with part 15 of the FCC
You can also obtain additional or duplicate rules and RSS-210. Operation is subject to the
remote control keys from certain independ-
NOTE ent repair facilities and locksmiths that are following conditions: (1) This device may not
qualified to make remote control keys. Each cause harmful interference, and (2) this device
In the remainder of this chapter, all referen-
ces to the remote key also pertain to the key must be programmed to work with your must accept any interference received, includ-
PCC unless otherwise stated. vehicle. ing interference that may cause undesired
California Only: operation.

WARNING A list of independent repair facilities and/or Canada-5WK49264


locksmiths known to Volvo that can cut and IC:267T-5WK49264 + Siemens VDO
Never leave the remote key in the ignition if code replacement keys can be found:
children are to remain in the vehicle. 5WK49236
• on the Volvo website at
IC:267T-5WK49236, 5WK49266
http://www.volvocars.com/us/keys
Detachable key blade IC:267T-5WK49266 + Siemens VDO
Each remote key or PCC contains a detachable • by calling Volvo Customer Care at
1-800-458-1552 5WK49233
metal key blade for mechanically locking or
unlocking the driver's door and the glove com- IC:267T-5WK49233
partment. See page 60 for more information The number of registered keys for the vehicle Operation is subject to the following condi-
on the key blade. The key blades have a unique can be found by pressing MY CAR and going tions: (1) this device may not cause interfer-
code, which is used if new ones need to be

56
02 Locks and alarm

Remote key and key blade

ence, and (2) this device must accept any inter- • Locking: turn signals flash once a key, take the other keys to a trained and
ference, including interference that may cause • Unlocking: turn signals flash twice qualified Volvo service technician for reprog-
undesired operation of the device. ramming as an anti-theft measure. The follow- 02
When the vehicle is locked, confirmation will
ing messages (which may appear in the instru-
Key memory: door mirrors and driver's only be given if all of the locks are locked after
ment panel display) are related to the immobil-
seat the doors have been closed.
izer:
The position of the side door mirrors and power
driver's seat are stored in the remote keys NOTE
Message Meaning
when the vehicle is locked. The next time the If you do not receive confirmation when
driver's door is unlocked with the same remote locking the vehicle, check whether a door or Key error Reinsert Remote key not rec-
key and the door is opened within 2 minutes, the tailgate is ajar, or if this feature has been key ognized during start.
the power driver's seat and side door mirrors turned off in the menu. Try to start the vehi-
will automatically move to the position that they cle again.
were in when the doors were most recently Making a setting
locked with the same remote key. See page Car key not found PCC with keyless
Different alternatives for locking/unlocking
83 for more information. drive only. Remote
confirmation can be selected in the menus by
key not recognized
This feature can be activated or deactivated in pressing MY CAR on the center console con-
during start. Try to
the vehicle's menu by pressing MY CAR and trol panel. Go to Settings Car settings start the vehicle
going into Settings Car settings Car Light settings and mark Door lock again.
key memory. See page 128 for a description confirmation light and/or Door unlock
confirmation light by pressing OK/MENU. If the problem con-
of the menu system.
See page 128 for a description of the menu tinues, insert the
See also page 63 for information regarding remote key into the
system.
vehicles with the optional keyless drive. ignition slot and try
Immobilizer (start inhibitor) to start the vehicle
Confirmation when locking/unlocking again.
Each of the keys supplied with your vehicle
the vehicle
contains a coded transponder. The code in the
When the vehicle is locked with a remote key, Immobilizer Try Remote key fault
key is transmitted to an antenna in the ignition
the turn signals will flash once to confirm that start again during start. Contact
slot where it is compared to the code stored in
this has been completed correctly. an authorized Volvo
the start inhibitor module. The vehicle will start
workshop.
only with a properly coded key. If you misplace

``

57
02 Locks and alarm

Remote key and key blade

CAUTION NOTE Buttons on the remote


Lock – Press the Lock button on the
02 Never use force when inserting the remote The remote key's range is normally approx-
key in the ignition slot. The vehicle cannot imately 60 ft (20 m) from the vehicle. remote once to lock all doors and the tailgate.
be started if the transponder is damaged. The turn signals will flash once to confirm lock-
ing.
See page 61 for information on replacing the
USA–FCC ID: LTQWFS 125VO battery. Unlock – Press the Unlock button on the
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC remote once to unlock the driver's door.
rules. Operation is subject to the following con- Common functions: Remote key/ After a short pause, press the Unlock button a
dition: (1) This device may not cause harmful Personal Car Communicator (PCC)* second time within 10 seconds to unlock the
interference, and (2) this device must accept other doors and the tailgate.
any interference received, including interfer-
This function can be changed so that all doors
ence that may cause undesired operation.
unlock at the same time by pressing My Car
Canada–IC: 3659A-WFS125VO and going to Settings Car settings
Operation is subject to the following condi- Lock settings Change doors unlock
tions: (1) this device may not cause interfer- setting. See page 128 for a description of the
ence, and (2) this device must accept any inter- menu system.
ference, including interference that may cause
undesired operation of the device. Approach lighting – As you approach the
vehicle, press the button on the remote key to

G021079
See page 109 for information on starting the light the interior lighting, parking lights, license
vehicle. plate lighting and the lights in the door mir-
Personal Car Communicator (PCC)* rors*.
Replacing the battery in the remote key
The batteries should be replaced if: Lock These lights will switch off automatically after
30, 60 or 90 seconds. See page 128 for a
• The information symbol illuminates and Unlock
description of the menu system.
Replace car key battery is shown in the
display and/or Approach lighting Unlock tailgate – Press the button twice
• if the locks do not react after several Tailgate unlock within several seconds to disarm the alarm
attempts to unlock or lock the vehicle. system and optional movement sensor (the
Panic alarm

58 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Remote key and key blade

alarm indicator light on the dashboard will go Range Using the information button
out), and unlock only the tailgate. Pressing this The remote key has a range of approximately 1. Press the information button .
button for several seconds also opens the tail- 60 ft. (20 m) from the vehicle. 02
gate on models equipped with the optional 2. All of the indicator lights will flash sequen-
power tailgate. tially for approximately 7 seconds to indi-
NOTE
cate that the PCC is receiving information
Buildings or other obstacles may interfere from the vehicle. If any of the buttons are
NOTE with the function of the remote key. The pressed during this 7-second period,
As an added safety precaution, the parking vehicle can also be locked or unlocked with transmission of information to the PCC will
lights will come on automatically for a short the key blade, see page 60. be interrupted.
period when the tailgate has been opened.

Unique functions—PCC* NOTE


After closing, the tailgate will not automatically
relock. Press Lock to relock it and rearm the If none of the indicator lights flash when the
information button has been pressed sev-
alarm. eral times from different places in relation to
See also the section "Unlocking the tailgate the vehicle, contact an authorized Volvo
from the passenger compartment." service technician.

Panic alarm – This button can be used to


The indicator lights provide information
attract attention during emergency situations.
according to the illustration:
To activate the panic alarm, press and hold this
button for at least 3 seconds or press it twice

G021080
within 3 seconds. The turn signals and horn will
be activated. The panic alarm will stop auto-
matically after 2 minutes and 45 seconds.
Information button
To deactivate, wait approximately 5 seconds
and press the button again. Indicator lights

The Panic alarm button will not unlock the vehi- Pressing the information button provides cer-
cle. tain information about the vehicle with the help
of the indicator lights.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 59


02 Locks and alarm

Remote key and key blade

NOTE NOTE
02 • The approach lighting, panic alarm, and If none of the indicator lights illuminate when
the functions controlled by the informa- the information button is pressed, this may
tion button have a range of approxi- be because the most recent transmission
mately 300 ft (100 m) from the vehicle. between the vehicle and the PCC was inter-
rupted or impeded by buildings or other
• Radio waves, buildings or other obsta- objects.
cles may interfere with the function of
the PCC.
Keyless drive
Vehicles equipped with the optional Personal
If the vehicle does not provide confirmation Car Communicator have the keyless drive
when a button has been pressed, try moving function, see page 63 for detailed informa-
Steady green light: the vehicle is correctly closer and pressing the button again. tion.
locked. Outside of the PCC´s range
Steady yellow light: the vehicle is not If the PCC is more than approximately 300 ft Detachable key blade
locked. (100 m) from the vehicle when the information
The key blade can be removed from the remote
Steady red light: the alarm has been trig- button is pressed, no new information will be
key. When removed, the key blade can be used
gered. received. The PCC most recently used to lock
to:
or unlock the vehicle will show the vehicle's
Both red lights flash alternatively: the alarm most recently received status. The indicator • Lock/unlock the driver's door if the remote
was triggered less than 5 minutes ago. lights will not flash when the information button key is not functioning properly
Range is pressed while the PCC is out of range. • Lock/unlock the glove compartment (see
The PCC's lock and unlock functions have a If more than one PCC is used to lock/unlock page 67)
range of approximately 60 ft. (20 m) from the the vehicle, only the one used most recently will • Block access to the glove compartment
vehicle. show the correct locking status.

60
02 Locks and alarm

Remote key and key blade

Removing the key blade wise approximately one-quarter turn to unlock


the driver's door only.
02
NOTE
After unlocking the driver's door with the
key blade, opening the door will trigger the
alarm.

To disable the alarm:


Insert the remote key in the ignition slot. This
also applies to vehicles equipped with the
G021082 optional keyless drive.

Slide the spring loaded catch to the side.


Replacing batteries in the remote key/
Pull the key blade straight out of the remote PCC
key. The battery/batteries in the remote key/PCC
should be replaced if:
Reinserting the key blade in the remote
key • The information symbol lights up and a text
1. Hold the remote key with the slot for the appears in the information display.
key blade up. and/or
2. Carefully slide the key blade into its groove. • the vehicle's locks repeatedly do not react
3. Gently press the key blade in the groove when a button on the remote key/PCC is
pressed within approximately 60 ft (20 m)
until it clicks into place.
from the vehicle.
Unlocking the doors with the detached
key blade
Insert the key blade as far as possible in the Battery type CR 2430, 3 V (one battery in the
remote key, two batteries in the PCC)
driver's door lock. Turn the key blade clock-

``

61
02 Locks and alarm

Remote key and key blade

Opening the remote key/PCC PCC (two batteries)


Slide the spring loaded catch to the 1. Use a screwdriver to pry out the old bat-
02 teries.
side.
Pull the key blade straight out of the 2. Insert the first new battery with the (+) side
remote key. upward.
3. Insert the plastic spacer over the battery.
Insert a small screwdriver in the hole
Insert the second new battery on top of the
behind the spring loaded catch and care- plastic spacer, with the + side downward.
fully pry up the cover.
Re-assembling the remote key
NOTE 1. Press the remote key's cover into place.
Turn the remote key with the buttons 2. Hold the remote key with the slot for the
upward so that the batteries do not fall out key blade up.
when the cover is removed.
3. Carefully slide the key blade into its groove.

Replacing the batteries 4. Gently press the key blade in the groove
until it clicks into place.
CAUTION Old batteries should be properly recycled.
When handling batteries, avoid touching
their contact surfaces as this could result in
poor battery function in the remote key.

Note the position of the battery's (+) or (–)


sides.
Remote key (one battery)
1. Use a screwdriver to pry out the old bat-
tery.
2. Insert a new one with the (+) side down-
ward.

62
02 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive

Keyless drive* (models with Personal NOTE Lock settings Keyless entry. See page
Car Communicator only) 128 for a description of the menu system.
• The gear selector must in the P position 02
Keyless locking and unlocking before the vehicle can be locked and
the alarm can be armed. NOTE
• The buttons on the keyless drive remote If the PCC does not function normally (weak
key can also be used to lock and unlock battery, etc.), the vehicle can be unlocked
the vehicle, see page 58 for more infor- with the detachable key blade, see
mation. page 61.

Both of the PCCs provided with the vehicle Locking or unlocking the vehicle with the
have the keyless function, and additional ones key blade
can be ordered. The system can accommo-
date up to six PCCs.
The red rings in the illustration indicate the area
Range of the keyless drive remote key–5 ft around the vehicle that is within range of the
(1.5 meters) keyless drive antennas.
This system makes it possible to unlock and Unlocking the vehicle
lock the vehicle without having to press any • A keyless drive remote key must be on the
buttons on the Personal Car Communicators same side of the vehicle as the door to be
(PCC). It is only necessary to have a keyless opened, and be within 5 feet (1.5 meters)
drive remote key in your possession to operate of the door's lock or the tailgate (see the
the central locking system. shaded areas in the illustration).
Keyless drive keyhole cover
• Pull a door handle to unlock and open the
door or pull the tailgate opening control. The driver's door on vehicles equipped with
The number of doors that are unlocked at the keyless drive can be locked or unlocked with
same time can be set in the vehicle's menu the remote key's detachable key blade if nec-
system. Press MY CAR and go to Car settings essary, see page 60 for information on remov-
ing the key blade from the remote key. To
access the keyhole in the driver's door:

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 63


02 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive

1. Press the key blade approx. 0.5 in. (1 cm) The doors and the tailgate can be locked by See also page 83 for information on adjusting
straight up in the hole on the underside of pressing the lock button in any of the outside and storing the seat's position in the seat mem-
02 the keyhole cover. door handles. ory.
> The cover will come off due to the pres-
NOTE Keyless drive information messages
sure exerted when the key blade is
If all of the PCCs are removed from the vehicle
pushed upward. On keyless drive vehicles, the gear selector while the engine is running or if the ignition is
2. Insert the key blade as far as possible in the must be in the Park (P) position, all doors in mode II (see page 81) and all of the doors
driver's door lock. Turn the key blade to and the tailgate must be closed and the igni- are closed, a message will appear in the instru-
unlock the driver's door only. This will trig- tion must be switched off before the vehicle
can be locked. ment panel display and an audible signal will
ger the alarm. Press the remote key into the sound.
igniton slot to turn off the alarm.
Keyless drive remote key and driver's When at least one PCC has been returned to
3. Press the cover back into place after the the car, the message will be erased in the dis-
seat/door mirror memory
door has been unlocked. play and the audible signal will stop when:
• When you leave the vehicle with a PCC in
Locking the vehicle your possession and lock any door, the • A door has been opened and closed
position of the driver's seat and door mir-
• The PCC has been inserted in the ignition
rors will be stored in the seat's memory. slot
• The next time a door is opened by a person • The READ button (see page 126 for the
with the same PCC in his/her possession, location of this button) has been pressed.
the driver's seat and door mirrors will auto-
matically move to the position that they
were in when the door was most recently
locked.

NOTE
If several people carrying PCCs approach
the vehicle at the same time, the driver's
Models with keyless drive have a button on the seat and door mirrors will assume the posi-
outside door handles tions they were in for the person who opens
the driver's door.

64
02 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive

CAUTION For Automobile Use The keyless drive system has a number of
antennas located at various points in the vehi-
• Keyless drive remote keys should never Canada – IC:267T-5WK48952, 02
cle.
be left in the vehicle. In the event of a 267T-5WK48964, 267T-5WK48891
break-in, a remote found in the vehicle On the tailgate, near the wiper motor
NOTE
could make it possible to start the
This device complies with RSS -210 of Industry Left rear door handle
engine.
Canada. Operation is subject to the following Ceiling, above the center of the rear seat
• Electromagnetic fields or metal
two conditions: (1) This device may not cause
obstructions can interfere with the key-
harmful interference, and (2) this device must Under the floor of the cargo area, near the
less drive system. Avoid placing the
accept interference received, including inter- rear seat
remote key near cellular phones, metal-
lic objects or e.g., in a metal briefcase. ference that may cause undesired operation. Right rear door handle
CAUTION
Under the rear section of the center con-
USA – FCC ID:KR55WK48952, KR55WK48964 Changes or modifications not expressly sole
NOTE approved by the manufacturer could void the Under the front section of the center con-
user's authority to operate the equipment. sole.
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC
Rules. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) This device may not cause Location of the keyless drive antennas WARNING
harmful interference, and (2) this device must People with implanted pacemakers should
accept interference received, including inter- not allow the pacemaker to come closer
ference that may cause undesired operation. than 9 inches (22 cm) to any of the keyless
drive system's antennas. This is to help pre-
CAUTION vent interference between the pacemaker
Changes or modifications not expressly and the keyless drive system.
approved by the manufacturer could void the
user's authority to operate the equipment.
Siemens VDO

G021179
5WK48891
Tested To Comply With FCC Standards

65
02 Locks and alarm

Locks

Locking and unlocking the vehicle From inside the vehicle (central locking Locking
button) • Press the lock button after the front
02 From outside the vehicle doors have been closed.
The remote key locks all of the doors and the
tailgate. • Each door can be locked individually with
the lock button on the respective doors.
If the locks repeatedly do not react when the The door must be closed first.
unlock button is pressed, it may be necessary
to replace the batteries in the remote, see Automatic relocking
page 58. In this case the vehicle can be If the doors are unlocked, the locks will auto-
unlocked with the detachable key blade. See matically reengage (re-lock) and the alarm will
page 61. rearm after 2 minutes unless a door or the tail-
gate has been opened.
The first press on the unlock button unlocks the
driver's door and a second press unlocks the Automatic locking
other doors and the tailgate (see also page When the vehicle starts to move, the doors and
Central locking button
58). trunk can be locked automatically. This feature
The lock buttons on the door panel can be used can be turned on or off by pressing MY CAR
NOTE to lock or unlock all doors and the tailgate at and going to Car settings Lock settings
the same time. Press to lock and to
The vehicle cannot be locked if a door is Automatic door locking. See page 128 for
open. unlock.
a description of the menu system.
Unlocking
The vehicle can be unlocked from inside the
vehicle in two ways:
• By pressing the unlock button .
• The door can be unlocked by pulling the
door handle once and opened by pulling
the handle again.

66
02 Locks and alarm

Locks

Glove compartment Locking/unlocking the tailgate NOTE


• If the doors are locked while the tailgate 02
is open, the tailgate will remain
unlocked until the vehicle is relocked by
pressing the Lock button on the remote
key.
• On keyless drive vehicles, the gear
selector must be in the Park (P) position,
all doors and the tailgate must be
closed and the ignition must be
switched off before the vehicle can be
locked.
Tailgate unlock button on the remote key
The glove compartment can only be locked Unlocking the tailgate from the
and unlocked using the detachable key blade Unlocking the tailgate with the remote
passenger compartment
in the remote key. See page 60 for information key
on removing the key blade from the remote  Press the tailgate unlock button on the
key. remote key to unlock (but not open1) the
tailgate. See also page 58.
Insert the key blade in the glove compart-
> The alarm indicator light on the dash-
ment lock.
board will go out to indicate that the
Turn the key blade 90 degrees clockwise. alarm is not monitoring the entire vehi-
cle. The accessory movement and incli-
Remove the key blade from the lock. nation sensors will be automatically dis-
connected.

1 This button also opens, but does not close, the tailgate on models equipped with the optional power tailgate (see page 255).
``

67
02 Locks and alarm

Locks

 Press the button on the lighting panel (1) to The tailgate is held closed by an electronic
unlock (but not open1) the tailgate. locking mechanism. To open:
02
1. Press lightly on the rubberized plate under
NOTE the handle to release the lock.
The taillights will illuminate automatically for 2. Lift the handle to open the tailgate.
a short period when the tailgate has been
opened.
CAUTION
Locking the tailgate with the remote key • When pressing the rubberized plate,
 only light pressure is necessary to
Press the lock button ( ) on the remote.
release the tailgate's electronic locking
See also page 58. mechanism.
> The alarm indicator on the dashboard
• When opening the tailgate, pull it up
will begin flashing to show that the alarm using the handle. Too much pressure on
has been armed. the rubberized plate can damage its
electrical connections.
Opening the tailgate manually

1 This button also opens, but does not close, the tailgate on models equipped with the optional power tailgate (see page 255).

68
02 Locks and alarm

Alarm

The alarm system NOTE Arming the alarm


The alarm is automatically armed whenever the  Press the Lock button on the remote key.
Do not attempt to repair any of the compo- 02
vehicle is locked with the remote key or nents in the alarm system yourself. This One long flash of the turn signals will con-
optional Personal Car Communicator. could affect the insurance policy on the firm that the alarm is armed.
When armed, the alarm continuously monitors vehicle. Alarm confirmation settings can be changed in
a number of points on the vehicle. The follow- MY CAR, under Car settings Lock
ing conditions will trigger the alarm: The alarm indicator light settings Keyless entry. See page 128 for
• The hood is forced open. a description of the menu system.
• The tailgate is forced open. USA FCC ID: MAYDA 5823(3)
• A door is forced open.
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC
• The ignition slot is tampered with. rules. Operation is subject to the following con-
• An attempt is made to start the vehicle with ditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful
a non-approved key (a key not coded to interference, and (2) this device must accept
the car's ignition). any interference received, including interfer-
• If there is movement in the passenger com- ence that may cause undesired operation.
partment (if the vehicle is equipped with
the accessory movement sensor).
Canada IC: 4405A-DA 5823(3)
• The vehicle is lifted or towed (if the vehicle Movement sensor DA5823 by Dynex Operation
is equipped with the accessory inclination The status of the alarm system is indicated by is subject to the following conditions: (1) this
sensor). the red indicator light on the dashboard (see device may not cause interference, and (2) this
illustration): device must accept any interference, including
• The battery is disconnected (while the interference that may cause undesired opera-
alarm is armed). • Indicator light off – the alarm is not armed tion of the device.
• The siren is disconnected when the alarm • The indicator light flashes at one-second
is disarmed. intervals – the alarm is armed
A message will appear in the information dis- • The indicator light flashes rapidly before
play if a fault should occur in the alarm system. the remote key is inserted in the ignition
Contact a trained and qualified Volvo service slot and the ignition is put in mode I—the
technician. alarm has been triggered.

``

69
02 Locks and alarm

Alarm

Disarming the alarm Remote key not functioning • Activate once. If this alternative is
 Press the Unlock button on the remote key. If the remote key is not functioning properly, selected, Reduced guard See
02 the alarm can be turned off and the vehicle can manual will appear in the instrument
> Two short flashes from the car's direc-
be started as follows: panel display and the accessory incli-
tion indicators confirm that the alarm
nation and movement alarm sensors will
has been deactivated and that all doors 1. Open the driver's door with the key blade. be deactivated when the vehicle is
are unlocked. > This will trigger the alarm. locked.
2. Insert the remote key into the ignition slot • Ask when exiting. If this alternative is
Turning off (stopping) the alarm (also on vehicles with the optional keyless selected, a message will appear in the
If the alarm is sounding, it can be stopped by drive). This will turn off the alarm. center console display each time the
pressing the Unlock button on the remote key engine is turned off. Press OK/MENU to
or by inserting the remote key in the ignition accept and the accessory inclination
slot. Two short flashes from the car's direction
Reduced alarm function and movement alarm sensors will be
indicators confirm that the alarm has been deactivated when the vehicle is locked.
Turning off the accessory alarm sensors
turned off. Press EXIT to cancel.
In certain situations it may be desirable to turn
off the accessory inclination and movement 4. Press OK/MENU and lock the vehicle.
Other alarm-related functions alarm sensors if, for example, you drive your The next time the engine is started, the alarm
vehicle onto a ferry where the rocking of the system will be reset and Full guard will appear
Automatic re-arming boat could trigger the alarm or if a pet is left in in the instrument panel display. The accessory
If the doors are unlocked, the locks will auto- the vehicle with the doors locked. inclination and movement alarm sensors will be
matically reengage (re-lock) and the alarm will
The vehicle's menu system is used for turning reactivated.
re-arm after 2 minutes unless a door or the tail-
off these sensors (see page 128 for a descrip- In either of the alternatives, if you prefer not to
gate has been opened.
tion of the menu system). deactivate the accessory inclination and move-
Audible/visual alarm signal 1. Go into the menu under Car settings. ment alarm sensors, do not make a choice in
• An audible alarm signal is given by a bat- the menu or press EXIT and lock the vehicle.
tery powered siren. The alarm cycle lasts 2. Select Reduced Guard (Press OK/
for 30 seconds. MENU to choose).
• The visual alarm signal is given by flashing 3. Two alternatives are now available:
all turn signals for approximately 5 minutes
or until the alarm is turned off.

70
02 Locks and alarm

02

71
Instruments and controls........................................................................ 74
Ignition modes........................................................................................ 81
Seats....................................................................................................... 82
Steering wheel........................................................................................ 88
Lighting................................................................................................... 89
Wipers and washers................................................................................ 95
Power windows....................................................................................... 98
Mirrors................................................................................................... 100
Compass*.............................................................................................. 102
Laminated panoramic roof*................................................................... 103
HomeLink® Wireless Control System*................................................. 106
Starting the engine................................................................................ 109
Transmission......................................................................................... 112
Brakes................................................................................................... 115
Parking brake........................................................................................ 118
Hill Descent Control (HDC)*.................................................................. 121

72 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


YOUR DRIVING ENVIRONMENT
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Instrument overview

03

74
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Function Page Function Page Function Page


Menus and mes- 128, 92, In-door control pan- 98, 100, Lighting panel, con- 89, 252,
sages, turn signals, 89, 142 els (power win- 52, 66 trols for opening 67
high/low beams, dows, mirrors, fuel filler door/tail-
trip computer power child safety gate
locks, central lock- 03
Cruise control 147 ing button) Power seat* adjust- 82
ment controls
Horn, airbag 88, 22 Hazard warning 91
flashers
Main instrument 75 Information displays
panel Audio system con- 200
trols
Audio system/Blue- 200, 229
tooth hands-free Climate system 137
controls controls

START/STOP 81 Gear selector 112


ENGINE button
Controls for active 146
Ignition slot 81 chassis (Four-C)*

Infotainment/menu - Wipers and washers 95, 96


display
Steering wheel 88
Information displays in the instrument panel
Door handle – adjustment
The information displays show information on
Hood opening con- 303 some of the vehicle's functions, such as cruise
trol control, the trip computer and messages. The
information is shown with text and symbols.
Parking brake 118

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 75


03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

More detailed information can be found in the in the red area of the gauge. The engine When the engine has started, all the symbols
descriptions of the functions that use the infor- management system will automatically should go out except the parking brake sym-
mation displays. prevent excessively high engines speeds. bol, which only goes out when the brake is dis-
This will be noticeable as a pronounced engaged.
unevenness in engine speed.
Gauges If the engine does not start or if the function
check is carried out in ignition mode II, all sym-
03 Indicator, information, and warning bols go out after 5 seconds except the symbol
symbols for faults in the vehicle's emissions system and
the symbol for low oil pressure.
Certain symbols may not have their functions
illustrated, depending on the vehicle's equip-
ment.

Indicator and information symbols


Symbol Description
Fault in the Active Bending
Gauges in the instrument panel Light (ABL)*system
Speedometer
Malfunction indicator light
Fuel gauge. Please note that the fuel level Indicator and warning symbols
indicator in the gauge moves from right to Anti-lock brake system (ABS)
High beam and turn signal indicators
left as the amount of fuel in the tank
decreases. The arrow indicates the side of Indicator and warning symbols
Rear fog light on
the vehicle that the fuel filler door is on. See
also the section on refueling beginning on Information symbols
page 250. See page 142 for more infor- Indicator and warning symbols Stability system
mation on fuel level and consumption.
The tachometer shows engine speed in Function check Tire pressure monitoring sen-
thousands of revolutions per minute (rpm). All indicator and warning symbols light up in sor (TPMS)
Do not drive continuously with the needle ignition mode II or when the engine is started.

76 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Symbol Description condition that potentially may need correcting. If the warning light remains on, the vehicle
When this happens, please have your vehicle should be driven to a trained and qualified
Low fuel level checked by a trained and qualified Volvo serv- Volvo service technician for inspection, see
ice technician as soon as possible. page 115 for additional information.
Information symbol, see text A malfunction indicator (CHECK ENGINE) light Canadian models are equipped with this
in information display may have many causes. Sometimes, you may symbol.
not notice a change in your car's behavior. 03
High beam indicator Even so, an uncorrected condition could hurt Rear fog light
fuel economy, emission controls, and drivabil- This symbol indicates that the rear fog light
Left turn signal indicator ity. Extended driving without correcting the (located in the driver's side tail light cluster) is
cause could even damage other components on.
Right turn signal indicator in your vehicle.
Stability system
This light may illuminate if the fuel filler cap is This indicator symbol flashes when the DSTC
The stability system's Sport not closed tightly or if the engine was running (Dynamic Stability and Traction Control sys-
mode is activated. while the vehicle was refueled. tem) is actively working to stabilize the vehicle,
see page 144 for more detailed information.
Canadian models are equipped with this
Fault in the Active Bending Light symbol. Tire pressure monitoring system
(ABL) system Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) (TPMS)*
This symbol will illuminate if the there is a fault This symbol illuminates to indicate that tire
warning light
in the ABL system. See page 90 for more pressure in one or more tires is low, see
If the warning light comes on, there may be a
information about this system. page 294 for detailed information.
malfunction in the ABS system (the standard
Malfunction Indicator Light braking system will still function). Check the Low fuel level
As you drive, a computer called On-Board system by: When this light comes on, the vehicle should
Diagnostics II (OBDII) monitors your vehicle's 1. Stopping in a safe place and switching off be refueled as soon as possible. See page
engine, transmission, electrical and emission the ignition. 250 for information about fuel and refueling.
systems. Information symbol
2. Restart the engine.
The malfunction indicator (CHECK ENGINE) The information symbol lights up and a text
3. If the warning light goes off, no further
light will illuminate if the computer senses a message is displayed to provide the driver with
action is required.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 77


03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

necessary information about one of the vehi- example when driving with snow chains, or Parking brake applied
cle's systems. The message can be erased and driving in deep snow or loose sand. This symbol illuminates when the parking
the symbol can be turned off by pressing the brake is applied. On models equipped with the
READ button (see page 126 for information) or Indicator and warning symbols
electric parking brake, this symbol flashes
this will take place automatically after a short Symbol Description while the brake is being applied and then glows
time (the length of time varies, depending on steadily.
03 the function affected). Low oil pressure
A flashing symbol means that a fault has been
The information symbol may also illuminate detected. See the message in the information
together with other symbols. Parking brake applied
display.
High beam indicator Canadian models are equipped with this
SRS airbags
This symbol illuminates when the high beam symbol.
headlights are on, or if the high beam flash
function is used. Seat belt reminder See page 118 for more information about
using the parking brake.
Left turn signal indicator
Generator not charging Airbags – SRS
Right turn signal indicator If this light comes on while the vehicle is being
Fault in the brake system driven, or remains on for longer than approxi-
NOTE mately 10 seconds after the vehicle has been
Warning symbol started, the SRS system's diagnostic functions
• Both turn signal indicators will flash
have detected a fault in a seat belt lock or pre-
when the hazard warning flashers are
tensioner, a front airbag, side impact airbag,
used.
and/or an inflatable curtain. Have the system(s)
• If either of these indicators flash faster Low oil pressure
inspected by a trained and qualified Volvo
than normal, the direction indicators are If the light comes on while driving, stop the
service technician as soon as possible.
not functioning properly. vehicle, stop the engine immediately, and
check the engine oil level. If the oil level is nor- See page 21 for more information about the
mal and the light stays on after restart, have the airbag system.
Sport mode vehicle towed to the nearest trained and quali-
This symbol illuminates to indicate that the sta- fied Volvo service technician. This is normal,
bility system's Sport mode has been activated provided it goes off when the engine speed is
to help provide maximum tractive force, for increased.

78
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Seat belt reminder MIN, the vehicle should be transported to an WARNING


This symbol comes on for approximately 6 sec- authorized Volvo workshop to have the brake
system checked. • If the fluid level is below the MIN mark
onds if the driver has not fastened his or her in the reservoir or if a warning message
seat belt. Canadian models are equipped with this is displayed in the text window: DO
Generator not charging symbol. NOT DRIVE. Have the vehicle towed to
a trained and qualified Volvo service
This symbol comes on during driving if a fault If the and symbols come on at the 03
technician and have the brake system
has occurred in the electrical system. Contact same time, there may be a fault in the brake inspected.
an authorized Volvo workshop. force distribution system.
• If the ABS and Brake system lights are
Engine temperature 1. Stop the vehicle in a safe place and turn off on at the same time, there is a risk of
Engine overheating can result from low oil or reduced vehicle stability.
the engine.
coolant levels, towing or hard driving at high
heat and altitude, or mechanical malfunction. 2. Restart the engine.
Engine overheating will be signaled with text Warning symbol
• If both symbols extinguish, continue driv-
and a red warning triangle in the middle of the ing. The red warning symbol lights up to indicate a
instrument display. The exact text will depend problem related to safety and/or drivability. A
on the degree of overheating. It may range from • If the symbols remain on, check the level in message will also appear in the main instru-
the brake fluid reservoir, see page 306. If
High engine temp Reduce speed to High ments panel's display. The symbol remains
the brake fluid level is normal but the sym-
engine temp Stop engine. If appropriate, bols are still lit, the vehicle can be driven, visible until the fault has been rectified but the
other messages, such as Coolant level low, with great care, to an authorized Volvo text message can be cleared with the READ
Stop safely will also be displayed. If your workshop to have the brake system button, see page 126. The warning symbol can
engine does overheat so that you must stop the checked. also come on in conjunction with other sym-
engine, always allow the engine to cool before bols.
attempting to check oil and coolant levels.
• If the level in the reservoir is below MIN, the
vehicle should be transported to an author- Action:
See page 306 for more information. ized Volvo workshop to have the brake
1. Stop in a safe place. Do not drive the vehi-
system checked.
Fault in brake system cle further.
If this symbol lights, the brake fluid level may 2. Read the information on the information
be too low. Stop the vehicle in a safe place and display. Implement the action in accord-
check the level in the brake fluid reservoir, see ance with the message in the display. Clear
page 306. If the level in the reservoir is below the message using READ.

``

79
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Reminder – doors not closed Odometer display Turn the control clockwise/counterclockwise
If one of the doors, the hood or tailgate is not to set the time. The set time is shown in the
Button for toggling between T1 and T2, information display.
closed properly, the information or warning
and for resetting the odometer
symbol comes on together with an explanatory The clock may be temporarily replaced by a
text message in the instrument panel. Stop the The trip odometers are used to measure short
symbol in conjunction with a message, see
vehicle in a safe place as soon as possible and distances. A short press the button toggles
page 126.
03 close the door, hood or tailgate. between the two trip odometers T1 and T2. A
long press (more than 2 seconds) resets an
If the vehicle is driven at a speed
active trip odometer to zero. The distance is
lower than approximately 5 mph
shown in the display.
(7 km/h), the information symbol comes on.
If the vehicle is driven at a speed
Clock
higher than approximately 5 mph
(7 km/h), the warning symbol comes on.

Trip odometers

Clock and setting control


Display
Control for setting the clock
Trip odometers and reset button

80
03 Your driving environment

Ignition modes

Inserting and removing the remote key Ignition modes Ignition mode 0
The various ignition modes are accessed with  Insert the remote key in the ignition slot and
the remote key in the ignition slot. press it in as far as possible.

Ignition mode I
Posi- Function  With the remote key fully pressed into the
tion ignition slot, press START/STOP 03
0 Odometer, clock and tempera- ENGINE briefly.
ture gauge are illuminated. Steer-
Ignition mode II
ing lock is deactivated. The audio
 With the remote key fully pressed into the
system can be used.
ignition slot, press START/STOP
I Laminated panoramic roof, ENGINE for approximately 2 seconds.
power windows,12-volt sockets,
Ignition slot with remote key and START/STOP Ignition mode III (engine start)
ENGINE button. navigation system*, climate sys-
tem blower, ECC, windshield Start the engine, see page 109.
Inserting the remote key wipers can be used. Stopping the engine
Holding the end of the remote key with the  Press START/STOP ENGINE. (If the
base of the key blade, insert the remote key II The headlights come on. Warn-
ing/indicator lights come on for engine is running and the vehicle is mov-
into the ignition slot as shown in the illustration ing, keep the button depressed until the
and press it in as far as possible (past the 5 seconds. All equipment oper-
ates apart from heated seats and engine stops).
detent).
rear window defroster, which
Returning to ignition mode 0
only work when the engine is run-
CAUTION  Press START/STOP ENGINE briefly to
ning.
return to ignition mode 0 from modes I or
Foreign objects in the ignition slot can
impair function or damage the lock. III The starter motor will operate II.
until the engine has started.
Emergency towing
Removing the remote key Ignition mode II should be used so that the
The remote key can be removed from the igni- NOTE lighting can be switched on.
tion slot by pulling it out. The brake pedal must not be depressed
when accessing ignition modes I or II.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 81


03 Your driving environment

Seats

Front seats WARNING Lift the catches on the rear of the backrest.

• Do not adjust the seat while driving. The Without releasing the catches, push the
seat should be adjusted so that the backrest forward.
brake pedal can be depressed fully. In
Move the seat as far forward as possible
addition, position the seat as far rear-
ward as comfort and control allow. so that the head restraint slides under the
03 glove compartment.
• Check that the seat is securely locked
into position after adjusting.
WARNING

Folding the front seat backrest • When transporting long objects, cover
sharp edges on the load to help prevent
injury to occupants. Secure the load to
help prevent shifting during sudden
Lumbar support: turn the control for firmer stops.
or softer lumbar support. • When the seat's backrest is returned to
Front-rear adjustment: lift the bar and the upright position, push and pull it to
move the seat to the position of your be sure that it is securely locked in this
choice. position.
Raise/lower front edge of seat cushion,
pump up/down.
Backrest tilt: turn the control to adjust the
angle of the backrest.
Raise/lower the seat, pump up/down. The front passenger seat backrest can be
folded to a horizontal position to make room for
Control panel for power seat*. a long load. Fold the backrest as follows:
Move the seat as far back and down as
possible.
Adjust the backrest to an upright position.

82 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Seats

Power seat* NOTE Programming the memory


Three different seating and door mirror posi-
• Only one of the power seat's controls tions can be stored in the driver seat's memory.
can be used at the same time.
The following example explains how button (1)
• The power seats have an overload pro-
can be programmed. Buttons (2) and (3) are
tector that activates if a seat is blocked
by any object. If this occurs, switch off programmed in the same way.
03
the ignition (key in position 0) and wait To program (store) a seat position and door
for a short period before operating the mirror position in button (1):
seat again.
1. Move the seat (and door mirrors) to the
desired position using the seat and mirror
Seat with memory function adjustment controls.
2. Press and hold down the memory button
Front edge of seat cushion up/down (4).
Seat forward/rearward and up/down 3. With the memory button depressed, press
button (1) briefly to store the current posi-
Backrest tilt
tion for the seat/mirrors.
Operation To move the seat and mirrors to the position
The seats can be adjusted for a short period that they were in when a button was pro-
after unlocking the door with the remote con- grammed:
trol without the key in the ignition slot. Seat  Press and hold down button (1) until the
adjustment is normally made when the ignition seat and mirrors stop moving.
is on and can always be made when the engine
is running. Stored seat position
NOTE
Stored seat position
As a safety precaution, the seat will stop
Stored seat position automatically if the button is released before
the seat has reached the preset position.
Memory button

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 83


03 Your driving environment

Seats

Remote keyless entry system and the 1. Unlock the driver's door with the same Emergency stop
driver's seat and door mirrors1 remote control (the one used to lock the If the seat accidentally begins to move, press
doors). one of the buttons to stop the seat.
2. Open the driver's door within 2 minutes.
WARNING
The driver's seat and door mirrors will auto-
03 matically move to the position in which you left • Because the driver's seat can be
them. adjusted with the ignition off, children
should never be left unattended in the
vehicle.
NOTE
• Movement of the seat can be STOPPED
• The key memory is independent of the at any time by pressing any button on
seat memory. the power seat control panel.
• The seat will move to this position even • Do not adjust the seat while driving. The
if someone else has moved it to a dif- seat should be adjusted so that the
The remote control transmitter also controls ferent seating position and locked the brake pedal can be depressed fully. In
the position of the power driver's seat and door vehicle with a different remote control. addition, position the seat as far rear-
mirrors in the following way: • This feature will work in the same way ward as comfort and control allow.
with all of the remote control transmit- • The seat rails on the floor must not be
1. Adjust the seat to your preferences.
ters that you use with your vehicle. obstructed in any way when the seat is
2. When you leave your vehicle, lock it using in motion.
the remote control. The function can be activated/deactivated
The position of the driver's seat and door mir- under MY CAR under Settings Car Heated seats*
rors is now stored in the remote control's mem- settings Car key memory Position of See page 138.
ory. door mirrors and driver's seat in key. See
Automatic seat/mirror adjustment page 128 for a description of the menu sys-
To move the seat and door mirrors to the posi- tem.
tion in which you left them:

1 See page 64 for information regarding vehicles with the optional keyless drive.

84 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Seats

Rear seats The center head restraint should be adjusted Manually folding down the rear seat's
according to the passenger's height. The outboard head restraints
Rear center head restraint restraint should be carefully adjusted to sup-
port the occupant's head.
• Pull the head restraint up as required.
• To lower, press and hold the button 03
(located at the center, between the back-
rest and the head restraint) while pressing
the head restrain down.

WARNING
The center rear seat head restraint should
only be in its lowest position when this seat
is NOT occupied. When the center position
is occupied, the head restraint should be • Pull the handle closest to the head restraint
correctly adjusted to the passenger’s to fold it down.
height. The upper edge of the head restraint
should be at least on a level with the upper- • To return the head restraint to the upright
most point of the seat occupant's ear. position, push it up until it clicks into place.

NOTE
• The head restraint must be returned to
the upright position manually.
• The outboard head restraints cannot be
folded down on models that are not
equipped with this button.

``

85
03 Your driving environment

Seats

CAUTION 2. Press the button to lower the rear head CAUTION


restraints for improved visibility.
The rear head restraints should not be kept To help avoid damage to the upholstery,
folded down for prolonged periods. This there should be no objects on the rear seat
could result in pressure marks in leather CAUTION and the seat belt should not be buckled
upholstery. The rear head restraints should not be kept when the backrest is folded down.
folded down for prolonged periods. This
03 could result in pressure marks in leather
WARNING upholstery.
For safety reasons, no one should be
allowed to sit in the outboard rear seat posi-
tions if the head restraints are folded down. WARNING
If these positions are occupied, the head For safety reasons, no one should be
restraints should be in the upright (fixed) allowed to sit in the outboard rear seat posi-
position. tions if the head restraints are folded down.
If these positions are occupied, the head
Automatically folding down the rear restraints should be in the upright (fixed)
position.
seat’s outboard head restraints*

Folding down the rear seat backrests


The three sections of the rear seat backrest can
be folded down in different combinations to
make it easier to transport long objects.
• The left (driver's side) section can be folded

G017903
down separately.
• The center section can be folded down
separately.
• The right (passenger's side) section can
only be folded down together with the cen-
ter section.
1. The ignition must be in mode I or II. • All three sections can be folded down
together.

86 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Seats

WARNING
• When one or more sections of the back-
rest is returned to the upright position,
check that it is properly locked in place
by pushing and pulling it. The red indi-
cators should also not be visible.
03
• Return the outboard head restraints to
the upright position.
• Long loads should always be securely
Release and lower the center head anchored to help avoid injury in the
restraint (see page 85) if the center and/or event of a sudden stop.
right section of the backrest is to be low-
ered. The outboard head restraints fold • Always turn the engine off and apply the
parking brake when loading/unloading
down automatically.
the vehicle.
Pull up the backrest release control on the • Place the transmission in the Park (P)
respective section(s) and fold the sec- position to help prevent inadvertent
tion(s) down. movement of the gear selector.
• On hot days, the temperature in the
NOTE vehicle interior can rise very quickly.
It may be necessary to move the front seats Exposure of people to these high tem-
forward or put their backrests in a more peratures for even a short period of time
upright position before folding down the can cause heat-related injury or death.
rear seat backrests. Small children are particularly at risk.

87
03 Your driving environment

Steering wheel

Adjusting WARNING Horn


Never adjust the steering wheel while driv-
ing.

With the optional speed-dependent power


03 steering the level of steering force can be
adjusted, see page 146.

Keypads

G021138

Adjusting the steering wheel Horn


Lever for releasing/locking the steering  Press the steering wheel hub to sound the
wheel horn.
Possible positions
The steering wheel can be adjusted for both
height and reach:
1. Pull the lever toward you to release the
steering wheel.
Keypads in the steering wheel
2. Adjust the steering wheel to the position
Cruise control, see page 147. Adaptive
that suits you.
cruise control*, see page 149.
3. Push back the lever to lock the steering
Infotainment controls, see page 203.
wheel in place. If the lever is difficult to
push into place, press the steering wheel
lightly at the same time as you push the
lever.

88 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Lighting panel High/low beam headlights High/low beam headlights


Continuous high beams
1. Set the ignition to mode II.
2. With the light switch in position , pull
the turn signal lever toward the steering
wheel to position 2 to toggle between high 03
and low beams (this also applies on mod-
els equipped with the optional Active
Bending Lights).
> The symbol illuminates in the
instrument panel to indicate that the
high beams are on.
Overview, light switches Headlight switch and lever
Thumb wheel for adjusting display and High beam flash Low beams
instrument lighting When the engine is started, the low beams are
Toggle between high and low beams
Rear fog light activated automatically (daytime running lights)
if the headlight control is in position 0 or
Headlights/parking lights Daytime running lights/no high .
beams
Instrument lighting Daytime running lights can be deactivated by
Illumination of the display and instrument lights Parking lights a trained and qualified Volvo service techni-
will vary, depending on ignition mode. cian.
The display lighting is automatically subdued Low beams
in darkness and the sensitivity is set with the
thumb wheel.
High beam flash
The intensity of the instrument lighting is Move the lever toward the steering wheel to
adjusted with the thumb wheel. position 1. The high beams come on until the
lever is released.

``

89
03 Your driving environment

Lighting

NOTE ABL is activated automatically1 when the Symbol Display Explana-


engine is started and it can be deactivated/ tion
• The use of daytime running lights is reactivated in the menu system under
mandatory in Canada.
MY CAR Settings Car settings Light Headlamp The system
• Continuous high beams cannot be acti- settings Active bending lights. failure is not func-
vated when the headlight switch is in Service tioning
03 position or 0. High beam flash will required properly and
function in these positions.
NOTE
should be
This function is only active in twilight or dark inspected/
conditions, and only when the vehicle is in repaired by
Active Bending Lights (ABL)* motion. a trained
and qualified
If a fault should occur in the system, the symbol Volvo serv-
will illuminate and a message will be displayed ice techni-
as shown in the table. cian.

Headlight pattern with the Active Bending Light


function deactivated (left) and activated (right)
When this function is activated, the headlight
beams adjust laterally to help light up a curve
according to movements of the steering wheel
(see the right-pointing beam in the illustration).

1 The factory default setting is on.

90 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Parking lights Rear fog light NOTE


The rear fog light is considerably brighter
than the normal taillights and should be
used only when conditions such as fog, rain,
snow, smoke or dust reduce visibility for
other vehicles to less than 500 ft.
(150 meters). 03

Hazard warning flashers

Headlight control in position for parking lights


The single rear fog light is located in the driver's
The rear parking lights can be turned on even side taillight cluster. The rear fog light will only
when the ignition is switched off. function in combination with the high/low
Turn the headlight control to the center posi- beam headlights.
tion (the license plate lighting comes on at the  Press the button to switch the rear fog light
same time). on/off.
The lighting also comes on when the tailgate is > The rear fog light indicator symbol
opened in order to alert anyone traveling on the instrument panel and the
behind your vehicle. Location of the hazard warning flasher button
light in the button come on when the
rear fog light is switched on. The hazard warning flasher should be used to
indicate that the vehicle has become a traffic
hazard.
 To activate the flashers, press the button
in the center dash. Press the button again
to turn off the flashers.

``

91
03 Your driving environment

Lighting

NOTE When turning Interior lighting, front


Move the lever as far up or down as possi-
• Regulations regarding the use of the
ble to start the turn signals. The turn signals will
hazard warning flasher may vary,
depending on where you live. be cancelled automatically by the movement of
the steering wheel, or the lever can be returned
• The hazard warning flashers will be acti- to its initial position by hand.
03 vated automatically if an airbag
deploys.
NOTE
• This automatic flashing sequence can
Turn signals be interrupted by immediately moving
the lever in the opposite direction.

G021149
• If the turn signal indicator flashes faster
than normal, check for a burned-out Light switches, front roof lighting
turn signal bulb.
Drivers side front reading light, on/off
Passenger's side front reading light, on/off
Overhead courtesy lighting.
The lighting in the front part of the passenger
compartment is controlled with the buttons (1)
and (2) in the roof console.

Turn signals Switch (3) has three positions for all passenger
compartment lighting:
When changing lanes
• Off: right side depressed, automatic light-
The driver can automatically flash the turn ing off.
signals 3 times by moving the turn signal lever
up or down to the first position and releasing it.
• Neutral position: automatic lighting is on.
• On – left side depressed, passenger com-
partment lighting on.

92
03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Interior lighting, rear Overhead courtesy lighting Home safe lighting


The passenger compartment lighting is When you leave your vehicle at night, you can
switched on and off automatically when button make use of the home safe lighting function to
(3) is in the neutral position. illuminate the area in front of the vehicle.
The lighting comes on and remains on for 1. Remove the key from the ignition slot.
30 seconds if:
2. Pull the turn signal lever as far as possible 03
• the vehicle is unlocked from the outside towards the steering wheel and release it.
with the key or remote control
3. Exit the vehicle and lock the doors.
• the engine is switched off and the ignition
is in mode 0. The headlights, parking lights, turn signals,
lights in the door mirrors, license plate lights,
The lighting switches off when:
and footwell lighting will illuminate and remain
Rear reading lights
• the engine is started on for 30 2, 60 or 90 seconds. The time interval
The lights are switched on or off by pressing
• the vehicle is locked from the outside. can be set in MY CAR under Settings Car
each respective button. The lighting comes on and remains on for two settings Light settings Home safe light
minutes if one of the doors is open. duration. See page 128 for a description of
Courtesy lights/door step lighting* The passenger compartment lighting can be the menu system.
The courtesy lights/door step lighting switch switched on and off manually within 30 minutes
on/off automatically when one of the front after the vehicle has been unlocked. Approach lighting
doors is opened/closed.
If the lighting is switched on manually and the Approach lighting is activated by pressing the
Glove compartment lighting vehicle is locked, the courtesy lighting will approach light button on the remote key (see
The glove compartment lighting switches on/ switch off automatically after one minute. the illustration on page 58).
off automatically when the lid is opened/ When the function has been activated, the
closed. Cargo area lighting
parking lights, indicator lights, door mirror
The cargo area lighting comes on automatically
lights, license plate lighting, dome lighting and
when the tailgate is opened.
door step lighting come on.

2 Factory setting
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 93


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

The time interval for this lighting can be set by


pressing MY CAR and going to Car settings
Light settings Approach light
duration. See page 128 for a description of
the menu system.

03

94
03 Your driving environment

Wipers and washers

Windshield wipers/washers Windshield wipers off (the wipers will sweep the windshield more fre-
Move the lever to position 0 to switch quently) or down (the wipers will sweep the
off the windshield wipers. windshield less frequently).

Single sweep NOTE


Move the lever upward from position
0 to sweep the windshield one stroke The wipers will make an extra sweep each
time the thumb wheel is adjusted upward. 03
at a time for as long as the lever is held up.

Intermittent wiping When the rain sensor is activated, the symbol


With the lever in this position, you can will illuminate in the instrument panel.
set the wiper interval by twisting the
thumb wheel upward to increase wiper speed Activating and setting the sensitivity
or downward to decrease the speed. When activating the rain sensor, the vehicle
Windshield wipers and washers must be running or in ignition mode II and the
Rain sensor* on/off Continuous wiping windshield wiper lever must be in position 0 or
The wipers operate at normal speed. in the single sweep position.
Thumb wheel sensitivity/frequency
Activate the rain sensor by pressing the button
The wipers operate at high speed.
CAUTION . The windshield wipers will make one
sweep.
• Use ample washer fluid when washing
Windshield wiper service position
the windshield. The windshield should Press the lever up for the wipers to make an
be thoroughly wet when the wipers are
The windshield wipers must be in the service extra sweep. The rain sensor returns to active
in operation. position before the wiper blades can be mode when the stalk is released back to posi-
cleaned or replaced. See page 315 for addi- tion 0.
• Before using the wipers, ice and snow tional information.
should be removed from the wind- Deactivating
shield/rear window. Be sure the wiper Rain sensor* Deactivate the rain sensor by pressing the but-
blades are not frozen in place. The rain sensor automatically regulates wiper ton or press the lever down to another
speed according to the amount of water on the wiper position.
windshield. The sensitivity of the rain sensor
can be adjusted moving the thumb wheel up

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 95


03 Your driving environment

Wipers and washers

The rain sensor is automatically deactivated After the lever is released the wipers make sev- Tailgate wiper/washer
when the key is removed from the ignition slot eral extra sweeps.
or five minutes after the ignition has been
switched off. Heated washer nozzles*
The washer nozzles are heated automatically
CAUTION in cold weather to help prevent the washer fluid
03
from freezing.
The rain sensor should be deactivated when
washing the car in an automatic car wash, High-pressure headlight washing*
etc. If the rain sensor function is left on, the High-pressure headlight washing consumes a
wipers will start inadvertently in the car large quantity of washer fluid. To save fluid, the
wash and could be damaged. headlights are washed using two alternatives:

Windshield washing
• Low/high beam headlights on. The head-
lights will be washed the first time the wind- Move the lever forward to start the tailgate washer.
shield is washed. Thereafter, the head-
lights will only be washed once for every Intermittent wiping
five times the windshield is washed within Normal (continuous) wiping
a 10-minute period.
• Parking lights on. Optional Active Bend-
ing Lights will be washed once for every NOTE
five times the windshield is washed. Nor- The rear wiper is equipped with cut-off func-
mal halogen headlights will not be washed. tion, which means that it will not operate if
its electric motor overheats. The wiper will
CAUTION function again after a cool-down period
(30 seconds or longer, depending on the
Use ample washer fluid when washing the heat of the motor and ambient temperature
Washing function windshield. The windshield should be thor- conditions).
oughly wet when the wipers are in opera-
Move the lever toward the steering wheel to tion.
start the windshield and headlight washers.

96 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Wipers and washers

Tailgate wiper and reverse gear IR-reflecting windshield* ces should not be placed on sections of the
If the windshield wipers are on and the trans- windshield with the IR coating because this
mission is put into reverse gear, the tailgate could affect their function and limit their range.
wiper will go into intermittent wiping function1. For best performance, place the device on the
This function is deactivated when a different section of the windshield without the IR coating
gear is selected. (see the area marked in the illustration).
03
NOTE
On vehicles with the optional rain sensor,
the tailgate wiper will be activated when
reverse is selected, if the rain sensor is acti-
vated and it is raining.

If the tailgate wiper is in the normal (continuous) Section of the windshield where the IR-coating is
wiping mode, selecting different gears will not not applied
affect its function.
Dimensions
A 1.9 in. (47 mm)

B 3.4 in. (87 mm)

An optional factory-installed infrared (IR) coa-


ting can be applied to the windshield to help
protect the cabin from the sun's heat and the
fading effect of sunlight on upholstery, panels,
etc.
Electronic equipment such as garage door
openers, electronic toll tags and similar devi-

1 Consult your Volvo retailer if you would like to have this function deactivated.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 97


03 Your driving environment

Power windows

Power windows Operating NOTE


• Movement of the windows will stop if
they are obstructed in any way.
• To reduce buffeting wind noise if the
rear windows are opened, also open the
03 front windows slightly.

Manual up/down
 Move one of the controls up/down slightly.
> The power windows move up/down as
long as the control is held in position.

Driver's door control panel Operating the power windows Auto up/down
 Move one of the controls up/down as far
Switch for power child safety locks* and Manual up/down
as possible and release it.
disengaging rear power window buttons,
Auto up/down. > The window will open or close com-
see page 52
All power windows can be operated using the pletely.
Rear window controls
control panel in the driver's door. The control Resetting
Front window controls. panels in the other doors only operate the win- If the battery has been disconnected, the auto
dow in the respective doors. open function must be reset so that it will work
WARNING For the power windows to function, the ignition properly.
must be in at least mode I. When the vehicle
• Always remove the ignition key when
has been running, the power windows can be
1. Gently raise the front section of the button
the vehicle is unattended. to close the window and hold it for one
operated for several minutes after the remote second.
• Never leave children unattended in the key has been removed from the ignition slot, or
vehicle. until a door has been opened. 2. Release the button briefly.
• Make sure that the windows are com- 3. Raise the front section of the button again
pletely unobstructed before they are
for one second.
operated.

98 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Power windows

Laminated glass*
This glass is reinforced to help pro-
vide protection against break-ins and
improved sound insulation in the
passenger compartment.
The windshield, laminated panoramic roof and
other windows have laminated glass. 03

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 99


03 Your driving environment

Mirrors

Power door mirrors Retractable power door mirrors* To activate this function, select reverse gear
The mirrors can be retracted for parking/driving and press the L or R mirror control button to tilt
in narrow spaces: the mirror down.
1. Press down the L and R buttons at the The function can be activated/deactivated in
same time. MY CAR under Settings Car settings
2. Release them after approximately one sec- Side mirror settings Tilt left mirror or Tilt
03
ond. The mirrors automatically stop in the right mirror. See page 128 for a description
fully retracted position. of the menu system.
Fold out the mirrors by pressing down the L The door mirror will reset to its normal position:
and R buttons at the same time. The mirrors • after 10 seconds when reverse is disen-
automatically stop in the fully extended posi- gaged and the car remains stopped.
tion.
Door mirror controls • immediately when reverse is disengaged
Storing the position* and the vehicle's forward speed exceeds
Adjusting The mirror positions are stored in the key mem- approximately 6 mph (10 km/h).
1. Press the L button for the left door mirror ory when the vehicle has been locked with the • immediately if you press the correspond-
or the R button for the right door mirror. remote key. When the vehicle is unlocked with ing L or R button again.
The light in the button comes on. the same remote control the mirrors and the • when the engine is turned off.
2. Adjust the position with the joystick in the driver's seat adopt the stored positions when
the driver's door is opened.
• when the side mirrors are folded in.
center.
3. Press the L or R button again. The light The function can be activated/deactivated in NOTE
should no longer be on. MY CAR under Settings Car settings
Only one mirror can be tilted down at a time.
Car key memory Position of door mirrors
WARNING and driver's seat in key. See page 128 for a
description of the menu system.
Automatically tilting the door mirrors
Objects seen in the mirrors may appear fur- when parking
ther away than they actually are. Tilting the door mirrors when parking* The door mirrors can tilt down automatically to
The door mirrors can be tilted down to help help give the driver a better view along the
give the driver a better view along the sides of sides of the vehicle, for example when parallel
the vehicle, for example when parallel parking. parking. When the transmission is no longer in

100 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Mirrors

reverse, the mirrors will automatically return to Home safe and approach lighting Settings Climate settings Automatic
their original position. The light on the door mirrors comes on when rear defroster. See page 128 for a description
This function can be activated/deactivated in approach lighting or home safe lighting is of the menu system.
selected, see page 93.
MY CAR under Settings Car settings
Side mirror settings In reverse gear tilt Interior rearview mirror
left mirror or In reverse gear tilt right Rear window and door mirror
defrosters Auto-dim function 03
mirror. See page 128 for information about
An integrated sensor reacts to headlights from
the MY CAR menu system.
following traffic and automatically reduces
Automatic retraction when locking glare in the mirror.
When the vehicle is locked/unlocked with the
remote key the door mirrors are automatically
retracted/extended.
The function can be activated/deactivated in
MY CAR under Settings Car settings
Side mirror settings Retract door mirrors
when locking. See page 128 for a description
of the menu system.
Resetting to neutral
Mirrors that have been moved out of position Use the defroster to quickly remove fog and ice
by an external force must be electrically reset from the rear window and the door mirrors.
to the neutral position for electric retracting/ Press the button once to start simultaneous
extending to work. rear window and door mirror defrosting. The
• Retract the mirrors with the L and R but- light in the button indicates that the function is
tons. active. Switch the function off when then win-
dows have cleared to help avoid battery drain.
• Fold them out again with the L and R but-
tons. The rear window is defogged/de-iced auto-
The mirrors are now reset in neutral position. matically if the vehicle is started in an outside
temperature lower than 48 °F (9 °C). Auto-
defrosting can be selected in MY CAR under

101
03 Your driving environment

Compass*

Operation netic zone. The character C is shown in the Selecting a magnetic zone
mirror's display if calibration is necessary. 1

1. Stop the vehicle in a large open area, safely


2 15
out of traffic and away from steel structures
14
and high-tension electrical wires. 3

03 2. Start the vehicle. 13


4
NOTE 12
5 8
For best results from calibration, switch off 9
11
all electrical equipment in the vehicle (cli- 10

G018632
mate system, windshield wipers, audio sys- 6 7
tem, etc.) and make sure that all doors are
Rearview mirror with compass. closed. Magnetic zones.
The rearview mirror has an integrated display The earth is divided into 15 magnetic zones.
that shows the compass direction in which the 3. Using a pen or similar object, press and The correct zone must be selected for the com-
vehicle is pointing. Eight different directions are hold the button on the underside of mirror pass to work correctly.
shown with the abbreviations: N (north), NE until C is shown again in the mirror(after
approx. 6 seconds). 1. Put the ignition in mode II.
(north east), E (east), SE (southeast), S (south),
SW (southwest), W (west) and NW (northwest). 4. Drive as usual. C disappears from the dis- 2. Using a pen or similar object, press and
hold the button on the rear side of mirror
The compass is displayed automatically when play when calibration is complete.
for at least 3 seconds. The number for the
the vehicle is started or in ignition mode II. To Alternative calibration method: current area will be shown.
switch the compass on/off use a pen or similar
Drive slowly in a circle at a speed of no 3. Press the button repeatedly until the num-
object and press in the button on the underside
more than 5 mph (8 km/h) until C disap- ber for the required geographic area
of the mirror.
pears from the display when calibration is (1 – 15) is shown.
Calibration complete.
4. The display will revert to showing the com-
The compass may need to be calibrated if, for pass direction after several seconds.
example, the vehicle is driven into a new mag-

102 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Laminated panoramic roof*

Introduction Both the laminated panoramic roof and the sun Operation
The laminated panoramic roof is divided into shade are operated by the controls in the ceil-
two sections. ing console, near the rear-view mirror. The
vehicle's ignition must be in mode I or II before
• The rear glass section is fixed in place and the laminated panoramic roof/sun shade can
cannot be moved. be operated.
• The front glass section can be slid hori- 03
zontally to the open or closed positions or CAUTION
its rear edge can be raised and lowered to
allow ventilation. • Remove ice and snow before opening
the laminated panoramic roof.
All references in this section to opening or clos-
ing the panoramic roof pertain to the front glass • Do not operate the laminated panor-
section. amic roof if it is frozen closed.

The laminated panoramic roof also has a sun • Never place heavy objects on the lami-
Auto open (arrow points toward the rear of
nated panoramic roof.
shade made of perforated fabric that is located the vehicle)
below the sections of glass. This shade can be
Manual open
opened or closed, for example when driving in
bright sunlight. Manual close
Auto close

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 103


03 Your driving environment

Laminated panoramic roof*

WARNING • Open - pull the control back (to the auto NOTE
open position) twice in quick succession
• During manual closing, if the laminated and release it. For manual opening, the sun shade must
panoramic roof is obstructed, immedi- first be fully open before it will be possible
ately open it again.
• Close - push the control forward (to the to open the laminated panoramic roof.
auto close position) twice in quick succes- When closing, the laminated panoramic roof
• Never open or close the laminated pan- sion and release it. must be fully closed before the sun shade
03 oramic roof if it is obstructed in any way. can be closed.
• Never allow a child to operate thelami- Manual operation
nated panoramic roof. 1. Opening the sun shade: Pull the control
back to the first stop (the manual open Tilt position
• Never leave a child alone in a vehicle.
position) and hold it until the sun shade has
• Never extend any object or body part opened to the position of your choice.
though the open laminated panoramic
roof, even if the vehicle's ignition is 2. Opening the rear edge of the laminated
completely switched off. panoramic roof: Pull the control back to
the first stop (the manual open position) a
second time to open the rear edge of the
Automatic operation laminated panoramic roof.
1. To open the sun shade completely, pull the
control as far back as possible (to the auto 3. Opening the front glass section: Pull the
open position) and release it. control back to the first stop (the manual
open position) a third time and hold it until
2. To fully open the laminated panoramic the laminated panoramic roof has opened
roof, pull the control as far back as possible to the position of your choice. Tilt position, raised at the rear edge
a second time (to the auto open position)
Perform this procedure in reverse order to Open (raise the rear edge of the front glass
and release it.
close the laminated panoramic roof and/or sun section) by pressing the rear edge of the
Quick open/close shade. control upward.
The laminated panoramic roof and the sun Close by pulling the rear edge of the con-
shade can be opened/closed at the same time: trol downward and holding it until the lami-
nated panoramic roof has closed com-
pletely.
If the sun shade is completely closed, it will
open approximately 2 inches (5 cm) when the

104 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Laminated panoramic roof*

laminated panoramic roof is opened to the tilt


position.

Wind blocker

03

The moonroof is equipped with a wind blocker


that folds up when the moonroof is open.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 105


03 Your driving environment

HomeLink® Wireless Control System*

Introduction WARNING Programming HomeLink


• If you use HomeLink to open a garage
NOTE
door or gate, be sure no one is near the
gate or door while it is in motion. Some vehicles may require the ignition
switch to be turned on or to the second
• When programming a garage door
(“accessories”) position for programming
03 opener, it is advised to park outside of and/or operation of HomeLink. It is also rec-
the garage. ommended that a new battery be placed in
• Do not use HomeLink with any garage the hand-held transmitter of the device
door opener that lacks safety stop and being programmed to HomeLink for quicker
reverse features as required by U.S. training and accurate transmission of the
federal safety standards (this includes radio-frequency signal.
any garage door opener model manu-
factured before April 1, 1982). A garage 1. Position the end of your hand-held trans-
The HomeLink1 Wireless Control System pro- door that cannot detect an object - sig- mitter 1–3 inches (5–14 cm) away from the
vides a convenient way to replace up to three naling the door to stop and reverse - HomeLink button you wish to program
hand-held radio-frequency (RF) transmitters does not meet current U.S. federal while keeping the indicator light in view.
used to activate devices such as gate opera- safety standards. For more information,
contact HomeLink at: 2. Simultaneously press and hold both the
tors, garage door openers, entry door locks,
www.homelink.com. chosen HomeLink and hand-held transmit-
security systems, even home lighting. Addi-
ter buttons until the HomeLink indicator
tional HomeLink information can be found on
light changes from a slow to a rapidly blink-
the Internet at www.homelink.com. Retain the original transmitter of the RF device
ing light. Now you may release both the
you are programming for use in other vehicles
HomeLink and hand-held transmitter but-
as well as for future HomeLink programming. It
tons.
is also suggested that upon the sale of the
vehicle, the programmed HomeLink buttons be
erased for security purposes. Refer to “Erasing
HomeLink Buttons”.

1 HomeLink and the HomeLink house are registered trademarks of Johnson Controls, Inc.

106 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

HomeLink® Wireless Control System*

NOTE found where the hanging antenna wire is cedures, replace “Programming HomeLink”
attached to the motor-head unit. step 2 with the following:
Some devices may require you to replace
this Programming Step 2 with procedures 5. Firmly press and release the “learn” or • Continue to press and hold the HomeLink
noted in the “Gate Operator / Canadian Pro- “smart” button. (The name and color of the button while you press and release -
gramming” section. If the HomeLink indica- button may vary by manufacturer.) There every two seconds (“cycle”) your hand-
tor light does not change to a rapidly blink- are 30 seconds to initiate step 6. held transmitter until the HomeLink indica-
ing light after performing these steps, con- tor light changes from a slow to a rapidly 03
tact HomeLink at www.homelink.com. 6. Return to the vehicle and firmly press, hold blinking light. Now you may release both
for two seconds and release the pro- the HomeLink and hand-held transmitter
grammed HomeLink button. Repeat the buttons.
3. Firmly press, hold for five seconds and
“press/hold/release” sequence a second
release the programmed HomeLink but- Proceed with “Programming” step 3 to com-
time, and, depending on the brand of the
ton up to two separate times to activate the plete.
garage door opener (or other rolling code
door. If the door does not activate, press
equipped device), repeat this sequence a
and hold the just-trained HomeLink button
third time to complete the programming Using HomeLink
and observe the indicator light.
process. To operate, simply press and release the pro-
• If the indicator light stays on con- HomeLink should now activate your rolling grammed HomeLink button. Activation will
stantly, programming is complete now occur for the trained device (i.e., garage
and your device should activate when code equipped device.
door opener, gate operator, security system,
the HomeLink button is pressed and Gate Operator/Canadian Programming entry door lock, home/office lighting, etc.). For
released.
Canadian radio-frequency laws require trans- convenience, the hand-held transmitter of the
• If the indicator light blinks rapidly for mitter signals to “time-out” (or quit) after sev- device may also be used at any time. In the
two seconds and then turns to a con- eral seconds of transmission – which may not event that there are still programming difficul-
stant light continue with “Program- be long enough for HomeLink to pick up the ties or questions, contact HomeLink at:
ming” steps 4-6 to complete the pro- signal during programming. Similar to this www.homelink.com.
gramming of a rolling code equipped Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators are
device (most commonly a garage door designed to “time-out” in the same manner.
opener).
If you live in Canada or you are having difficul-
4. At the garage door opener receiver (motor-
ties programming a gate operator or garage
head unit) in the garage, locate the “learn”
door opener by using the “Programming” pro-
or “smart” button. This can usually be

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 107


03 Your driving environment

HomeLink® Wireless Control System*

Erasing HomeLink Buttons For questions or comments, contact HomeLink


To erase programming from the three Home- at: www.homelink.com or 1–800–355–3515.
Link buttons (individual buttons cannot be This device complies with FCC rules part 15
erased but can be “reprogrammed” as outlined and Industry Canada (IC) RSS-210. Operation
below), follow the step noted: is subject to the following two conditions: (1)
1. Press and hold the two outer HomeLink This device may not cause harmful interfer-
03 ence, and (2) This device must accept any
buttons until the indicator light begins to
flash-after 10 seconds. interference that may be received including
interference that may cause undesired opera-
2. Release both buttons. Do not hold for tion.
longer that 20 seconds.
HomeLink is now in the train (or learning) mode NOTE
and can be programmed at any time beginning
The transmitter has been tested and com-
with “Programming” - step 1. plies with FCC and IC rules. Changes or
modifications not expressly approved by
Reprogramming a Single HomeLink the party responsible for compliance could
void the user’s authority to operate the
Button
device.2
To program a device to HomeLink using a
HomeLink button previously trained, follow
these steps:
1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink but-
ton. DO NOT release the button.
2. The indicator light will begin to flash after
20 seconds. Without releasing the Home-
Link button, proceed with “Programming”
- step 1.

2 The term “IC:” before the certification/registration number only signifies that Industry Canada technical specifications were met.

108 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Starting the engine

Start 1. Press the remote key into the ignition slot WARNING
as far as possible, with the metallic key
blade pointing outward (not inserted into • Always remove the remote key from the
the slot)1. ignition slot when leaving the vehicle,
especially if there are children in the
2. Depress the brake pedal2. vehicle.
3. Press and release the START/STOP • Never remove the remote key from the 03
ENGINE button. The autostart function will ignition slot while driving or when the
operate the starter motor until the engine vehicle is being towed. The steering
starts. lock could otherwise be activated, mak-
ing it impossible to steer the vehicle. On
The starter motor operates for a maximum vehicles with the optional keyless drive,
of 10 seconds. If the engine has not never remove the remote key from the
started, repeat the procedure. vehicle while driving or during towing.
Ignition switch with remote key inserted ( see
page 81 for more information on ignition modes) • Always place the gear selector in Park
NOTE and apply the parking brake before
Keyless drive* leaving the vehicle. Never leave the
WARNING vehicle unattended with the engine run-
Before starting the engine: To start a vehicle equipped with the keyless ning.
drive feature, one of the remote keys must
• Fasten the seat belt. be in the passenger compartment. Follow • Always open garage doors fully before
the instructions in step 3 to start the vehicle. starting the engine inside a garage to
• Check that the seat, steering wheel and
ensure adequate ventilation. The
mirrors are adjusted properly.
exhaust gases contain carbon monox-
• Make sure the brake pedal can be WARNING ide, which is invisible and odorless but
depressed completely. Adjust the seat very poisonous.
if necessary. An extra mat on the driver's floor can cause
the accelerator and/or brake pedal to catch.
Check that the movement of these pedals is
not impeded. Not more than one protective
floor covering may be used at one time.

1 On vehicles with the optional keyless drive, it is only necessary to have a remote key in the passenger’s compartment.
2 If the vehicle is moving, it is only necessary to press the START/STOP ENGINE button to start the vehicle.
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 109


03 Your driving environment

Starting the engine

NOTE CAUTION Switching off the engine


With the engine running, press the START/
• After a cold start, idle speed may be • When starting in cold weather, the auto-
STOP ENGINE button.
noticeably higher than normal for a matic transmission may shift up at
short period. This is done to help bring slightly higher engine speeds than nor- If the gear selector is not in the P position or if
components in the emission control mal until the automatic transmission the vehicle is moving, press the button twice or
system to their normal operating tem- fluid reaches normal operating tem- press and hold it in until the engine switches
03 perature as quickly as possible, which perature. off.
enables them to control emissions and • Do not race a cold engine immediately
help reduce the vehicle's impact on the after starting. Oil flow may not reach
environment3. Jump starting
some lubrication points fast enough to
prevent engine damage.
• The engine should be idling when you
move the gear selector. Never acceler-
ate until after you feel the transmission
engage. Accelerating immediately after
selecting a gear will cause harsh
engagement and premature transmis-
sion wear.
• Selecting P or N when idling at a stand-
still for prolonged periods of time will

G021347
help prevent overheating of the auto-
matic transmission fluid.
Connecting the jumper cables
Follow these instructions to jump start your
vehicle's dead battery or to jump start another
vehicle's dead battery using your vehicle. If the
12-volt auxiliary battery to be used is in another
vehicle, check that the vehicles are not touch-
ing to prevent premature completion of a cir-

3 If the gear selector is in the D or R positions and the car is not moving, engine speed (rpm) will be lower and it will take longer for the engine to reach normal operating temperature.

110
03 Your driving environment

Starting the engine

cuit. Be sure to follow jump starting instruc- WARNING WARNING


tions provided for the other vehicle.
PROPOSITION 65 WARNING! • Do not connect the jumper cable to any
To jump start your vehicle: part of the fuel system or to any moving
Battery posts, terminals, and related acces-
1. Switch off the ignition (set the ignition to sories contain lead and lead compounds, parts. Avoid touching hot manifolds.
mode 0, see page 81). chemicals known to the state of California • Batteries generate hydrogen gas, which
to cause cancer and reproductive harm. is flammable and explosive.
2. First connect the red jumper cable to the 03
Wash hands after handling.
auxiliary battery's positive (+) terminal (1). • Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do
not allow battery fluid to contact eyes,
3. Fold back the cover over the positive (+) CAUTION skin, fabrics or painted surfaces. If con-
terminal on your vehicle's battery (2), tact occurs, flush the affected area
marked with a "+" sign, located under a Connect the jumper cables carefully to immediately with water. Obtain medical
folding cover. avoid short circuits with other components
help immediately if eyes are affected.
in the engine compartment.
4. Connect the black jumper cable to the aux- • Never expose the battery to open flame
iliary battery's negative (–) terminal (3) and or electric spark.
to the ground point in your vehicle's engine • Do not smoke near the battery.
compartment (right engine mount at the
top, on the outer screw) (4).
• Failure to follow the instructions for
jump starting can lead to injury.
5. Start the engine in the assisting vehicle,
then start the engine in the vehicle with
dead battery.
6. After the engine has started, first remove
the negative (–) terminal jumper cable
(black). Then remove the positive (+) termi-
nal jumper cable (red).

111
03 Your driving environment

Transmission

Automatic transmission before the gear lever can be moved from the Apply the parking brake if the vehicle is sta-
P position. tionary with the gear selector in position N.
Always apply the parking brake when the vehi- Drive (D)
cle is parked. Press the control to apply the D is the normal driving position. The car auto-
brake, see page 118. matically shifts between the various forward
03
gears, based on the level of acceleration and
speed. The car must be at a standstill when
shifting from position R to position D.

Geartronic–manual shifting
Geartronic allows you to manually shift among
G021351 your vehicle's six forward speeds. Geartronic
can be selected at any time.
Shiftgate positions1
• To access the manual shifting position
Depress the button on the front of the gear from Drive (D), move the gear selector to
selector knob to move the gear selector the right (to the area marked M in the illus-
between the R, N, D, and P positions. tration.
The gear selector can be moved freely between • To return to the D position from the manual
the Geartronic (manual shifting) and Drive (D) CAUTION shifting position, move the gear selector to
positions while driving. the left.
The vehicle must be stationary when posi-
tion P is selected. While driving
Park position (P)
Select the P position when starting or parking.
• If you select the manual shifting position
while driving, the gear that was being used
Reverse ®) in the Drive position will also initially be
Shiftlock
The vehicle must be stationary when position selected in the manual shifting position.
When P has been selected, the transmission is
R is selected.
mechanically blocked in this position. The • Move the gear selector forward (toward
brake pedal must be depressed and the igni- Neutral position (N) "+") to shift to a higher gear or rearward
tion must be in at least mode II (see page 81) No gear is engaged and the engine can be (toward "–") to shift to a lower gear.
started with the gear selector in this position.
1 The information display (see page 75) shows the gear selector's position or the selected gear by displaying the following: P, R, N, D, S, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.

112
03 Your driving environment

Transmission

• If you hold the gear selector toward "–", the not switch to manual shifting mode until the selector forward again and release it to
transmission will downshift one gear at a gear selector is moved forward or rearward select 3rd gear.
time and will utilize the braking power of toward + or -.
the engine. If the current speed is too high 3. Release the brake pedal and press gently
for using a lower gear, the downshift will Sport mode can be selected any time. on the accelerator pedal.
not occur until the speed has decreased
NOTE Shiftlock override
enough to allow the lower gear to be used.
03
• If you slow to a very low speed, the trans- • When the transmission is in Sport
mission will automatically shift down. mode, the transmission symbol in the
Shiftlock – Neutral (N) main instrument panel will change from
If the gear selector is in the N position and the D to S (see page 75).
vehicle has been stationary for at least 3 sec- • Please be aware that using Sport mode
onds (irrespective of whether the engine is run- may result in a slight decrease in fuel
ning) then the gear selector is locked. economy. Driving in D can help improve
fuel economy.
To be able to move the gear selector from N to
another gear position, the brake pedal must be
depressed and the ignition must be in posi- Geartronic–starting on slippery surfaces
tion II, see page 81. Selecting 3rd gear in Geartronic’s manual shift-
ing mode can help provide better traction when
Geartronic–Sport mode (S)2 starting off on slippery surfaces. To do so: If the vehicle cannot be driven, for example
This transmission mode provides sportier shift- because of a dead battery, the gear selector
ing characteristics and enables a more active 1. Depress the brake pedal and move the must be moved from the P position before the
driving style by making it possible to drive at gear selector to the right from the D posi- vehicle can be moved3.
higher rpm in each gear before shifting up. The tion to the manual shifting position. The
text in the instrument panel display will Lift away the rubber mat on the floor of the
engine also responds faster when the throttle
change from D to 1. storage compartment behind the center
pedal is pressed.
console to expose the small opening for
To access Sport mode from Drive (D), move the 2. Press the gear selector forward and overriding the shiftlock system.
gear selector to the right. The transmission will release it (this selects 2nd gear). Press the

2 Only available on models with the T6 turbo engine.


3 If the battery is dead, the electric parking brake cannot be applied or released. Connect an auxiliary battery if the battery voltage is too low, see page 110.
``

113
03 Your driving environment

Transmission

Insert the key blade into the opening. Press NOTE


the key blade down as far as possible and
keep it held down. Move the gear selector The message AWD disabled Service
from the P position. For information on the required will be appear in the information
display if an electrical fault should occur in
key blade, see page 60.
the AWD system. A warning light will also
illuminate in the instrument panel. If this
03 All Wheel Drive – AWD4 occurs, have the system checked by a
trained and qualified Volvo service techni-
cian.

Your Volvo can be equipped with permanent


All Wheel Drive, which means that power is
distributed automatically between the front
and rear wheels. Under normal driving condi-
tions, most of the engine's power is directed to
the front wheels. However, if there is any ten-
dency for the front wheels to spin, an electron-
ically controlled coupling distributes power to
the wheels that have the best traction.

4 Standard on certain models.

114
03 Your driving environment

Brakes

Brake system Brake pad inspection mirror vated. This function causes an additional tail-
The brake system is a hydraulic system con- light on each side of the vehicle to illuminate to
sisting of two separate brake circuits. If a prob- help alert vehicles traveling behind.
lem should occur in one of these circuits, it is The adaptive brake lights activate if:
still possible to stop the vehicle with the other
brake circuit. • The ABS system activates for more than
approximately a half second 03
If the brake pedal must be depressed farther
• In the event of sudden braking while the
than normal and requires greater foot pressure, vehicle is moving at speeds above approx-
the stopping distance will be longer. imately 6 mph (10 km/h)
A warning light in the instrument panel will light When the vehicle has come to a stop, the brake
up to warn the driver that a fault has occurred. lights and additional taillights remain on for as
If this light comes on while driving or braking, long as the brake pedal is depressed or until
Brake pad inspection mirror braking force on the vehicle is reduced.
stop immediately and check the brake fluid
level in the reservoir. This mirror is used to inspect the brake pads
Power brakes function only when the
on vehicles that are not equipped with the a
jack* and lug wrench*. engine is running
NOTE The power brakes utilize vacuum pressure
Press the brake pedal hard and maintain This mirror is located with the other tools under which is only created when the engine is run-
pressure on the pedal – do not pump the the floor of the cargo compartment (see ning. Never let the vehicle roll to a stop with the
brakes. page 291). engine switched off.
Insert the mirror between the spokes in the If the power brakes are not working, consider-
WARNING wheels to visually inspect the brake pads for ably higher pressure will be required on the
wear. brake pedal to compensate for the lack of
If the fluid level is below the MIN mark in the
reservoir or if a brake system message is power assistance. This can happen for exam-
Brake lights ple when towing your vehicle or if the engine is
shown in the information display: DO NOT
The brake lights come on automatically when switched off when the vehicle is rolling. The
DRIVE. Have the vehicle towed to a trained
and qualified Volvo service technician and the brakes are applied. brake pedal feels harder than usual.
have the brake system inspected. Adaptive brake lights
The adaptive brake lights activate in the event
of sudden braking or if the ABS system is acti-

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 115


03 Your driving environment

Brakes

Water on brake discs and brake pads matically modulated in order to help prevent in order to utilize the system completely. EBA
affects braking lockup that could lead to a skid. is automatically deactivated when the brake
Driving in rain and slush or passing through an pedal is released.
The system performs a brief self-diagnostic
automatic car wash can cause water to collect test when the engine has been started and
on the brake discs and pads. This will cause a driver releases the brake pedal. Another auto- NOTE
delay in braking effect when the pedal is matic test may be performed when the vehicle
03 depressed. To avoid such a delay when the
• When the EBA system is activated, the
first reaches a speed of approximately 6 mph brake pedal will go down and pressure
brakes are needed, depress the pedal occa- (10 km/h). The brake pedal will pulsate several in the brake system immediately increa-
sionally when driving through rain, slush, etc. times and a sound may be audible from the ses to the maximum level. You must
This will remove the water from the brakes. ABS control module, which is normal. maintain full pressure on the brake
Check that brake application feels normal. This pedal in order to utilize the system com-
should also be done after washing or starting Cleaning the brake discs pletely. There will be no braking effect if
in very damp or cold weather. Coatings of dirt and water on the brake discs the pedal is released. EBA is automati-
may result in delayed brake function. This delay cally deactivated when the brake pedal
Severe strain on the brake system is minimized by cleaning the brake linings. is released.
The brakes will be subject to severe strain
when driving in mountains or hilly areas, or Cleaning the brake pads is advisable in wet • When the vehicle has been parked for
weather, prior to long-term parking, and after some time, the brake pedal may sink
when towing a trailer. Vehicle speed is usually
the vehicle has been washed. Do this by brak- more than usual when the engine is
slower, which means that the cooling of the
ing gently for a short period while the vehicle is started. This is normal and the pedal will
brakes is less efficient than when driving on return to its usual position when it is
level roads. To reduce the strain on the brakes, moving.
released.
shift into a lower gear and let the engine help
Emergency Brake Assistance
with the braking. Do not forget that if you are
EBA is designed to provide full brake effect
towing a trailer, the brakes will be subjected to
immediately in the event of sudden, hard brak-
a greater than normal load.
ing. The system is activated by the speed with
Anti-lock braking system (ABS) which the brake pedal is depressed.
The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) helps to When the EBA system is activated, the brake
improve vehicle control (stopping and steering) pedal will go down and pressure in the brake
during severe braking conditions by limiting system immediately increases to the maximum
brake lockup. When the system "senses" level. Maintain full pressure on the brake pedal
impending lockup, braking pressure is auto-

116
03 Your driving environment

Brakes

Symbols in the instrument panel


Symbol Specification
Steady glow – Check the brake
fluid level. If the level is low, fill
with brake fluid and check for
the cause of the brake fluid 03
loss.

Steady glow for two seconds


when the engine is started –
There was a fault in the brake
system's ABS function when
the engine was last running.

WARNING
If and come on at the same time
and the brake level is below the MIN mark
in the reservoir or if a brake system-related
message is shown in the information dis-
play: DO NOT DRIVE. Have the vehicle
towed to a trained and qualified Volvo serv-
ice technician and have the brake system
inspected.

117
03 Your driving environment

Parking brake

Electric parking brake Applying the electric parking brake NOTE


An electric parking brake has the same func-
tion as a manual parking brake.
• In an emergency the parking brake can
be applied when the vehicle is moving
by holding in the control. Braking will be
NOTE interrupted when the accelerator pedal
• A faint sound from the parking brake's is depressed or the control is released.
03
electric motor can be heard when the • An audible signal will sound during this
parking brake is being applied. This procedure if the vehicle is moving at
sound can also be heard during the speeds above 6 mph (10 km/h).
automatic function check of the parking
brake.
Parking on a hill
• The brake pedal will move slightly when • If the vehicle is pointing uphill, turn the front
the electric parking brake is applied or Parking brake control wheels so that they point away from the
released. curb.
1. Press firmly on the brake pedal.
• If the vehicle is pointing downhill, turn the
Low battery voltage 2. Push the control. front wheels so that they point toward the
If the battery voltage is too low, the parking 3. Release the brake pedal and ensure that curb.
brake cannot be applied or released. Connect the vehicle is at a standstill. The parking brake should also be applied.
an auxiliary battery if the battery voltage is too
4. When the vehicle is parked, the gear selec-
low, see page 110.
tor must be in position P.
The symbol in the instrument panel
flashes while the parking bake is being applied,
and glows steadily when the parking brake has
been fully applied.

118
03 Your driving environment

Parking brake

Releasing the electric parking brake NOTE Symbols


• For safety reasons, the parking brake is Symbol Specification
only released automatically if the engine
Read the message in the infor-
is running and the driver is wearing a seat
mation display
belt.
• The electric parking brake will be A flashing symbol indicates that 03
released immediately when the acceler- the parking brake is being
ator pedal is pressed and the gear selec- applied. If the symbol flashes in
tor is in position D or R. any other situation then this
means that a fault has arisen.
2. Fasten the seat belt. Read the message on the infor-
mation display.
3. Move the gear selector to position D or R
Parking brake control
and press the accelerator pedal. The park- Messages
Manual release ing brake will release when the vehicle
1. Fasten the seat belt. begins to move.
2. Insert the remote key in the ignition slot. Heavy load uphill
A heavy load, such as a trailer, can cause the
3. Press firmly on the brake pedal.
vehicle to roll backward when the parking
4. Pull the parking brake control. brake is released automatically on a steep
Vehicles with Keyless drive* incline. To help avoid this:
1. Press the START/STOP ENGINE button. 1. Keep the electric parking brake lever
2. Press firmly on the brake pedal. pushed in with the left hand while shifting
into Drive with the right.
3. Pull the parking brake control.
2. While pressing the throttle pedal to pull
Automatic release away, release the parking brake lever only
1. Start the engine. after the vehicle begins to move. Park brake not fully released – A fault is pre-
venting the parking brake from being released.
Contact an authorized Volvo workshop. If you

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 119


03 Your driving environment

Parking brake

drive off with this error message showing, a


warning signal sounds.
Parking brake not applied – A fault is pre-
venting the parking brake from being applied.
Try to apply and release. Contact a Volvo work-
shop if the message remains.
03
Parking brake Service required – A fault has
occurred. Contact a Volvo workshop if the fault
remains.

WARNING
If the vehicle must be parked before the fault
has been corrected, always put the gear
selector in P and turn the wheels so that
they point away from the curb if the vehicle
is pointing uphill or toward the curb if it is
pointing downhill.

120
03 Your driving environment

Hill Descent Control (HDC)*

Introduction Function Using HDC


Normally, when the accelerator pedal is HDC allows the car to roll forward at a maxi-
released while driving down hills, the vehicle's mum speed of 6 mph (10 km/h), and 4 mph
speed slows as the engine runs at lower rpm (7 km/h) in reverse. However, the accelerator
(the normal engine braking effect). However, if pedal can be used to select any speed that is
the downhill gradient becomes steeper and if possible in first or reverse gears. When the
the vehicle is carrying a load, speed increases accelerator pedal is released, speed is quickly 03
despite the engine braking effect. In this situa- reduced again to 6 mph (10 km/h) or 4 mph
tion, the brakes must be applied to reduce the (7 km/h), depending on the gear selected,
vehicle's speed. regardless of the hill's gradient. It is not nec-
essary to apply the brakes.
HDC is a type of automatic engine brake and
makes it possible to increase or decrease the • The brake lights illuminate automatically
vehicle's speed on downhill gradients using when HDC is controlling the vehicle's
only the accelerator pedal, without applying • HDC can be switched on and off with the speed.
the brakes. The brake system functions auto- button in the center console. An indicator • The driver can slow or stop the vehicle at
matically to maintain a low and steady speed. light in the button illuminates when HDC is any time by applying the brakes.
HDC is particularly useful when driving down activated. HDC is deactivated when:
steep hills with rough surfaces, and where the • The indicator light in the instrument • The button on the center console is
road may have slippery patches. panel illuminates and a message is dis- pressed
played when the system is controlling the
WARNING vehicle's speed. • A gear higher than first gear is selected
• HDC only functions when first or reverse • D is selected on vehicles with an automatic
HDC does not function in all situations, and transmission
is a supplementary braking aid. The driver gears are selected (1 will be shown in the
has full responsibility for driving in a safe instrument panel display when first gear is HDC can be deactivated at any time. If this is
manner. selected). done while driving down a steep hill, the sys-
tem's braking effect will decrease gradually.
NOTE
HDC cannot be activated if the gear selector
is the D position.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 121


03 Your driving environment

Hill Descent Control (HDC)*

NOTE
Engine response to pressure on the accel-
erator pedal may be slightly slower than
normal when HDC is activated.

03

122 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

03

123
Menus and messages........................................................................... 126
The MY CAR menus.............................................................................. 128
Climate system..................................................................................... 134
Trip computer........................................................................................ 142
Stability system..................................................................................... 144
Active chassis system–Four C*............................................................. 146
Cruise control........................................................................................ 147
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)*............................................................ 149
Distance Alert* ..................................................................................... 159
City Safety™ ........................................................................................ 162
Collision warning with Full Auto-brake and Pedestrian Detection*...... 168
Driver Alert System* ............................................................................. 175
Park assist*........................................................................................... 181
Rear Park Assist Camera (PAC)* .......................................................... 185
Blind Spot Information System*............................................................ 189
Passenger compartment convenience................................................. 193

124 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


COMFORT AND DRIVING PLEASURE
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menus and messages

Main instrument panel Average Press READ to acknowledge and scroll among
the messages.
Instantaneous
Average speed NOTE
Current speed in mph (Canadian models If a warning message appears while you are
only) using the trip computer, the message must
Engine oil level* be read and confirmed by pressing READ
before the previous activity can be
Calibrate tire pressure resumed.

04 Message Description
G022908
Messages
Stop safely Stop and switch off
Information display and menu controls the engine. Serious
READ – access to the list of messages and risk of damage.
message confirmation. Contact an author-
Thumbwheel – browse among menus and ized Volvo work-
options in the list of functions. shop.
RESET – reset the active function. Used in Stopping the Stop and switch off
certain cases to select/activate a function, engine the engine. Serious
see the explanation under each respective risk of damage.

G028940
function. Contact an author-
The menus shown on the information displays ized Volvo work-
in the instrument panel are controlled with the shop.
When a warning, information or indicator sym-
left lever. The menus shown depend on ignition
bol comes on, a corresponding message Service urgent Have the vehicle
mode. Press READ to erase a message and
appears on the information display. An error checked by an
return to the menus.
message is stored in a memory list until the authorized Volvo
Menu overview fault is rectified. workshop immedi-
Driving distance on current fuel reserve ately.

126 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menus and messages

Message Description Message Description


Service required Have the vehicle Maintenance over- If the service inter-
checked by an due vals are not fol-
authorized Volvo lowed, the warranty
workshop as soon does not cover any
as possible. damaged parts.
Contact an author-
See manual Read the owner's ized Volvo workshop
manual. for service.
Book time for Time to book service Temporarily OFF A function has been 04
maintenance at an authorized temporarily
Volvo retailer. switched off and is
Time for regular Time for regular reset automatically
service at an author- while driving or after
maintenance
ized Volvo work- starting again.
shop. The timing is Power save mode The audio system is
determined by the switched off to save
number of miles current. Charge the
driven, number of battery.
months since the
last service, engine
running time.

127
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

The MY CAR menus

Introduction Operation • From the main MY CAR menu, press and


The menu system provides access to menus hold EXIT to go to the infotainment sys-
Center console controls tem's main view. See page 204 for addi-
for operating many of the vehicle's functions,
such as setting the clock, door mirrors, locks, tional information.
etc. Steering wheel keypad
Navigatiing in the menus is done using the but-
tons on the center console control panel or with
the right-side steering wheel keypad.
Some of the features mentioned in this section
are optional.
04

Center console controls for menu navigation


Press MY CAR to access the My Car
menus.
The keypad varies according to the vehicle's
Press OK/MENU to select a highlighted equipment
selection or to store a certain function in Turn the thumb wheel to go up/down
the system's memory. among menu selections. Press the thumb
Turn to navigate up/down among menu wheel to make a selection or store a func-
selections. tion in the system's memory.
Press and hold to return to the main menu. EXIT.
Press briefly .
• Press EXIT briefly to go back one step at a Paths
time in the current menu. The current menu level is displayed at the
• Press and hold EXIT to go to the main MY upper right of the center console display. Menu
CAR menu. paths are displayed as follows, for example:

128
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

The MY CAR menus

Settings Car settings Lock settings MY CAR MY CAR Support systems


Doors unlock Driver door, then all All settings connected to driving the
vehicle are found under MY CAR.
The current status of the various driver support
The following is an example of how to set a When the MY CAR symbol has been systems is displayed.
function in the menu system: selected, the following menu alternatives are
displayed. MY CAR Settings Car settings
1. Press the MY CAR button on the center
console control panel.
All of the settings in the vehicle that can be
2. Navigate to a menu, for example
changed by the driver can be found under MY
Settings using the thumb wheel (1) and CAR, where they can be activated/deacti- 04
press it to open a submenu. vated/adjusted. The following pages list the
3. Navigate to the desired submenu such as main menus/submenus and possible selec-
Car settings. tions.
4. Navigate to Lock settings and press the Car key memory
thumb wheel to open a new submenu. See pages 84 and 57 for more information.
5. Navigate to Doors unlock and press the Lock settings
thumb wheel to open a submenu with alter-
natives that can be selected. Automatic door locking
• My XC60
6. Use the thumb wheel to move to the Doors unlock
• Support systems
desired choice and press the thumb wheel All doors
to put an X in the box.
• Settings
Driver door, then all
7. Finish by exiting the menu system either MY CAR My XC60
one step at a time with short presses on Keyless entry
EXIT (2) or press and hold this button to The driver support systems installed in the All doors
return to the main menu. vehicle are displayed and can be activated/
Any door
The OK/MENU (2), EXIT (4) and control (3) in deactivated here.
Doors on same side
the center console can be used in the same
way. Both front doors

``

129
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

The MY CAR menus

See page 57 and 63 for more information. This feature returns the "Car settings" menu to
Home safe light duration
the original factory settings.
Reduced Guard
30 sec
Activate once
60 sec MY CAR Settings Driver support
Ask when exiting systems
90 sec
See page 70 for more information.
See page 93 for more information.
Collision warning
Side mirror settings
Door lock confirmation light Collision Warning
Fold mirrors
See page 57 for more information. Warning distance
Tilt left mirror
04 Long
Tilt right mirror Daytime running lights
Normal
See page 100 for more information. See page 89 for more information.
Short
Light settings Active bending lights
Warning sound
Door lock confirmation light See page 90 for more information.
See page 170 for more information.
Door unlock confirmation light Tire pressure system
Lane departure warning
See page 57 for more information. Warns if tire pressure is too low
Lane departure warning
Approach light duration Calibrate tire pressure
On at start-up
Off See page 294 for more information.
Increased sensitivity
30 sec Steering wheel force
See page 178 for more information.
60 sec High
DSTC
90 sec Medium
See page 144 for more information.
See page 58 for more information. Low
City safety
See page 146 for more information.
See page 162 for more information.
Reset car settings

130
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

The MY CAR menus

BLIS Show help text


MY CAR Settings Voice settingsA.
See page 189 for more information. This displays help texts for the current menu.
A Only on vehicles with the optional Volvo Navigation System
Distance Alert Distance and fuel units and/or a BluetoothŸ-connected cell phone

See page 159 for more information. MPG (UK) Voice tutorial
Driver alert MPG (US) Select this menu alternative and press OK for
See page 175 for more information. km/l spoken information about how the system
works.
l/100km
MY CAR Settings System options Voice command list
See page 142 for more information about the
Phone commands 04
trip computer.
Set/change time
Temperature unit Phone
See page 80 for more information.
Celsius Phone call contact
Time format
Fahrenheit Phone dial number
12 h
Select the temperature scale to be displayed Navigation commands
24 h by the climate control unit. Navigation
Screensaver Volume levels Navigation repeat instruction
The contents of the screen are replaced by Voice output volume Navigation go to address
another image if this selection is marked. The
contents of the screen will be displayed again Park assist front volume General commands
if one of the buttons (1-4) is pressed, see Park assist rear volume Help
page 128.
Phone ringing volume Cancel
Uncheck the selection to turn the screen saver
Reset system options Voice tutorial
off.
This feature returns the "System options" The menu alternatives under Phone
Language
menu to the original factory settings. commands show examples of the voice com-
Select the language for menu texts. mands available when a cell phone is con-

``

131
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

The MY CAR menus

nected to the BluetoothŸ hands-free system. Voice output volume High


See page 237 for more detailed information.
• A volume control will be displayed. To set Low
The menu alternatives under Navigation the volume level:
Recirculation timer
commands show examples of the voice com- 1. Adjust the volume using the thumb wheel
mands available for the optional Volvo Automatic rear defroster
2. Test the setting by pressing OK
Navigation System. Refer to the navigation Interior air quality system
system's manual for detailed information. 3. Store the setting and leave the menu by
pressing EXIT. Reset climate settings
Voice user setting
Voice POI list This feature returns the "Climate settings"
Default setting menu to the original factory settings.
Edit list
04 User 1
The navigation system has a large number of For more information about the climate sys-
User 2 points of interest (POIs). A maximum of 30 POIs tem, see page 134.
can be stored in this list.
Two user profiles can be set, which is useful if
more than one person uses voice commands The menu alternative Voice POI list is only MY CAR Settings Favorites (FAV)
regularly. Default setting resets the factory displayed if the vehicle is equipped with the
settings. optional Volvo Navigation System. Refer to the See page 207 for more information about this
navigation system's manual for detailed infor- feature.
Voice training
mation.
User 1 MY CAR Settings Information
User 2 MY CAR Settings Audio settings
Voice training enables the system to become Number of keys
familiar with the driver's voice and pronuncia- See page 200 for more information about the See page 56 for more information.
tion. A list of phrases is presented on the infotainment system.
screen for the driver to read aloud. When the VIN number
system has registered the driver's pronuncia- MY CAR Settings Climate settings See page 337 for more information.
tion, no additional phrases will be displayed.
DivX® VOD code
After completed voice training, select User 1
Automatic blower adjustment
or User 2 in Voice user setting to set the sys- See page 222 for more information.
tem to the current user. Normal

132
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

The MY CAR menus

Bluetooth software version in car


See page 228 for more information.
Map and software version
Refer to the optional Volvo Navigation System
manual for more information.

04

133
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate system

Introduction NOTE mercially available window washing spray will


also help prevent fogging or misting.
Air conditioning The sunlight sensor monitors which side of
The vehicle is equipped with Electronic Climate the car that is most exposed to sunlight. Temporary shut-off of the air
Control (ECC). The climate control system This can mean that the temperature may conditioning
differ between the right and left-side air
cools, heats or dehumidifies the air in the pas- The air conditioning is momentarily disen-
vents, even if the temperatures set for both
senger compartment. sides of the passenger compartment are the gaged during full-throttle acceleration or when
same. driving uphill with a trailer. This may result in a
NOTE temporary increase in cabin temperature.
• The air conditioning can be switched • The temperature sensor for the passenger Ice and snow
04 off, but to ensure the best possible cli- compartment is located below the climate Always keep the air intake grille at the base of
mate comfort in the passenger com- control panel. the windshield free of snow.
partment and to prevent the windows • The outside (ambient) temperature sensor
from misting, it should always be on. is located on the door mirror. Climate system maintenance
• In warm weather, a small amount of • The humidity sensor* is located in the inte- Special tools and equipment are required to
water may accumulate under the car rior rearview mirror. maintain and carry out repairs on the climate
when it has been parked. This water is system. Work of this type should only be done
condensation from the A/C system and by a trained and qualified Volvo service tech-
NOTE
is normal. nician.
Do not cover or block the sensors with
clothing or other objects. Refrigerant
Sensor location Volvo cares about the environment. The air
• The sunlight sensor is located on the top conditioning system in your car contains a
side of the dashboard. Side windows and laminated panoramic
CFC-free refrigerant – R134a. This substance
roof
will not deplete the ozone layer. The air condi-
To ensure that the air conditioning works opti-
tioning system contains 1.7 lbs (770 g) of
mally, the side windows, and the laminated
R134a. The systems uses PAG oil.
panoramic roof should be closed.
Passenger compartment filter
Fog on the inside of the windows
Replace the cabin air filter with a new one at
The defroster function should be used to
the recommended intervals. Please refer to
remove fog or mist from the inside of the win-
dows. Keeping the windows clean with a com-

134 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate system

your Warranty and Service Records Informa- Materials used in the cabin Air distribution
tion booklet, or consult a trained and qualified The materials used in the cabin have been
Volvo service technician for these intervals. developed to help minimize the amount of dust
The filter should be replaced more often when and make the cabin easier to keep clean. All
driving under dirty and dusty conditions. The floor mats can be easily removed for cleaning.
filter cannot be cleaned and therefore should Use car cleaning products recommended by
always be replaced with a new one. Volvo. See also the information beginning on
page 330.
NOTE
Menu settings
There are different types of cabin air filters. The default settings for four of the climate sys-
Ensure that the correct type is installed. tem's functions can be changed in the menu 04

G032070
system.
Interior Air Quality System (IAQS)
• Blower speed in automatic mode. The incoming air is distributed from 20 different
A multifilter helps reduce gases and particles
in the incoming air, thereby reducing the levels • Recirculation timer for passenger com- vents in the passenger compartment.
of odors and contaminants entering the vehi- partment air.
Air distribution is fully automatic in AUTO
cle. The air quality sensor detects increased • Automatic rear window defrosting. mode.
levels of contaminants in the outside air. When • The optional Interior Air Quality System
the air quality sensor detects contaminated (IAQS). If desired, air distribution can be controlled
outside air, the air intake closes and the air manually, see page 141.
The functions can also be returned to factory
inside the passenger compartment is recircu- settings in the menu system.
lated, i.e. no outside air enters the vehicle. The
filter also cleans recirculated passenger com- See page 128 for a description of the menu
partment air. system.

NOTE
Contact your Volvo retailer for IAQS air filter
replacement intervals.

``

135
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate system

Air vents in the dashboard Air vents in the door pillars

04

Open Closed
Closed Open
Horizontal airflow Horizontal airflow
Vertical airflow Vertical airflow
Direct the outer air vents toward the side win- Direct the outer air vents toward the side win-
dows to defrost. dows to defrost.
Direct the vents into the passenger compart-
ment to help maintain the desired temperature
in the rear seat.

136
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate system

Electronic climate control, ECC

04

Temperature control, driver's side Temperature control, passenger's side


Heated driver's seat* Recirculation
Defroster (maximum effect) AUTO
Blower A/C on/off
Manual air distribution—floor
Manual air distribution—dashboard air
vents
Manual air distribution—defroster
Heated rear window and door mirrors
Heated front passenger's seat*

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 137


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate system

Climate system controls Seat heating will automatically switch off when NOTE
the engine is switched off.
Heated front seats* If the blower is turned off completely, the air
Heated rear seats*1 conditioning is disengaged, which may
result in fogging on the windows.

Air distribution

04

G021376
The current seat temperature is shown in the cen-
ter console display
Heat control for the outboard seating positions
Press the button once for the is done in the same way as for the front seats.
highest heat level – three indi-
cator lights come on. Blower control Manual air distribution—defroster
Press the button twice for a Turn the control clockwise to
increase or counterclockwise Manual air distribution—dashboard air
lower heat level – two indica- vents
tor lights come on. to decrease the blower
speed. If AUTO is selected, Manual air distribution—floor
Press the button three times for the lowest heat blower speed will be regula-
level – one indicator light comes on. The figure consists of three buttons. When a
ted automatically and this will
button is pressed, the corresponding figure will
Press the button four times to switch off the override manual adjustment.
appear in the display with an arrow indicating
heat – no indicator lights come on. which manual air flow has been selected (see

1 Not available on models equipped with the optional integrated booster cushions

138 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate system

the following illustration). See also the air dis- Blower speed in automatic mode can be set A/C – ON/OFF
tribution chart on page 141. under Climate settings Automatic blower When the indicator light in the
adjustment. Choose between Low, Normal button is on, the air condition-
or High. ing is controlled automati-
cally. This cools/heats and
NOTE dehumidifies the incoming air.
When the indicator light in the
Selecting the lowest blower speed may button is off, the air condition-
increases the risk of fog forming on the win- ing is disengaged. Other functions are still con-
dows.
trolled automatically. When maximum
defroster is selected, the air conditioning sys-
04
Temperature control tem is set for maximum blower speed and
The temperatures on the dehumidification.
driver and passenger sides
can be set separately. When Defroster
Air distribution is shown in the center console dis- This function defrosts/de-ices
play the vehicle is started, the
most recent setting is the windshield and front side
Auto resumed. windows. The indicator light
The function automatically in the defroster button lights
regulates cooling, heating, when the function is active.
NOTE
blower speed, recirculation,
and air distribution to main- Heating or cooling cannot be speeded up by
selecting a higher/lower temperature than • Blower speed increases automatically and
tain the chosen temperature. the air conditioning will switch on (if not
the actual temperature required.
If you select one or more man- already on and if the passenger compart-
ual functions, the other func- ment blower is not turned off) to dehumid-
tions continue to be controlled automatically. ify the air in the passenger compartment.
The air quality sensor is engaged and all man- Air conditioning can be switched off by
ual settings are switched off when AUTO is pressing the AC button.
pressed. The display shows AUTO
• Recirculation will not function while defrost
CLIMATE. is engaged.

``

139
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate system

The climate system will return to its previous is selected by automatically switching off the enters the vehicle. The filter also cleans recir-
settings when the defroster function is function after a certain length of time, depend- culated passenger compartment air. When the
switched off. ing on the ambient temperature. Activate/ AUTO button is depressed the air quality sen-
deactivate the function under Climate sor is always engaged.
Recirculation/air quality system settings Recirculation timer. See page Activate or deactivate this function in Climate
Recirculation 128 for a description of the menu system. settings Interior air quality system.
This function can be used to
shut out exhaust fumes, NOTE
smoke, etc., from the passen- NOTE
ger compartment. The air in When Defroster is selected, recirculation is
always deactivated. • The air quality sensor should always be
the passenger compartment engaged in order to obtain the best air
04
is then recirculated, i.e., no air in the passenger compartment.
from outside the car is taken Interior Air Quality System–IAQS*
• Recirculation is limited in cold weather
into the car when this function is activated. The This system consists of a multifilter and an air to avoid fogging.
indicator light in the button will illuminate when quality sensor. The filter helps remove gases
recirculation is selected. and particles from the incoming air, thereby • If the insides of the windows start fog-
ging, disengage the air quality sensor.
reducing the amounts of odors and contami-
If the air in the car recirculates for too long, Use the defroster function to increase
nants entering the vehicle. The air quality sen-
there is a risk of condensation forming on the airflow to the front, side, and rear win-
sor detects increased levels of contaminants in
insides of the windows, especially in winter. dows.
the outside air. When the air quality sensor
Timer detects contaminated outside air, the air intake
The timer function minimizes the risk of fog- closes and the air inside the passenger com-
ging, or stale air when the recirculation function partment is recirculated, i.e., no outside air

140 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate system

Air distribution table


Air distribution Use Air distribution Use
Air to windows. Some air To remove de-fog/de- Air to the floor and windows. To ensure comfortable
flows from the dashboard ice the front side win- Some air flows from the conditions and good de-
air vents. The air is not dows and windshield dashboard air vents. fogging in cold or humid
recirculated. Air condition- quickly. weather.
ing is always engaged.

Air to windshield and side In cold or humid Air to floor and from dash- In sunny weather with
windows. Some air flows weather (blower board air vents. cool outside tempera- 04
from the air dashboard speed should be tures.
vents. moderate to high).

Airflow to windows and To ensure good com- Air to floor. Some air flows to To warm or cool the feet.
from dashboard air vents. fort in warm, dry the dashboard air vents and
weather. windows.

Airflow to the head and To ensure efficient Airflow to windows, from To cool the feet or pro-
chest from the dashboard cooling in warm dashboard air vents and to vide warmer air to the
air vents. weather. the floor. upper body in cold
weather or hot, dry
weather.

141
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Trip computer

Introduction Functions updated every few seconds. When the vehicle


is stationary, "----" appears on the display.
NOTE
Average fuel consumption
If a warning message appears while you are The average fuel consumption since the last
using the trip computer, this message must reset. Reset using RESET.
be acknowledged in order to return to the
trip computer function. Acknowledge a Driving distance on current fuel reserve
message by pressing READ. This function shows the approximate distance
that can be driven on the fuel remaining in the
To change the unit of measure specified for tank. The calculation is based on average fuel
04 distance and speed, contact an authorized consumption during the last 20 miles (30 km)
G022909
Volvo workshop. of driving and the amount of fuel remaining in
the tank when the reading was taken. When the
Information display and controls Average speed message ---- miles to empty tank appears in
READ–press to acknowledge/confirm/ The system calculates the average speed from the display, refuel as soon as possible.
erase a message) the last resetting. Reset using RESET.
Thumb wheel (used to scroll among the trip Current speed in mph (Canadian models NOTE
computer menus) only) The actual distance that can be driven on
RESET–resets certain functions This function provides the driver with an instan- the usable fuel remaining in the tank may be
taneous conversion of the car's current speed influenced by a change in driving style.
To scroll through trip computer information,
from km/h to mph.
move the thumb wheel up or down. Continue
See also page 246 for information on driving
turning to return to the starting point. Current speed in km/h (U.S. models only) economically.
This function provides the driver with an instan-
taneous conversion of the car's current speed Resetting
from mph to km/h. 1. Select --- mph average speed or --.-
mpg average.
Current fuel consumption
2. Press and hold RESET for approx. 1 sec-
(Instantaneous)
ond to reset the selected function. If
Current fuel consumption is calculated every
RESET is kept depressed for at 3 three
second. The information on the display is

142
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Trip computer

seconds, Average speed and Average fuel


consumption are reset simultaneously.

04

143
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Stability system

Introduction Spin control (SC) pedal and steering wheel for sportier driving by
The Dynamic Stability and Traction Control The spin control function is designed to help allowing more lateral movement of the rear
system (DSTC) consists of a number of func- prevent the drive wheels from spinning while wheels before DSTC is activated.
tions designed help reduce wheel spin, coun- the vehicle is accelerating. Under certain circumstances, such as when
teract skidding, and to generally help improve driving with snow chains, or driving in deep
directional stability. Engine Drag Control (EDC)
snow or loose sand, it may be advisable to
EDC helps keep the engine running if the
wheels show a tendency to lock, e.g., when temporarily use Sport mode for maximum
CAUTION shifting down in the Geartronic manual shifting tractive force.
A pulsating sound will be audible when the mode or while using the engine's braking func- If the driver releases pressure on the acceler-
system is actively operating and is normal. tion on a slippery surface. If the engine were to ator pedal, DSTC will also activate to help sta-
04 stop, power steering would not function, mak- bilize the vehicle.
Traction control (TC) ing the vehicle more difficult to steer.
To switch to Sport mode:
This function is designed to help reduce wheel
Trailer Stability Assist – TSA* 1. Press the My Car button in the center con-
spin by transferring power from a drive wheel
Trailer Stability Assist helps stabilize a vehicle sole control panel and select My XC60
that begins to lose traction to the wheel on the
that is towing a trailer when the vehicle and DSTC in the menu.
opposite side of the vehicle (on the same axle).
trailer have begun to sway. See page 263 for
TC is most active at low speeds. more information. 2. Unselect the symbol by pressing OK/
MENU and press EXIT to leave the menu.
This is one of DSTC's permanent functions and This system is automatically deactivated if the
cannot be switched off. driver selects Sport mode. > This puts DSTC in Sport mode.
Sport mode remains active until the driver
Active Yaw Control (AYC) switches it off in the menu or until the engine is
This function helps maintain directional stabil- Operation
switched off. DSTC will return to normal mode
ity, for example when cornering, by braking when the engine is restarted.
Sport mode
one or more of the wheels if the vehicle shows
The stability system is always activated and
a tendency to skid or slide laterally. Symbols in the instrument panel
cannot be switched off.
This is one of DSTC's permanent functions and If the symbols and are displayed
However, the driver can select Sport mode,
cannot be switched off. at the same time, read the message in the
which offers more active driving characteris-
information display.
tics. In this mode, the engine management sys-
tem monitors movement of the accelerator

144 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Stability system

1. Stop the vehicle in a safe place and turn off


The symbol is displayed in the main
the engine.
instrument panel when Sport mode has been
activated. 2. Restart the engine.
If the message remains when the engine is
If the symbol appears alone, it may
restarted, drive to an authorized Volvo work-
appear as follows:
shop to have the system inspected.
• If the symbol flashes, this indicates that the
stability system is actively functioning to
help counteract wheel spin and/or a skid.
• If the symbol remains on for approximately 04
2 seconds after the engine has been
started, this indicates that the system is
performing a self-diagnostic test.

WARNING
The stability system is intended to help
improve driving safety. It supplements, but
can never replace, the driver's judgment
and responsibility when operating the vehi-
cle. Speed and driving style should always
be adapted to traffic and road conditions.

Messages in the information display


DSTC Temporarily OFF – system function
has been temporarily reduced due to high
brake disc temperature. The function is acti-
vated automatically when the brakes have
cooled.
DSTC Service required – the system has
been disabled due to a fault. If this occurs:

145
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Active chassis system–Four C*

Active chassis (Four C) ing is done at high rpm in each gear for Speed-dependent steering force*
Active chassis, Four-C (Continuously Con- dynamic and active driving. Steering force increases with the speed of the
trolled Chassis Concept)1, regulates the cha- vehicle to give the driver enhanced sensitivity.
Operation
racteristics of the shock absorbers so that the At low speed the vehicle is easy to steer in
car's driving characteristics can be adjusted. order to facilitate parking, etc.
There are three settings: Comfort, Sport and Steering force can be changed under MY CAR
Advanced.
Car settings Steering wheel force.
Select Low, Medium or High. For a descrip-
NOTE tion of the menu system, see page 128.
This system is available on Canadian mod-
04 els only. NOTE
This steering force level menu function can-
Comfort not be accessed when the vehicle is in
Comfort mode offers a somewhat softer ride motion.
and the transmission shifts gears at lower rpm.
This mode is particularly suitable for long-dis- Chassis settings
tance highway driving. The indicator light in the Use the buttons in the center console to
button will be on when this mode is selected. change setting. The setting in use when the
engine is switched off is activated the next time
Sport the engine is started.
In this mode, the vehicle's body sway is
reduced during cornering and steering
response is more immediate. The transmission
shifts up at higher rpm for sportier driving. The
indicator light in the button will be on to indi-
cate that Sport mode has been selected.

Advanced
In this mode, body sway in curves is minimal
and steering response is very direct. Gear shift-
1 Available as an option on Canadian models only

146 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Cruise control

Operation > The symbol illuminates and the text NOTE


(---) mph (5) indicates that cruise con-
trol is in standby mode. • A temporary increase in speed by
pressing the accelerator pedal, for less
than 1 minute (e.g. when passing
NOTE another car), does not affect the current
This does not set the vehicle's speed. cruise control setting. The vehicle will
automatically return to the previously
set speed when the accelerator pedal is
Setting a speed released.
Use the or buttons set the vehicle's cur-
• If one of the cruise control buttons is
rent speed. The set speed is shown in the dis- kept depressed for more than approx. 04
G022910
play. 1 minute cruise control is disengaged.
The engine must then be switched off in
Steering wheel-mounted controls and display NOTE order to reset cruise control.
Standby mode
Cruise control cannot be engaged at
Resume set speed speeds below 20 mph (30 km/h). Automatic deactivation
Cruise control is automatically deactivated
Deactivating temporarily if one of the following occurs:
Adjusting the set speed
Activate/set speed After a speed has been set, it can be increased • If the speed drops below approximately
or decreased by using the or buttons. 20 mph (30 km/h).
Set speed indicator (parentheses indicate
standby mode) 1. Press and hold down or until the • When the brake pedal is depressed.
vehicle reaches the desired speed. • If the gear selector is moved to position N.
Engaging the cruise control function
> This will become the set speed when the • During wheel spin or wheel lock-up.
Before a speed can be set, the cruise control
system must be engaged (put in standby
button is released. • If the vehicle's speed is increased by using
mode). the accelerator pedal for more than
2. Press or for approximately a half
1 minute.
 Press the CRUISE button (1). second and release the button to increase
or decrease vehicle speed by approxi- The currently set speed will be saved in the
mately 1 mph (1.6 km/h). system's memory.

``

147
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Cruise control

Temporary deactivation
The driver can temporarily deactivate cruise
control by pressing 0. The saved speed is
shown in brackets in the information display.

Resume set speed


If cruise control has been deactivated tempo-
rarily, it can be reactivated by pressing . The
vehicle's speed returns to the most recently set
speed.
04
WARNING
There may be a significant increase in speed
after the button has been pressed.

Deactivation
Cruise control is disengaged by pressing
CRUISE, or by switching off the engine. The
set speed is cleared.

WARNING
Cruise control should not be used in heavy
traffic or when driving on wet or slippery
roads. Cruise control may not maintain set
speed on steep downgrades.

148
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)*

Introduction WARNING Function


Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) is an optional
system designed to assist the driver by main-
• Adaptive Cruise Control cannot cover
all driving situations and traffic, weather
taining a set speed or a set time interval to the and road conditions. The "Function"
vehicle ahead. It is primarily intended for use section provides information about lim-
on long straight roads in steady traffic, such as itations that the driver must be aware of
on highways and other main roads. before using this feature.
When the driver has set the desired speed and • This system is designed to be a supple-
the time interval to the vehicle ahead, ACC mentary driving aid. It is not, however,
functions as follows: intended to replace the driver's atten-
tion and judgement. The driver is 04

G021412
• If there are no other vehicles in the lane responsible for maintaining a safe dis-
ahead of you, your vehicle will travel at the
tance and speed and must intervene if
set speed. Function overview
Adaptive Cruise Control does not main-
• If ACC's radar sensor detects a slower tain a suitable speed or suitable dis- Warning light, braking by driver required
moving vehicle in the lane ahead, the sys- tance to the vehicle ahead.
tem will adapt your vehicle's speed to help Controls in steering wheel
maintain the set time interval to the vehicle • Maintenance of ACC components may
only be performed by a trained and Radar sensor in front grille
ahead. When there are no longer slower
qualified Volvo technician.
moving vehicles ahead, your vehicle will Adaptive Cruise Control consists of:
accelerate to resume the set speed.
If ACC is switched off completely or in standby
• A cruise control system to maintain a set
speed
mode and your vehicle comes too close to
another vehicle ahead, the driver will be • A system to maintain a set distance to the
warned by the Distance Alert system (see vehicle ahead, which is expressed as a
time interval. For example, you can choose
page 159).
to remain approximately 2 seconds behind
the vehicle ahead. The actual distance
required to maintain a 2-second interval
will vary according the speed of the vehi-
cles.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 149


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)*

WARNING WARNING WARNING


• Adaptive Cruise Control is not a colli- The brake pedal moves when the adaptive When Adaptive Cruise Control is in standby
sion avoidance system. The driver is cruise control system modulates the mode or is switched off completely, the
always responsible for applying the brakes. Do not rest your foot under the brakes will not be modulated automatically.
brakes if the system does not detect brake pedal. The driver must assume full control over the
another vehicle. vehicle.

• Adaptive Cruise Control does not react The ACC system is designed to smoothly reg-
to people or animals, or small vehicles ulate speed. However, the driver must apply Warning light—driver braking required
such as bicycles and motorcycles. It the brakes in situations that require immediate Adaptive Cruise Control can exert brake force
also does not react to slow moving, braking. This applies when there are great dif- that is equivalent to approximately 40% of the
04 parked or approaching vehicles, or sta- ferences in speed between vehicles, or if the vehicle's total braking capacity. In situations
tionary objects. vehicle ahead brakes suddenly. requiring more brake force than ACC can pro-
• Do not use Adaptive Cruise Control in vide and if the driver does not apply the brakes,
demanding driving conditions such as WARNING an audible signal from the Collision Warning
city driving or other heavy traffic situa- system will sound and warning light will illumi-
Due to limitations in the radar sensor, brak- nate (see page 169) in the windshield to alert
tions, in slippery conditions, when there ing may occur unexpectedly or not at all,
is a great deal of water or slush on the see page 155. the driver to react.
road, during heavy rain or snow, in poor
visibility, on winding roads or on high- NOTE
way on- or off-ramps. Adaptive Cruise Control can be put in active
mode at any permitted speed. However, if the Strong sunlight, reflections, extreme light
vehicle's speed falls below 18 mph (30 km/h) contrasts, the use of sunglasses, or if the
The distance to the vehicle ahead (in the same or if engine speed (rpm) becomes too low, ACC driver is not looking straight ahead may
lane) is monitored by a radar sensor. Your vehi- make the visual warning signal in the wind-
disengages (goes into standby mode) and will
cle's speed is regulated by accelerating and shield difficult to see.
no longer modulate the brakes. The driver will
braking. The brakes may emit a sound when then have to maintain a safe distance to the
they are being modulated by the adaptive vehicle ahead.
cruise control system. This is normal.

150 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)*

WARNING Operation Putting ACC in standby mode


Before ACC can be used to regulate speed
Adaptive Cruise Control only warns of vehi- and/or the distance to a vehicle ahead, it must
cles detected by the radar sensor, see
page 155. In some cases there may be no first be put in standby mode.
warning or the warning may be delayed. The To do so:
driver should always apply the brakes when
necessary. Press .
The symbol appears in the display and
Steep inclines and/or heavy loads parentheses (---) indicate that ACC is in
ACC is primarily intended for use on fairly level standby mode.
roads. The system may have difficulty main- 04
taining the correct distance to a vehicle ahead
NOTE
on steep inclines, if the vehicle is carrying a
heavy load or is towing a trailer. In these situa- Controls and display The driver's door must be closed and the
tions, the driver should always be prepared to Resume previous settings, increase speed driver's seat belt must be fastened before
apply the brakes if necessary. (each additional press increases speed by ACC can be put in active mode. If the driv-
er's seat belt is taken off or if the driver's
1 mph (approximately 2 km/h). door is opened, ACC will return to standby
Standby mode on/off mode.

Set time interval


Setting a speed
Put in active mode and set a speed Once ACC has been put in standby mode, use
Set speed (parentheses indicate standby the or buttons to store (set) the vehicle's
mode) current speed. This puts the system in active
mode. The set speed, for example 55 mph, is
Time interval while it is being set shown in the display.
Time interval after it has been set

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 151


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)*

NOTE NOTE Different time intervals can be


selected and are shown in the
Adaptive cruise control cannot be put in • If one of the Adaptive Cruise Control display as 1–5 horizontal bars.
active mode at speeds below 20 mph buttons is pressed for more than The greater the number of
(30 km/h). approximately one minute, ACC will be bars, the longer the time inter-
deactivated. The engine must then be val. One bar represents a time
When the symbol on the switched off and restarted to reset ACC.
interval of approximately
left side of the display • In some situations Adaptive Cruise 1 second; 5 bars is approximately
changes to , the radar sen- Control cannot be put in active mode. 2.5 seconds. At low speeds, when the distance
sor has detected another Cruise control Unavailable is shown to the vehicle ahead is short, ACC increases
in the display, see page 157. the time interval slightly. In order to follow the
04
vehicle ahead. The distance
to a vehicle ahead is only vehicle ahead as smoothly as possible, ACC
regulated when this symbol ( ) is illumi- Setting a time interval allows the time interval to vary considerably in
The set time interval to vehicles ahead can be certain situations.
nated.
increased by pressing and decreased by
Changing the set speed pressing . The current time interval is shown WARNING
After a speed has been set, it can be increased
briefly in the display following adjustment. • Only use a time interval that is suitable
or decreased by using the or buttons. in current traffic conditions.
Each time one of these buttons is pressed, the
vehicle's speed changes by 5 mph
• A short time interval gives the driver lim-
ited reaction time if an unexpected sit-
(approximately 8 km/h). uation occurs in traffic.
When the system is in active mode, the but-
ton has the same function as , but results in
a smaller increase in speed.

The number of bars indicating the selected


time interval are shown while the setting is

152 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)*

being made and for several seconds afterward. • if the accelerator pedal is depressed for Queue Assist*
A smaller version of the symbol is then shown more than 1 minute. The following functions are linked to your vehi-
to the right in the display. The same symbol is cle's automatic transmission and comprise the
also displayed when Distance Alert is in active NOTE Queue Assist feature.
mode, see page 159 .
If the accelerator pedal is only depressed for Please note that the lowest speed that can be
Standby mode (temporary deactivation) a short time, such as when passing another set is 18 mph (30 km/h), although ACC can
vehicle, ACC is deactivated temporarily and maintain a set speed/distance to a vehicle
Press to temporarily deactivate cruise con- is reactivated when the pedal is released. ahead down to a standstill.
trol (put it in standby mode). The set speed, for
example 55 mph, is then shown in parenthe- Enhanced speed interval
ses. Automatic standby mode
Your vehicle can maintain the set time interval
Adaptive cruise control is linked to other sys- 04
The previously set speed and time interval are to the vehicle ahead at any permissible speed,
tems such as the stability and traction control
including a complete stop.
resumed by pressing . system (DSTC). If this system is not functioning
properly, adaptive cruise control is automati- In order to activate ACC at speeds below
WARNING cally deactivated and will go into standby 18 mph (30 km/h):
mode.
There may be a significant increase in speed • The vehicle ahead must be within a rea-
after the button has been pressed. In the event of automatic deactivation, an audi- sonable distance (not farther away than
ble signal will sound and the message Cruise approx. 100 ft/30 meters)

When ACC is in active mode, the vehicle’s


control Cancelled is shown in the display. • The lowest speed that can be selected is
The driver must then intervene and adapt the 18 mph (30 km/h), although ACC will also
speed increases by approximately 1 mph help maintain the set time interval to the
vehicle's speed to the surrounding traffic and
(1 km/h) each additional time is pressed. regulate the distance to the vehicle ahead. vehicle ahead at lower speeds, including a
complete stop.
Standby mode due to action by the driver An automatic switch to standby mode may be
ACC is temporarily deactivated and put in caused if: During short stops (less than approximately
standby mode: 3 seconds) in slow-moving traffic, your vehicle
• the wheels lose traction will begin moving again automatically as soon
• when the brakes are applied • brake temperature is high as the vehicle ahead begins to move.
• if the driver's seat belt is taken off • the radar sensor is obstructed by, for If it takes more than 3 seconds for the vehicle
• If the driver's door is opened example, wet snow or rain. ahead to begin moving, ACC will be automati-
• if the gear selector is moved to N cally go into standby mode.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 153


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)*

The driver will then have to reactivate ACC in Automatic standby mode when ACC • Your vehicle's speed goes below 10 mph
one of the following ways: changes target vehicles (15 km/h) and ACC cannot determine if the
target object is a stationary vehicle or some
• By pressing other type of object such as e.g., a speed
• By accelerating up to at least 3 mph bump.
(4 km/h) • Your vehicle's speed goes below 10 mph
Your vehicle will then resume following the (15 km/h) and the vehicle ahead turns so
vehicle ahead at the set time interval. that ACC no longer has a target vehicle to
follow.
NOTE No automatic braking when at a
04 ACC can remain active and keep your vehi- standstill
cle at a standstill for up to 2 minutes. After If the vehicle ahead turns suddenly, there may be In certain situations, ACC will no longer apply
2 minutes have elapsed, the parking brake a stationary vehicle ahead the brakes and go into standby mode while the
will be engaged and ACC will go into The following only applies at speeds below vehicle is not moving. This means that the
standby mode. approximately 18 mph (30 km/h): driver will have to apply the brakes.
To reactivate ACC, the driver must release If ACC changes target vehicles (the vehicle that This happens if:
the parking brake (see page 119) and press
the radar sensor has detected) from a moving • The driver presses the brake pedal
.
vehicle to a stationary one, the system will
apply the brakes in your vehicle. • The parking brake is activated
• The gear selected is moved to P,N or R
WARNING • The driver presses the button to put
At speeds above 18 mph (30 km/h), ACC ACC in standby mode
will not react to a stationary vehicle and The parking brake is applied
apply the brakes but will instead accelerate automatically
to the previously set speed. The driver must
actively apply the brakes to stop the vehicle.
In certain situations, ACC will apply the parking
brake in order to continue keeping the vehicle
at a standstill.
ACC disengages and goes into standby mode
if: This happens if:

154 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)*

• The driver opens the door or takes off WARNING Situations where ACC may not function
his/her seat belt optimally
Accessories or other objects, such as extra
• DSTC is put in Sport mode (see page 144) headlights, must not be installed in front of
• ACC has kept the vehicle at a standstill for the grille. WARNING
more than 2 minutes Modification of the radar sensor could make • The radar sensor has a limited field of
• The engine has been switched off its use illegal. vision. In some situations it may detect
• The brakes have overheated a vehicle later than expected or not
The radar sensor's capacity to detect vehicles detect other vehicles at all.
Turning ACC off completely ahead is impeded: • If ACC is not functioning properly,
• From standby mode, press once. cruise control will also be disabled.
• if the radar sensor is obstructed and can- 04
• From active mode, press twice. not detect other vehicles, for example in
The set speed and time interval are then heavy rain, or if snow or other objects are
cleared from the system's memory and cannot obscuring the radar sensor.
be resumed by pressing .
NOTE
The radar sensor and its limitations Keep the area in front of the radar sensor
clean.
In addition to being used by ACC, the radar
sensor is also used by Distance Alert (see
page 159) and Collision Warning with Full • if the speed of vehicles ahead is signifi-
cantly different from your own speed.
Auto-brake and Pedestrian Detection (see
page 168). This sensor is designed to detect
cars or larger vehicles driving in the same
direction as your vehicle, in the same lane.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 155


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)*

In curves, the radar sensor may detect the WARNING


wrong vehicle or lose sight of the target
vehicle. • Adaptive Cruise Control is not a colli-
sion avoidance system. The driver is
always responsible for applying the
WARNING brakes if the system does not detect
• Adaptive Cruise Control cannot cover another vehicle.
all driving situations and traffic, weather • Adaptive Cruise Control does not react
and road conditions. The "Function" to people or animals, or small vehicles
section provides information about lim- such as bicycles and motorcycles. It
itations that the driver must be aware of also does not react to slow moving,
04 before using this feature. parked or approaching vehicles, or sta-
• This system is designed to be a supple- tionary objects.
mentary driving aid. It is not, however, • Do not use Adaptive Cruise Control in
intended to replace the driver's atten- demanding driving conditions such as
tion and judgement. The driver is city driving or other heavy traffic situa-
responsible for maintaining a safe dis- tions, in slippery conditions, when there
tance and speed and must intervene if is a great deal of water or slush on the
Adaptive Cruise Control does not main- road, during heavy rain or snow, in poor
tain a suitable speed or suitable dis- visibility, on winding roads or on high-
tance to the vehicle ahead. way on- or off-ramps.
Radar sensor's field of vision (dark gray) • Maintenance of ACC components may
only be performed by a trained and
In certain situations, the radar sensor can- qualified Volvo technician. Fault tracing and actions
not detect vehicles at close quarters, for
If the message Radar blocked See manual is
example a vehicle that suddenly enters the
displayed, this means that the radar signals
lane between your vehicle and the target
from the sensor have been obstructed and that
vehicle.
a vehicle ahead cannot be detected.
Small vehicles, such as motorcycles, or
vehicles not driving in the center of the lane This, in turn, means that the functions of the
may remain undetected. ACC, Distance Alert, and Collision Warning
System with Auto-brake will not function.

156 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)*

The table lists possible causes for this mes- sage being displayed, and suitable actions.

Cause Action
The surface of the radar in the grille is dirty or obstructed in some way. Clean the radar surface, or remove the object causing the obstruction.

Heavy rain or snow is interfering with the radar signals. No action possible. Heavy precipitation may affect the function of the
radar.

Swirling water or snow from the surface of the road may interfere with No action possible. A very wet or snow-covered road surface may affect
the radar signals. the function of the radar. 04
The surface of the radar is clean but the message remains in the display. Wait a short time. It may take several minutes for the radar to detect that
it is no longer obstructed.

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Description
- Standby mode or active mode when no other vehicle has been detected.

- Active mode with a detected vehicle to which ACC is adapting speed/distance.

- Time interval while it is being set.

- Time interval after it has been set.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 157


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)*

Symbol Message Description


- Turn on DSTC to enable ACC cannot be put in active mode if the stability system DSTC is in Sport mode. Switch DSTC to
Cruise normal operating mode, see page 144 for more information.
ACC cannot be put in active mode if the stability system DSTC's Spin control is switched off. See
page 144 for more information.

- Cruise control Cancelled ACC has been automatically switched off.


The driver must regulate the vehicle’s speed/distance to the vehicle ahead.

04 - Cruise control Unavailable ACC cannot be put in active mode. This may be due to:
• high brake temperature
• the radar sensor is obstructed (by heavy rain, snow, etc.)
Radar blocked See manual ACC has been temporarily disconnected because the radar is obstructed in some way and cannot
detect other vehicles.
See page 155 for information on the radar sensor’s limitations.

Cruise control Service ACC is not functioning.


required Contact a trained and qualified Volvo service technician.

Press Brake To hold + an The vehicle is at a standstill and ACC will release the brakes before the parking brake engages to keep
audible signal the vehicle stopped but a problem with the parking brake means that the vehicle may begin to roll.
The driver will have to apply the brakes. The message will remain in the display and the audible signal
will continue until the driver applies the brakes or presses the accelerator pedal.

– Below 20 mph Only follow- This is displayed if you try to activate ACC at speeds below approx. 18 mph (30 km/h) without a vehicle
ing ahead within range (approx. 100 ft/30 meters).

158 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Distance Alert*

Introduction NOTE Depending on the optional equipment


Distance Alert is part of Adaptive Cruise Con- selected, there may not be room for a Distance
Distance Alert only monitors distance to the Alert button in the center console. In this case,
trol and is a function that provides information vehicle ahead while Adaptive Cruise Control
about the time interval to the vehicle ahead. the function is controlled through the menu
is in standby mode or off.
system. Press MY CAR and go to Settings
Distance Alert is active at speeds above
Car settings Distance alert On/Off.
approximately 18 mph (30 km/h). Time interval WARNING
information is only given for a vehicle that is Setting a time interval
driving ahead of your vehicle in the same direc- Distance Alert only indicates the distance to
tion. No information is provided for vehicles the vehicle ahead. It does not affect the
driving toward you, moving very slowly, or at a speed of your vehicle.
standstill. 04
Operation

Controls and display


Time interval: Increase/decrease
Time interval: On, while it is being set
Amber warning light Time interval: On, after it has been set
An amber warning light in the windshield glows Press the button in the center instrument panel Press to increase the interval or to
steadily if your vehicle is closer to the one to switch this function on or off. The indicator
ahead than the set time interval. decrease it.
light in the button illuminates when the function
is on.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 159


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Distance Alert*

Five different time intervals WARNING WARNING


can be selected and are
shown in the display as 1–5 Only use a time interval that is suitable in • Bad weather or winding roads may
horizontal bars. The greater current traffic conditions. affect the radar sensor’s capacity to
the number of bars, the longer detect vehicles ahead.
the time interval. One bar rep-
Limitations • The size of the vehicle ahead, such as a
resents approximately motorcycle, may also make it difficult to
1 second to the vehicle ahead; 5 bars is Distance Alert uses the same radar sensor detect. This may result in the warning
approximately 2.5 seconds. used by Adaptive Cruise Control and the Col- light illuminating at a shorter distance
lision Warning system. See page 155 for more than the one that has been set, or that
The number of bars indicating information on the radar sensor’s limitations. the light will not come on at all.
04 the selected time interval are
shown while the setting is NOTE
being made and for several
seconds afterward. A smaller Strong sunlight, reflections, extreme light
version of the symbol is then contrasts, the use of sunglasses, or if the
driver is not looking straight ahead may
shown to the right in the dis-
make the visual warning signal in the wind-
play. The same symbol is displayed when shield difficult to see.
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) is activated.

NOTE
• The higher your vehicle’s speed, the
greater the distance to the vehicle
ahead, measured in feet (meters), for a
given time interval.
• The set time interval is also used by
Adaptive Cruise Control, see page 151.

160 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Distance Alert*

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Description
- Time interval while it is being set.

- Time interval after it has been set.

Radar blocked See manual Distance Alert has been temporarily disconnected because the radar is obstructed in some way and
cannot detect other vehicles. See page 155 for information on the radar sensor’s limitations.
04
Collision warn. Service Distance Alert or Collision Warning with Full Auto-brake and Pedestrian Detection is not functioning
required properly. Contact a trained and qualified Volvo service technician.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 161


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

Introduction means that the system cannot help the driver WARNING
City Safety™1 is a support system designed to in all situations.
help the driver avoid low speed collisions when
• City Safety™ is a supplemental aid to
City Safety™ should not be used to alter the the driver. It can never replace the
driving in slow-moving, stop-and-go traffic. way in which the driver operates the vehicle. driver’s attention to traffic conditions or
City Safety™ is not active if your vehicle’s The driver should never rely solely on this sys- his/her responsibility for operating the
speed is below approximately 2 mph (4 km/h). tem to safely stop the vehicle. vehicle in a safe manner.
This means that City Safety™ will not react if Normally, the occupants of the vehicle will not • City Safety™ does not function in all
your vehicle approaches another vehicle at be aware of City Safety™ except when the driving situations or in all traffic, weather
very low speed, for example, when parking. system intervenes when a low-speed collision or road conditions.
The function is active at speeds ranging from is imminent. • City Safety™ only reacts to vehicles
04 traveling in the same direction as your
approximately 2-18 mph (4-30 km/h) and If the vehicle is also equipped with the optional
assists the driver by applying the brakes auto- Collision Warning with Full Auto-brake and vehicle and does not react to small vehi-
matically, thereby avoiding or helping to cles, bicycles or motorcycles or to peo-
Pedestrian Detection system, the two systems
reduce the effects of a collision. ple or animals.
interact. For more information about the Colli-
City Safety™ is designed to intervene as late sion Warning with Auto-brake system, see • City Safety™ is not activated when your
page 168. vehicle is backing up.
as possible to help avoid unnecessary activa-
tion. • City Safety™ functions at speeds up to
18 mph (30 km/h). This system can help
City Safety™ triggers brief, forceful braking if a prevent a collision if the difference in
low-speed collision is imminent. However, the speed between your vehicle and the
system will not intervene in situations where vehicle ahead is less than 9 mph
the driver actively steers the vehicle or applies (15 km/h). If the difference in speed is
the brakes, even if a collision cannot be avoi- greater, a collision cannot be avoided
ded. This is done in order to always give the but the speed at which the collision
driver’s actions highest priority. occurs can be reduced. The driver must
apply the vehicle’s brakes for full brak-
City Safety™ activates in situations where the
ing effect.
driver has not applied the brakes in time, which
• Never wait for City Safety™ to intervene
in a potential collision situation. The

1 City Safety is a registered trademark of the Volvo Car Corporation

162
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

driver is always responsible for main- City Safety™ alone cannot avoid a colli- When the engine is running, City Safety™ can
taining a safe distance to the vehicle sion. The driver must apply the brakes for be switched off as follows:
ahead. full braking effect.
Press My Car in the center console control
When the function activates and applies the panel and go to Settings Car settings
brakes, a message will appear in the informa-
Function tion display to indicate that the system is/has
Driver support systems City safety.
been active. Select Off.

NOTE WARNING
The laser sensor emits light when the igni-
• When City Safety™ applies the brakes,
tion is in mode II or higher, even if City
the brake lights will illuminate. 04
Safety™ has been switched off.
• In cases where City Safety™ has stop-
ped the vehicle, the system will then
release the brakes. The driver must To switch City Safety™ on again:
apply the brakes to keep the vehicle at • Follow the same procedure as for switch-
a standstill. ing City Safety™ off but select ON by
pressing RESET.
Location of the laser sensor in the windshield or
Using City Safety™
City Safety™ monitors traffic ahead of you • Vehicles not equipped with keyless
using a laser sensor mounted in the upper sec- drive: Press lightly on the remote key to
NOTE
tion of the windshield. If a collision is imminent, release it partially from the ignition slot.
City Safety™ will automatically apply the The City Safety™ function is activated auto- Press the remote key into the ignition slot
brakes, which may feel like hard braking. matically each time the engine has been again. Depress the brake pedal and press
switched off and restarted. the START/STOP ENGINE button to start
• If the difference in speed between your the engine. This restarts City Safety™.
vehicle and the vehicle ahead is between
approximately 2-9 mph (4-15 km/h), City On and Off • Vehicles equipped with the optional
Safety™ can help prevent a collision from In certain situations, it may be desirable to keyless drive: Press the START/STOP
taking place. switch City Safety™ off, such as when driving ENGINE button to switch off the engine.
in close quarters where leaves, branches, etc. Depress the brake pedal and press the
• If the difference in speed is between may obscure the hood and windshield.
approximately 10-18 mph (15-30 km/h),

``

163
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

START/STOP ENGINE button to start the City Safety™ emits infrared light and measures area of the windshield in front of the sensor is
engine. This restarts City Safety™. the way in which the light is reflected. There- always kept clean.
See page 81 for information on ignition modes. fore, vehicles or objects with low-reflective sur-
The following table shows some of the situa-
faces may not be detected. Normally, the
City Safety™ will be automatically switched on tions that can cause the message to be dis-
license plate and taillight reflectors give the
the next time the engine is started, even if it was played and suggested actions.
rear section of a vehicle ahead sufficient reflec-
off when the engine was switched off. tive surfaces to be detected.
Cause Action
Limitations NOTE The area of the Clean the wind-
The sensor used by City Safety™ is designed windshield in front of shield or remove the
• Keep the windshield in front of the laser
04 to detect cars and other larger motor vehicles sensor free of ice, snow, dirt, etc. See the sensor is dirty or ice/snow.
ahead of your vehicle in both daylight and dark- page 163. covered by ice or
ness. snow.
• Snow or ice on the hood deeper than
However, there are certain limitations and the 2 inches (5 cm) may obstruct the sen- The laser sensor's Remove the
laser sensor’s function may be reduced by, for sor. Keep the hood free of ice and snow. field of view is obstruction.
example, heavy rain or snowfall, or by dense • Do not mount or in any way attach any- obstructed.
fog or thick, blowing dust or snow. Condensa- thing on the windshield that could
tion, dirt, ice or snow on the windshield may obstruct the laser sensor.
also interfere with the sensor’s function.
Objects such as warning flags hanging from
long objects on the roof or accessories such as Troubleshooting
auxiliary lights or protective arches on the front If Windscreen Sensors blocked appears in
of the vehicle that are higher than the hood may the information display, this indicates that the
also impede the sensor’s function. City Safety™ laser sensor is obstructed in
some way and cannot detect vehicles ahead of
Braking distance to the vehicle ahead increa-
you, which means that the system is not func-
ses on slippery road surfaces, which may
tioning.
reduce City Safety’s capacity to avoid a colli-
sion. In situations like this, the DSTC system However, this message will not be displayed in
(see page 144) will help provide the best pos- all situations in which the sensor is obstructed.
sible braking capacity and stability. For this reason, the driver must ensure that the

164
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

CAUTION The laser sensor Maximum pulse energy 2.64 μJ


If a crack, scratch or stone chip should Maximum average output 45 mW
occur in the section of the windshield in
front the laser sensor and covers an area of Pulse length 33 ns
approximately 1/50 x 1/10 in. (0.5 x 3 mm)
or larger, contact a trained and qualified Divergence (horizontal × verti- 28° × 12°
Volvo service technician to repair or replace cal)
the windshield (see the illustration showing
the location of the sensor on page 163).
Failing to do so may result in reduced City NOTE
Safety™ functionality.
The function of aftermarket laser detectors 04
To help prevent reduced functionality, may be affected by City Safety's laser sen-
please also observe the following: sor.
• If the windshield is replaced, use the
same type or a windshield approved by The upper decal describes the laser beam's
Volvo. classification and contains the following text: WARNING
• When replacing windshield wipers, use Invisible Laser radiation – Do not view directly The laser sensor emits light when the igni-
the same type or ones approved by with optical instruments (magnifiers) – Class tion is in mode II or higher, even if City
Volvo. 1M laser product. Safety™ has been switched off.

The lower decal describes the laser beam's


physical data and contains the text:
IEC 60825-1:1993 + A2:2001. Complies with
FDA performance standards for laser products
except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice
No. 50, dated July 26th, 2001
The laser beam's physical data is listed in the
following table:

``

165
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

WARNING Symbols and messages in the display


When City Safety™ automatically applies the
Eye injury may occur if any of the following
points are not followed: brakes, one or more of the symbols in the main
instrument panel may illuminate and its asso-
• It is essential that all pertinent instruc- ciated message will be displayed.
tions be followed when handling laser
instruments. Testing, repairing, remov- A text message can be erased by pressing
ing, adjusting and/or replacing any briefly on the READ button on the turn signal
components in the laser sensor may lever.
only be done by a trained and qualified
Volvo service technician.
04
• Do not remove the laser sensor (includ-
ing removal of the lenses). A laser sen-
sor that has been removed belongs to
laser class 3B according to standard
IEC 60825-1. Devices in laser class 3B
present a risk of injury to the eyes.
• The laser sensor’s connector must be
disconnected before the sensor is
removed from the windshield.
• The laser sensor must be mounted in
place on the windshield before con-
necting the sensor’s connector.
• Do not view the laser sensor (which
emits spreading, invisible laser beams)
with optical instruments from a distance
of less than 4 inches (100 mm).

166
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

Symbol Message Meaning/action required


Auto braking by City Safety City Safety™ is applying/has applied the brakes automatically.

Windscreen Sensors The laser sensor is temporarily not functioning due to an obstruction.
blocked
• Remove the obstruction and/or clean the windshield in front of the sensor(s).
For more information on the sensor’s limitations, see page 164. 04

City Safety Service required City Safety™ is not functioning.


• If this message remains in the display, have the system checked by a trained and qualified Volvo
service technician.

167
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision warning with Full Auto-brake and Pedestrian Detection*

Introduction The system should not be used in such a way WARNING


Collision Warning with Full Auto-brake and that the driver changes his/her way of operat-
Pedestrian Detection is designed to assist the ing the vehicle. If the driver relies entirely on the • Collision Warning will not provide a
system, the chances of an accident eventually warning or brake the vehicle for pedes-
driver if there is a risk of a collision with a trians in darkness or in tunnels, even if
pedestrian, a vehicle ahead that is at a stand- occurring increase considerably.
there is street lighting in the area.
still or one that is moving in the same direction The Collision Warning and City Safety™ sys-
as your vehicle. tems supplement each other. See page 162 for
• The auto-brake function can help pre-
vent a collision or reduce the speed at
Collision Warning consists of the following detailed information about City Safety™. impact but the driver should always
three functions: apply the brakes for the best possible
WARNING braking effect, even if auto-brake is
04
• Collision Warning warns the driver of a actively applying the brakes.
potential collision situation. • Collision Warning does not work in all
• Brake Support helps the driver brake effi- driving, traffic, weather and road condi- • Never wait for a collision warning. This
ciently in a critical situation. tions. It does not react to vehicles not system is designed to be a supplemen-
traveling in the same direction as your tary driving aid. It is not, however,
• Auto-brake brakes the vehicle automati- vehicle. intended to replace the driver's atten-
cally if a collision with a pedestrian or tion and judgement. The driver is
another vehicle cannot be avoided and the • Collision Warning does not react to ani-
responsible for maintaining a safe dis-
driver does not apply the brakes in time or mals.
tance and speed, even when the colli-
steer around the person/vehicle. Auto- • Warnings are only provided when the sion warning system is in use.
brake can help prevent a collision or risk of collision is high. The "Function"
reduce the speed at which a collision section provides information about lim- • Maintenance of the Collision Warning
itations that the driver must be aware of system's components must only be
occurs.
before using Collision Warning. performed by a trained and qualified
Since Collision Warning with Full Auto-brake Volvo technician.
and Pedestrian Detection is activated in cir- • Collision Warning will not provide a
cumstances where the driver should have warning or brake the vehicle for pedes-
begun braking much sooner, the system will trians at speeds above 50 mph
not be able to assist the driver in all situations. (80 km/h).

This system is designed to activate as late as


possible to help avoid unnecessary interven-
tion.

168 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision warning with Full Auto-brake and Pedestrian Detection*

Function Brake Support Operation


If the risk of collision continues to increase after Settings are made by pressing MY CAR on the
the collision warning has been given, Brake center console control panel and using the
Support is activated. Brake Support prepares menus displayed.
the brake system to react quickly, and the
brakes are applied slightly. This may be expe- On and off
rienced as a light tug. To switch Collision Warning on or off, press MY
CAR on the center console control panel and
If the brakes are applied quickly, full braking
effect will be provided. Brake Support also go to Settings Car settings Collision
increases brake force if the system determines warning On/Off. If Collision Warning is on,
that the driver has not applied adequate pres- the system will perform a self-test each time 04
sure on the brake pedal. the engine is started by briefly illuminating the
warning light. See page 129 for more informa-
Function overview Auto-brake tion about the menu system.
Visual warning signal, collision risk If a collision is imminent and the driver has not
When the engine is switched on, the Collision
applied the brakes or begun to steer around the
Radar sensor Warning setting that was being used when it
vehicle or pedestrian, the auto-brake function
was switched off will be the default setting.
is activated without the driver pressing the
Camera
brake pedal. Full brake force is applied to help Activating/deactivating warning signals
reduce the vehicle’s speed when the collision The collision warning system’s visual signals
Collision Warning occurs or limited brake force is applied if this
The radar sensor and the camera work are activated automatically when the engine is
is sufficient to avoid the collision. started if the collision warning system is
together to detect a pedestrian, stationary
vehicles and vehicles that are moving in the switched on.
same direction as your vehicle. If there is a risk
NOTE
The audible warning signal can be activated/
of collision with a vehicle or a pedestrian, the The auto-brake and brake support functions deactivated by pressing MY CAR on the center
driver is alerted by a flashing red warning light are always on and cannot be turned off. console control panel and going to Settings
and an audible warning signal. Collision warn- Car settings Collision warning
ing is active at speeds above 3 mph (4 km/h).
Warning sound On/Off.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 169


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision warning with Full Auto-brake and Pedestrian Detection*

Setting a warning distance NOTE best possible braking effect while helping to
This setting determines the distance at which maintain stability.
the visual and audible warnings are triggered. • When Adaptive Cruise Control is used,
the warning light and signal will be used
Select Long, Normal or Short by pressing MY NOTE
by that function, even if the warnings
CAR on the center console control panel and
provided by Collision Warning have The visual warning signal may be temporar-
going to Settings Car settings been deactivated by the driver. ily disengaged in the event of high passen-
Collision warning Warning distance. ger compartment temperature due to strong
• In situations where traffic is moving at sunlight, etc. If this occurs, the audible
The warning distance determines the level of considerably different speeds, or if the warning signal will be used, even if it has
sensitivity used by the system. The warning vehicle ahead brakes suddenly, warn- been deactivated in the menu system.
distance Long provides an earlier warning. ings may be considered to be late, even
04 if the setting Long has been selected.
Begin by using Long and if the system gives
too many warnings, try changing to Normal.
Checking settings
WARNING The current Collision Warning settings can be
checked by pressing MY CAR on the center
• The setting Short should only be used
console control panel and going to Settings
in situations where traffic is light and
moving at low speeds. Car settings Collision warning.

• Collision Warning alerts the driver to the


risk of a collision but this function can- Limitations
not reduce the driver’s reaction time. Strong sunlight, reflections, extreme light con-
• For Collision Warning to be as effective trasts, the use of sunglasses, or if the driver is
as possible, it is recommended that Dis- not looking straight ahead may make the visual
tance Alert be set to 4 or 5, see warning signal in the windshield difficult to see.
page 159. For this reason, always activate the audible
warning signal.
Slippery driving conditions increase braking
distance, which can reduce the system's
capacity to avoid a collision. In these condi-
tions, the ABS and DSTC systems provide the

170 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision warning with Full Auto-brake and Pedestrian Detection*

WARNING NOTE The camera’s limitations


The camera is used by Collision Warning with
• In certain situations, the system cannot If warnings are given too frequently, the Auto-brake, Driver Alert Control (see
provide warnings or warnings may be warning distance can be reduced (see
page 170). This causes the system to pro- page 175), and Lane Departure Warning (see
delayed if traffic conditions or other
vide later warnings, which decreases the page 178).
external factors make it impossible for
the radar sensor or camera to detect a total number of warnings provided.
pedestrian or a vehicle ahead. NOTE
• Warnings may not be provided if the WARNING • To help protect the camera in very hot
distance to the vehicle ahead is short, conditions, it may be temporarily
or if movements of the steering wheel/ • The system is not activated at speeds switched off for approximately 15
brake pedal are great, such as during under approx. 2 mph (4 km/h). There- minutes after the engine has been 04
active driving. fore, it will not brake your vehicle if you started.
approach a vehicle ahead at very low
• The sensor system has a limited range speed, such as when parking. • Keep the section of the windshield in
for pedestrians and provides warnings front of the camera clean and free of ice,
and braking effect most effectively at • The driver's actions always have high- snow, or condensation.
speeds up to 30 mph (50 km/h). For sta- est priority and override the Collision
tionary or slow-moving vehicles, the Warning system. This means that the
system functions best if your vehicle’s system will not intervene in situations
speed is below approximately 45 mph where the driver is actively steering,
(70 km/h). braking or pressing the accelerator
pedal, even if a collision is imminent.
• Warnings for stationary or slow-moving
vehicles may not be provided in dark • When Auto-brake has prevented a col-
conditions or in poor visibility. lision with a stationary object, your vehi-
cle will remain at a standstill for approx.
1.5 seconds. If your vehicle has been
The Collision Warning system uses the same braked for a moving vehicle ahead, your
radar sensors as Adaptive Cruise Control. For vehicle's speed will be reduced to the
more information on the radar sensor and its same speed as that vehicle's.
limitations, see page 155.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 171


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision warning with Full Auto-brake and Pedestrian Detection*

WARNING Pedestrians body and the person must be at least


32 in. (80 cm) tall.
• The camera has the same limitations as
• The system cannot detect a pedestrian
the human eye. In other words, its
carrying a large object.
“vision is impaired” by adverse weather
conditions such as heavy snowfall, • The camera's capacity to see a pedestrian
dense fog, etc. These conditions may at dawn or dusk is limited, much as it is for
reduce the function of systems that the human eye.
depend on the camera or cause these • The camera's function is deactivated and
systems to temporarily stop function- will not detect a pedestrian in darkness or
ing. in tunnels, even if there is street lighting in
04 • Never place any objects, decals, etc., the area.
on the windshield in front of the camera.
This could reduce or block the camera’s WARNING
function, and could cause one or more The system cannot identify all pedestrians
of the systems that utilize the camera to The Collision Warning system can only identify • Collision Warning with Full Auto-brake
stop functioning. and Pedestrian Detection is designed to
and detect a pedestrian who is standing
be a supplementary driving aid. It is not,
• Strong sunlight, reflections from the upright. This person can be standing still, walk-
however, intended to replace the driv-
road surface, ice or snow covering the ing or running. er's attention and judgement. The driver
road, a dirty road surface, or unclear This means that the system has to be able to is always responsible for operating the
lane marker lines may drastically reduce identify a person's head, arms, shoulders, legs, vehicle in a safe manner.
the camera’s capacity to detect the side
the upper and lower parts of the body and a • The system cannot detect all pedes-
of a lane, a pedestrian or another vehi-
person's pattern of movement when walking or trians in all situations, such as in dark-
cle.
running. ness/at night and cannot detect parti-
ally hidden pedestrians, people who are
If parts of the body are not visible to the cam-
less than approx. 32 in. (80 cm) tall, or
era, the system cannot detect the pedestrian.
people wearing clothing that obscures
The following conditions apply: the contours of their bodies.
• In order to detect a pedestrian, the system
must have a full view of the person's entire

172 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision warning with Full Auto-brake and Pedestrian Detection*

Fault tracing and actions This, in turn, means that Collision Warning with The table lists possible causes for this mes-
If the message Windscreen Sensors Full Auto-brake and Pedestrian Detection, sage being displayed, and suitable actions.
blocked is displayed, this means that the cam- Lane Departure Warning, and Driver Alert Con-
era is obscured and cannot detect pedestrians, trol will not have full functionality.
vehicles or road marker lines in front of the
vehicle.

Cause Action
The surface of the windshield in front of the camera is dirty or covered Clean or clear the section of the windshield in front of the camera.
with ice or snow. 04

Fog, heavy rain or snow is interfering with the function of the camera. No action possible. Heavy precipitation may affect the function of the
camera.

The surface of the windshield is clean but the message remains in the Wait a short time. It may take several minutes for the camera to register
display. visibility.

The surface between the inside of the windshield and the camera is dirty. Contact an authorized Volvo retailer or service technician to have this
surface cleaned.

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Description
Collis'n warning OFF Collision Warning is switched off. This message is displayed when the engine is started and will dis-
appear after approx. 5 seconds. It can also be erased by pressing the READ button.

Collision warn. Unavaila- Collision Warning cannot be activated. This message is displayed when the driver attempts to activate
ble the function. It will disappear after approx. 5 seconds or can be erased by pressing the READ button.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 173


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision warning with Full Auto-brake and Pedestrian Detection*

Symbol Message Description


Auto braking was acti- Auto-braking has been active. This message can be erased by pressing the READ button.
vated

Windscreen Sensors The camera is temporarily not functioning. This message is displayed if the camera is obstructed by
blocked snow, ice, dirt, etc., on the windshield. Clean the area of the windshield in front of the camera, see
page 171 for more information on the camera’s limitations.

Radar blocked See man- Collision Warning and Auto-brake are temporarily not functioning. The radar sensor is blocked, for
04 ual example by heavy rain or snow that has accumulated in front of the sensor, and cannot detect other
vehicles, see page 155 for more information on the radar sensor’s limitations.

Collision warn. Service Collision Warning and Auto-brake are partially or completely not functioning.
required Contact a trained and qualified Volvo service technician if the message remains in the display.

174 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System*

Introduction Driver Alert Control (DAC)– DAC is designed to help detect a slowly chang-
The Driver Alert System is designed to help a introduction ing driving pattern. It is primarily intended to be
driver who may be becoming fatigued or who used on main roads and is not meant for use in
is inadvertently leaving the lane. city traffic.

The Driver Alert System consists of two differ-


WARNING
ent functions that can be switched on together
or separately. • DAC is not intended to extend the dura-
tion of driving. Always plan breaks at
• Driver Alert Control (DAC) regular intervals to help remain alert.
• Lane Departure Warning (LDW), see • In certain cases, fatigue may not affect
page 178 04
the driver’s behavior. In situations of
When one or both of the functions has been this type, no warning will be provided.
switched on, it is in standby mode and is acti- Therefore, it is important to take breaks
vated when the vehicle exceeds a speed of at regular intervals, regardless of
40 mph (65 km/h). This function is intended to alert the driver if whether or not DAC has given a warn-
his/her driving becomes erratic, such as if the ing.
The function deactivates if the vehicle's speed
goes under 37 mph (60 km/h). driver is distracted or fatigued.
Limitations
Both functions use a camera that is dependent
on the road/lane being clearly marked by pain-
NOTE In certain situations, DAC may provide warn-
ings even if the driver’s driving pattern has not
ted lines on each side. The camera has certain limitations, see
page 155. become erratic.

WARNING • if the driver is testing the LDW function


The Driver Alert System does not function in A camera monitors the painted lines marking • in strong crosswinds
all situations and is designed to be a sup- the lane in which the vehicle is traveling and • on grooved road surfaces.
plementary aid. It is not, however, intended compares the direction of the road with the
to replace the driver’s attention and judge- driver’s movements of the steering wheel. The
ment. driver is alerted if the vehicle does not follow
the lane smoothly.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 175


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System*

Operating DAC Thumb wheel. Turn this wheel until Driver If the vehicle is being driven erratically, the
Certain settings can be made from the menu Alert is displayed. The second line shows driver will be alerted by an audible signal and
system controlled from the center instrument the alternatives Off, the message Driver Alert, Time for a break is
panel. Standby <40 mph (<65 km/h), Unavaila displayed. The warning will be repeated after a
short time if the driving pattern remains the
The current system status can be checked on ble or [-----], i.e., the number of bars.
same.
the trip computer’s display by using the but- READ button. Confirms and erases a mes-
tons on the left steering wheel lever. sage in the display. WARNING
Activating DAC • An alert should be taken seriously since
Press MY CAR in the center instrument panel it is sometimes difficult for a driver to
04 and go to Car settings Support systems realize that he/she is fatigued.
Driver Alert on. • In the event of a warning or if the driver
feels fatigued, stop as soon as possible
The function is activated when the in a safe place and rest.
vehicle exceeds a speed of 40 mph
(65 km/h). The display will show level
markings of 1–5 bars, where a low
number of bars indicates erratic driving. A high
number of bars indicates stable driving.

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Description
- Driver Alert Off The function is not switched on.

- Driver Alert Standby The function has gone into standby mode because the vehicle's speed is below 40 mph (65 km/h).
<40 mph (65 km/h)

176 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System*

Symbol Message Description


- Driver Alert The road lacks clear marker lines.
Unavailable

Driver Alert The function is analyzing the driver’s driving pattern. The number of bars varies from 1–5, where a low
number of bars indicates erratic driving. A high number of bars indicates stable driving.

Driver Alert Time for a The vehicle has been driven erratically. The driver receives an audible signal and a text message.
break
04

Windscreen Sensors The camera is temporarily not functioning, due to snow, ice, or dirt on the windshield. Clean the area
blocked of the windshield in front of the camera. See page 171 for information on the camera’s limitations.

Driver Alert Sys Service The system is not functioning. Contact a trained and qualified Volvo service technician if the message
required remains in the display.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 177


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System*

Lane Departure Warning (LDW)– Operation and function and Lane Depart Warn Standby <40 mph
introduction (65 km/h) will be displayed.
If the camera can no longer monitor the road’s
side marker lines, Lane Depart Warn
Unavailable will be displayed.
If the vehicle unexpectedly crosses the lane’s
left or right side marker lines, the driver will be
alerted by an audible signal.
No warning signal will be given in the follow-
04 ing situations:
• The turn signal is being used
• The driver’s foot is on the brake pedal1
LDW can be switched on or off by pressing the
This function is designed to help reduce the button on the center console. A light in the but- • The throttle pedal is pressed quickly1
risk of accidents in situations where the vehicle ton illuminates when the function is on. • If the steering wheel is moved quickly1
leaves its lane and there is a risk of driving off • In sharp turns that cause the vehicle’s
The trip computer display shows Lane Depart
the road or into the opposite lane. LDW con- body to sway
Warn Standby <40 mph (65 km/h) when the
sists of a camera that monitors the lane’s side
function is in standby mode. See page 171 for information on the camera’s
marker lines. The driver is alerted by an audible
limitations.
signal if the vehicle crosses a side marker line When LDW is in standby mode, the function is
or the road’s center dividing line. activated automatically after the camera has
monitored the road’s side marker lines and the WARNING
vehicle’s speed exceeds 40 mph (65 km/h). The driver will only be warned once for each
Lane Depart Warn Available will be dis- time the wheels cross a marker line. No
played. alarm will be given if a marker line is
between the wheels.
If the vehicle’s speed falls below 37 mph
(60 km/h), LDW will return to standby mode

1
When Increased sensitivity has been selected, a warning will be issued if a side marker line is crossed in this situation.

178 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System*

Settings There are two alternatives: apply. When this setting is being used, the sys-
Settings for Lane Departure Warning can be tem only needs to monitor lane marker lines on
On at start-up: This selection switches LDW
made in the menu system by pressing My one side of the vehicle to change status to
on each time the engine is started. Otherwise,
Car. Go to Settings Car settings Lane Depart Warn Available.
the system will be in the mode that it was in
Support systems Lane Departure when the engine was switched off.
Warning. Increased sensitivity: This selection increa-
ses the function’s sensitivity. Warnings will be
given at an earlier stage and fewer limitations

04
Symbols and messages in the display
Symbol Message Description
Lane departure warning ON/Lane The function is switched on or off. The text disappears after 5 seconds.
departure warning OFF

- Lane Depart Warn Available The function is monitoring the road’s marker lines.

- Lane Depart Warn Standby The function has gone into standby mode because the vehicle's speed is below 40 mph
<40 mph (65 km/h) (65 km/h).

- Lane Depart Warn Unavailable The road lacks clear marker lines.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 179


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System*

Symbol Message Description


Windscreen Sensors blocked The camera is temporarily not functioning, due to snow, ice, or dirt on the windshield. Clean
the area of the windshield in front of the camera. See page 171 for information on the camera’s
limitations.

Driver Alert Sys Service required The system is not functioning. Contact a trained and qualified Volvo service technician if the
message remains in the display.

04

180 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist*

Introduction Function Activating/deactivating


The park assist system is designed to assist The system is activated automatically when the
you when driving into parking spaces, garages, vehicle is started.
etc. It utilizes four ultrasound sensors located  Press the Park assist button on the center
in one or both bumpers to measure the dis- console to temporarily deactivate the sys-
tance to a vehicle, object, or a person who may tem(s).
be close to the front or rear of your vehicle. An
> The indicator light in the button will go
audible signal and symbols in the audio sys-
out when the system has been deacti-
tem’s display indicate the distance to the
vated.
object.
Park assist will be automatically reactivated the 04
This system is available in the rear bumper
next time the engine is started, or if the button
only, or in both the front and rear bumpers.
is pressed (the indicator light in the button will
Park assist button illuminate).
WARNING
The system is activated automatically when the
Park Assist is an information system, NOT a NOTE
vehicle is started. The indicator light in the but-
safety system. This system is designed to
be a supplementary aid when parking the ton in the center console illuminates when the Park assist is disengaged automatically
vehicle. It is not, however, intended to system is on. when the parking brake is applied.
replace the driver's attention and judge- • The front park assist system is active from
ment. the time the engine is started until the vehi-
cle exceeds a speed of approximately
10 mph (15 km/h). It is also active when the
vehicle is backing up.
• Rear park assist is active when the engine
is running and reverse gear has been
selected.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 181


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist*

Signals from the park assist system Audible signal Rear park assist
The Park Assist system uses an intermittent
tone that pulses faster as you come close to an
object, and becomes constant when you are
within approximately 1 ft (30 cm) of an object
in front of or behind the vehicle. If there are
objects within this distance both behind and in
front of the vehicle, the tone alternates
between front and rear speakers.

04 NOTE
The level of the audible signal can be low-
ered/raised with the infotainment volume
View in the display (warning for objects front left/ control. The level can also be set in the MY The distance monitored behind the vehicle is
right rear) CAR menu system, see page 129. approximately 5 ft (1.5 m). The audible signal
Visual indicator comes from the rear speakers.
The audio system’s display gives an overview If the volume of another source from the audio
The system must be deactivated when towing
of the vehicle’s position in relation to a system is high, this will be automatically low-
a trailer, carrying bicycles in a rear-mounted
detected object. ered.
carrier, etc, which could trigger the rear park
The marked sectors in the display indicate that assist system's sensors.
one or more of the sensors has detected an
object. The closer the car symbol comes to a NOTE
sector, the closer the vehicle is to the object.
Rear park assist is deactivated automati-
If the infotainment system is switched off, the cally when towing a trailer if Volvo genuine
park assist system will not be able to provide a trailer wiring is used.
visual indicator. An audible signal will still be
provided.

182 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist*

Front park assist Faults in the system Cleaning the sensors


If the information symbol illuminates and Park
assist syst Service required is shown on the
information display, this indicates that the sys-
tem is not functioning properly and has been
disengaged. Consult a trained and qualified
Volvo service technician.

CAUTION
In certain circumstances, the park assist
system may give unexpected warning sig- 04

G031402
nals that can be caused by external sound
sources that use the same ultrasound fre-
quencies as the system. This may include Location of the front sensors
The distance monitored in front of the vehicle
is approximately 2.5 ft (0.8 m). The audible sig- such things as the horns of other vehicles,
wet tires on asphalt, pneumatic brakes,
nal comes from the audio system's front motorcycle exhaust pipes, etc. This does
speakers. not indicate a fault in the system.
It may not be possible to combine auxiliary
headlights and front park assist since these
lights could trigger the system's sensors.

NOTE
Front park assist is deactivated when the
parking brake is applied and or when the
gear selector is in the P position.
Location of the rear sensors
The sensors must be cleaned regularly to
ensure that they work properly. Clean them

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 183


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist*

with water and a suitable car washing deter-


gent.
Ice and snow covering the sensors may cause
incorrect warning signals.

NOTE
If the sensors are obstructed by e.g., dirt,
snow, or ice, this could result in false warn-
ing signals from the park assist system.

04

184 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Rear Park Assist Camera (PAC)*

Introduction Function Ambient lighting conditions


The Park Assist Camera uses the display in the The camera automatically monitors the ambi-
center console to show the area behind the car ent lighting conditions behind the vehicle and
while you are backing up. constantly adjusts sensitivity to light. This may
cause the brightness and quality of the image
PAC also shows guiding lines in the on-screen on the screen to vary slightly. Sensitivity to light
image to indicate the direction that the vehicle is increased in dark conditions or in bad
will take as it moves rearward, which helps weather, which may affect image quality.
simplify parallel parking, backing into a tight
space or when attaching a trailer to the vehicle. If the image on the screen seems too dark,
brightness can be increased with the thumb
NOTE wheel on the lighting panel. 04

PAC can only be installed on vehicles equip-


ped with the Volvo’s own navigation system
NOTE
VNS. The driver sees what is behind the vehicle and In order to function properly, the camera
if a person or animal should suddenly appear lens should always be kept clean. This is
from the side. particularly important in bad weather. Keep
WARNING the lens free of dirt, ice or snow.
PAC is mounted on the tailgate, near the open-
• PAC is designed to be a supplementary ing handle.
aid when parking the vehicle. It is not,
however, intended to replace the The camera has built-in electronics that help
driver’s attention and judgment. reduce the “fish-eye” effect so that the image
shown on the screen is as natural as possible.
• The camera has blind spots where it
This may cause some objects on the screen to
cannot detect objects or people behind
“lean,” which is normal.
the vehicle.
• Pay particular attention to people or ani-
WARNING
mals that are close to the vehicle.
Objects seen on the screen may be closer
than they appear to be.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 185


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Rear Park Assist Camera (PAC)*

Using PAC With the camera zoomed in on the trailer hitch, Guiding lines
a guiding line showing the hitch's path toward
Activation the trailer will be projected. This feature can be
activated in the MY CAR menu, see
page 129. The guiding lines for the wheels (see
the following section "Guiding lines") and for
the trailer hitch cannot be displayed at the
same time.
If the camera shows an enlarged (zoomed)
image, turn TUNE counterclockwise, or press
04 EXIT, CAM or OK to return to a normal view.

Deactivation
Move the gear selector from R to another posi-
The lines on the screen are projected as if they
tion. There is a slight delay in the PAC system,
were a path on the ground behind the vehicle
PAC is activated when the gear selector is which means that the view from behind the
and are affected by the way in which the steer-
moved to R if the system is selected in the MY vehicle will remain on the screen for approxi-
ing wheel is turned. This enables the driver to
CAR menu system or by pressing the CAM mately 15 seconds after the gear selector has
see path the vehicle will take, even if he/she
button in the center console. See page 128 for been moved from the R position or until the
turns the steering wheel while backing up.
a description of the menu system. vehicle reaches a forward speed of 6 mph
(10 km/h). The screen will then revert to the
If the Volvo Navigation System (VNS) is in use, mode that it was in before R was selected and NOTE
PAC will automatically override the navigation will, for example, display navigation system When backing up with a trailer, the guiding
system to show the camera's image on the information. lines show the path that the vehicle will
screen instead of navigation information, for as take, not the trailer.
long as reverse gear is selected.
NOTE
Zoom If any button on the center console control
The camera can be useful when attaching a panel is pressed, the camera image will dis-
trailer. Press CAM to zoom in on the trailer appear from the display. Pressing CAM will
hitch (and press this button again to return to return the camera image to the display.
the normal camera view).

186 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Rear Park Assist Camera (PAC)*

WARNING The dashed line (2) indicates the clear zone of The markers change color (from yellow to
approximately 5 feet (1.5 m) behind the orange to red) as the vehicle comes closer to
Keep in mind that the image on the screen bumper. These lines also indicate the outmost the object.
only shows the area behind the vehicle. The limits that any object (door mirrors, corners of
driver must always watch for people, ani-
mals, other vehicles, etc., near the sides of the body, etc.) extends out from the vehicle , Marker (color) Distance to
the vehicle when turning while backing up. even when the it turns. object
The "wheel tracks" (3) between the side marker
Yellow more than 5 ft (1.5 m)
Marker lines lines show where the wheels will roll and can
extend up to approximately 10.5 ft (3.2 m) Orange 5–1 ft (0.3–1.5 m)
behind the bumper if there are no objects in the
way. Red 0–1 ft (0–0.3 m) 04

Vehicles equipped with Park Assist Settings


Press OK/MENU when a normal camera view
is displayed and make the desired settings.
Parking camera settings
• Mark Park Assist lines to display the side-
lines while backing up.
• Mark Distance information to display the
intersecting lines while backing up.
The PAC system's lines
Activating the system
Marker line for a 1-foot (30-centimeter)
zone behind the vehicle
• Mark Automatic to activate PAC each
time reverse gear is selected.
Marker line for the clear back-up zone
Colored fields (4-one per sensor) indicate distance • Mark Off to turn off PAC completely.
"Wheel tracks"
If the vehicle is equipped with the optional Park Summary
The solid line (1) indicates a zone within 1 ft Assist system, the distance to an object will be • The camera is activated when the gear
(30 centimeters) of the rear bumper. indicated more exactly and colored markers in selector is moved to R (this can be
the display indicate which of the sensor(s) has changed in the MY CAR menu) and the
detected the object.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 187


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Rear Park Assist Camera (PAC)*

image is shown on the center console dis- R. This setting can be changed in the in MY
play. CAR menu.
• When backing up, two solid lines are pro- • If there are two cameras installed on the
jected on the screen to show the path that vehicle*, to switch between cameras, turn
the vehicle's rear wheels will take. These TUNE (at least one of the cameras has to
lines are affected by movements of the be active), press CAM repeatedly or use
steering wheel. The vehicle's approximate the center console controls. If the front
outer dimension are shown by two dashed camera is on, it overrides the optional park
lines. assist system's visual indicator but there
• The graphic lines will not be displayed will still be an audible signal.
when backing up with a trailer that is con-
04
nected to the vehicle's electrical system. Limitations
• Objects on the ground that are closer than Even if a fairly small section of the screen image
1 ft (30 centimeters) cannot be detected by appears to be obstructed, this may mean that
the camera. a relatively large area behind the vehicle is hid-
• The camera is active for approx. den and objects there may not be detected
5 seconds after the gear selector is moved until they are very near the vehicle.
to R or until the vehicle's speed exceeds
6 mph (10 km/h). NOTE
• The optional Park Assist sensors and the Bicycle carriers or other accessories moun-
parking camera work together and infor- ted on the tailgate may obstruct the cam-
mation from the sensors is shown graphi- era's field of view.
cally on the display.
• The graphic lines shown on the screen Keep in mind
when the vehicle backs up can be disabled
in the settings menu.
• Keep the camera's lens free of dirt, ice and
snow. Remove ice and snow carefully to
• Manual zoom can be selected in the MY avoid scratching the lens.
CAR menu.
• Clean the lens regularly with warm water
• The system can be switched off by press- and a suitable car washing detergent.
ing CAM. By default, the system is acti-
vated when the gear selector is moved to

188 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Blind Spot Information System*

Introduction WARNING NOTE


• BLIS is an information system, NOT a The door panel indicator light illuminates on
warning or safety system. the side of the vehicle where the system has
detected another vehicle. If your vehicle is
• BLIS does not eliminate the need for passed on both sides at the same time, both
you to visually confirm the conditions lights will illuminate.
around you, and the need for you to turn
your head and shoulders to make sure
that you can safely change lanes. BLIS has an integrated function that alerts the
driver if a fault should occur with the system.
• As the driver, you have full responsibility
For example, if one or both of the system's
for changing lanes in a safe manner.
cameras are obscured, a message (see the 04
G031404 table on page 191) will appear in the informa-
The system is based on digital camera tech- tion display in the instrument panel. If this
BLIS camera nology. The cameras are located beneath the occurs, clean the camera lenses. If necessary,
side-view mirrors. the system can be temporarily switched off (for
Indicator light instructions, see page 191).
When one (or both) of the cameras have
BLIS symbol detected a vehicle in the blind area (up to
approximately 10 ft. (3 meters) from the side of
The Blind Spot Information System (BLIS) is an
your vehicle, and up to approximately 31 ft.
information system that indicates the presence
(9.5 meters) behind the side-view mirror), see
of another vehicle moving in the same direction
the illustration, the indicator light in the door
as your vehicle in the side-view mirror's "blind
panel illuminates. The light will glow continu-
area."
ously to alert the driver of the vehicle in the
blind area.
CAUTION
The BLIS system should only be repaired by
a trained and qualified Volvo service tech-
nician.
Areas monitored by BLIS Distance A = approx.
31 ft. (9.5 meters), Distance B = approx. 10 ft.
(3 meters)

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 189


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Blind Spot Information System*

When does BLIS function Darkness NOTE


The system functions when your vehicle is BLIS reacts to the headlights of surrounding
vehicles. In order to be detected by BLIS, a If the BLIS indicator lights illuminate occa-
moving at speeds above 6 mph (10 km/h). sionally even when there are no other vehi-
vehicle in the blind area must have its head- cles in the blind area, this does not indicate
When you pass another vehicle: lights on. This means, for example, that the a fault in the system.
The system reacts when you pass another system will not detect a trailer without head-
vehicle at a speed of up to 6 mph (10 km/h) lights that is being towed behind a car or truck. In the event of a fault, Blind spot syst.
faster than that vehicle. Service required will be displayed.

When you are passed by another vehicle: WARNING


The following are several examples of situa-
The system reacts if your vehicle is passed by • BLIS does not react to cyclists or tions in which the BLIS indicator light(s) may
04 another vehicle at a speed of up to 43 mph mopeds. illuminate even when there are no other vehi-
(70 km/h) faster than your vehicle.
• BLIS does not react to vehicles that are cles in the area monitored by the system.
standing still.
WARNING
• The BLIS cameras have the same limi-
• BLIS does not function in sharp curves. tation as the human eye. In other words,
• BLIS does not function when your vehi- their "vision is impaired" by adverse
cle is backing up. weather conditions such as heavy
snowfall, intense light directly into the
• If you are towing a wide trailer, this may
camera, dense fog, etc.
prevent the BLIS cameras from detect-
ing other vehicles in adjacent lanes.
Limitations
In certain situations, the BLIS indicator light(s) Light reflected from a wet road surface
How BLIS functions in daylight and
may illuminate even when there are no other
darkness
vehicles in the area monitored by the system.
Daylight
BLIS reacts to the shape of surrounding vehi-
cles. The system is designed to help detect
motor vehicles such as cars, trucks, buses,
motorcycles, etc.

190 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Blind Spot Information System*

CAUTION switched off, and a text message is dis-


played.
• Clean the lenses carefully to avoid
• BLIS can be switched on again by pressing
scratching.
the button. The indicator light in the button
• The lenses are electrically heated to will illuminate and a new text message will
help melt ice or snow. If necessary, gen- be displayed. Press the READ button (see
tly brush away snow from the lenses. page 126) to erase the message.
Depending on the vehicle's optional equip-
ment, there may not be space for the BLIS but-
The vehicle's own shadow against a large, light, Switching BLIS on and off
ton in the center console. In this case, BLIS can
smooth surface such as barriers between lanes on be switched on and off in the menu system by
a highway 04
pressing MY CAR and going to Settings
Car settings BLIS. See page 129 for a
description of the menu system.

BLIS system messages


Text in the dis- System status
play
Blind spot syst. BLIS not functioning
Service required properly. Contact an
Sunlight directly in the camera when the sun is low authorized Volvo
on the horizon
BLIS is automatically activated when the igni- service technician.
Cleaning the BLIS camera lenses tion is switched on. The indicator lights will
provide confirmation by flashing 3 times. Blind spot syst. BLIS camera
In order to function optimally, the BLIS camera
camera blocked obscured. Clean the
lenses must be kept clean. They can be wiped • The system can be switched off by press- lenses.
clean with a soft cloth or wet sponge. ing the BLIS button in the center console
(see the illustration). The indicator light in Blind-spot info BLIS system on
the button goes out when the system is system ON

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 191


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Blind Spot Information System*

Text in the dis- System status


play
Blind-spot info BLIS system off
system OFF

Blind spot syst. The BLIS cameras'


Reduced function function has been
reduced due to
weak or impaired
data transfer
04 between the BLIS
system's cameras
and the vehicle's
electrical system.
The cameras will
reset themselves
when this data
transfer has
returned to normal.

192 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Passenger compartment convenience

Storage spaces

04

``

193
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Passenger compartment convenience

Compartment in door panel Tunnel console Glove compartment


Storage pocket on the front edge of the
front seat cushions
Glove compartment
Storage compartment, 12-volt socket and
AUX input/USB connector*
Jacket holder
Rear seat cup holders
04
Storage pocket

Jacket holder
Storage compartment (for CDs, etc.) under The owner's manual and maps can be kept
The jacket hanger is located on the inboard
armrest, AUX input/USB connector. here. There are also holders for pens and fuel
side of the front passenger's seat head
restraint. It is only intended for hanging light Includes cup holder for driver and passen- cards. The glove compartment can be locked
garments. ger, 12-volt socket and small storage com- manually with the key blade, see page 67.
partment.

194 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Passenger compartment convenience

Vanity mirror 12-volt sockets ignition must be in at least mode I, see


page 81.
The maximum current consumption is 10A
(120W) if only one of the 12-volt sockets in the
passenger compartment is in use. If both the
front and rear sockets are used at the same
time, the maximum current consumption per
socket is 7.5A (90W).
The auxiliary sockets can also be used to
power a cigarette lighter. Accessory cigarette
lighters and ashtrays can be purchased from 04
G021438

G031435
your Volvo retailer.
Vanity mirror with lighting 12-volt socket in the front tunnel console
WARNING
The light comes on automatically when the
cover is lifted. Always keep the sockets covered when not
in use.

12-volt socket in the cargo area*

G021440
12-volt socket in the rear center console
The electrical sockets can be used for 12-volt
accessories such as cell phone chargers and
coolers. For the socket to supply current, the

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 195


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Passenger compartment convenience

Fold down the cover to access the electrical


socket.

NOTE
The 12-volt socket in the cargo area pro-
vides electrical current even when the igni-
tion is switched off. Using the socket while
the engine is not running will drain the bat-
tery.

04

196
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

04

197
Introduction........................................................................................... 200
Getting started ..................................................................................... 202
General infotainment functions ............................................................ 207
Radio..................................................................................................... 210
Media player......................................................................................... 219
AUX/USB sockets................................................................................. 223
BluetoothŸ media ................................................................................. 226
Bluetooth® hands-free connection ...................................................... 229
Cell phone voice control....................................................................... 237
Infotainment system menus ................................................................. 241

198
INFOTAINMENT
05 Infotainment

Introduction

General information • AUX and USB sockets Audyssey MultEQ3


The infotainment system in your vehicle is • Bluetooth hands-free/streaming
available in two versions: • 12 speakers
High Performance Multimedia • 5x130W amplifier
• 7" color TFT display Dolby Pro Logic
• Voice control1
• Thumb wheel on the steering wheel key-
pad
• AM/FM/HD radio2
• Sirius satellite radio* The Audyssey MultEQ system has been used
to optimize sound quality to help ensure a
• CD/DVD (mp3 and wma file formats) world-class listening experience.
• AUX and USB sockets
Using the infotainment system
05 • Bluetooth hands-free/streaming
If the infotainment system is on when the igni-
• 8 speakers Dolby Surround Pro Logic IIŸ distributes stereo tion is switched off, it will come on automati-
• 4x40W amplifier sound's two channels to the left/right and front/ cally the next time the ignition is put in mode I
rear speakers. or higher and continue using the same source
Premium Sound Multimedia (FM1, etc.) that was in use when the ignition
Dolby Pro Logic II and the symbol are
• 7" color TFT display was switched off (the driver's door must also
trademarks of Dolby Laboratories Licensing
• Voice control1 Corporation. The Dolby Pro Logic II System is be closed on vehicles with the optional keyless
• Thumb wheel on the steering wheel key- manufactured under license from Dolby drive).
pad Laboratories Licensing Corporation. The infotainment system can be operated with-
• AM/FM/HD radio2 out a key in the ignition slot for 15 minutes at
• Sirius satellite radio* a time by pressing the On/Off button.
• CD/DVD (mp3 and wma file formats)

1 Only available on models equipped with the optional Volvo Navigation System.
2 U.S. models only
3 Applies only to models with Premium Sound Multimedia.

200 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment

Introduction

While the engine is being started, the infotain-


ment system will be temporarily interrupted
and will resume when the engine has started.

NOTE
To help avoid excessive battery drain,
remove the remote key from the ignition slot
if the infotainment system is used while the
engine is switched off.

05

201
05 Infotainment

Getting started

Infotainment system overview Operating the system Infotainment mode buttons

Sockets for external audio sources (AUX Short press: switch the system ON. Press Press a button to select a mode
and USB) and hold: switch the system OFF. RADIO: use to select AM, FM1, FM2,
05
Steering wheel keypad Infotainment system mode buttons SAT1*1, SAT2*1
(RADIO, MEDIA, or TEL). Press a button MEDIA: use to select DISC, AUX, USB,
7" display to access the desired mode and press the iPodŸ or Bluetooth*.
Center console control panel same button again to access the mode's
TEL: Bluetooth® hands-free cell phone
menus. Release the button and wait sev-
operation
eral seconds to automatically accept your
selection. You can also navigate in the MY CAR – See page 128.
menus by turning TUNE to make a selec-
tion and pressing OK/MENU to confirm
your selection.
Turn TUNE to navigate among the menu
alternatives in the display (FM1, DISC,
etc.), or to quickly scroll among tracks,
folders or radio stations.

1 Sirius Satellite radio

202 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment

Getting started

Basic infotainment functions TUNE: Turn in either direction to manually Views in the display
tune a radio station or navigate among the
menu alternatives shown on the display. General information
The infotainment system displays information
OK/MENU: Press to confirm a selection or
in four different views. The highest (most gen-
access the menus for the currently
eral) level is called the main view and is com-
selected infotainment system mode (you
mon to all system modes (RADIO, MEDIA,
can also choose to wait several seconds to
TEL). Each mode has three different basic
automatically accept your selection).
views:
EXIT: Go higher in the menu system, inter-
rupt the current function, reject an incom- • Normal view: the default view for that par-
ticular mode
ing phone call or erase any characters
entered in the display. From the highest • Quick scroll view: the view displayed when
level in the current menu, press and hold to TUNE is turned, which allows you to e.g.,
Controls in the center console for basic infotain- go to the infortainment system's main change tracks on a CD, change radio sta-
ment functions tions, etc.
menu view (see page 204). 05
SOUND: press this button to access the • Menu view: a view for navigating and mak-
INFO: Press this button to display addi-
menu for adjusting bass, treble, etc. See ing selections in the mode's menu system.
tional information about a function, song,
page 208 for additional information.
etc. See page 207 for more information. The views in the different modes vary depend-
VOL: Turn to raise or lower the volume ing on the mode selected, the vehicle's equip-
FAV: This button can be used to store a
level. ment, current settings, etc.
shortcut to a commonly used function in
Short press: switch the system ON. AM/FM/SIRIUS/DISC, etc. See the sec-
Press and hold: switch the system OFF. A tion "FAV—storing a shortcut" on page
short press when the infotainment system 207 for information on using this button.
is on will mute/unmute the infotainment
system sound.
Number key pad (used to e.g., select a pre-
set radio station, enter letter/numbers
when using a Bluetooth cell phone, etc.

``

203
05 Infotainment

Getting started

Main view

Example of RADIO mode's normal view Example of BluetoothŸ hands-free mode's menu
view Example of RADIO mode's main view
Modes (e.g., RADIO, MEDIA etc.), see the
05 following table.
Source menu, e.g., (FM1, DISC, etc.).
Press and hold EXIT on the steering wheel
keypad to display the main view (see the illus-
tration). This offers a quick way of changing
modes (RADIO, MEDIA etc.) directly from the
steering wheel keypad without taking your
hands off the steering wheel. This can also be
done using the mode buttons on the center
Example of RADIO mode's quick scroll view console control panel.
• Select a mode (1) by turning the thumb
wheel on the steering wheel keypad. Press
the thumb wheel to confirm your choice.
• After selecting a mode, turn the thumb
wheel to one of the mode's alternatives in

204
05 Infotainment

Getting started

the display (2) (for example, FM1) and Steering wheel keypad Thumb wheel, used to scroll in the menus
press the thumb wheel to confirm your shown on the display. Press the thumb
choice. wheel to e.g., confirm a menu selection or
Press and hold EXIT to go back. to answer an incoming call on a Bluetooth-
connected cell phone.
NAV: Navigation system* Mute

RADIO: Radio

MEDIA: Media (DISC, USB, etc.)

Standard steering wheel keypad


TEL: BluetoothŸ hands-free Left/right arrow keys: A short press moves
05
between tracks on a disc or searches for
the next radio station. Press and hold to
MY CAR: Driving-related settings
search within tracks.
Volume Steering wheel keypad with voice control button2
CAM: Park assist camera* Left/right arrow keys: A short press moves
EXIT: Go higher in the menu system, inter-
rupt the current function, reject an incom- between tracks on a disc or searches for
ing phone call or erase any characters the next radio station. Press and hold to
entered in the display. Press and hold to go search within tracks.
to the highest level in the current menu. Volume
From the highest level in the current menu,
press and hold to go to the infortainment EXIT: Go higher in the menu system, inter-
system's main menu view (see page 204). rupt the current function, reject an incom-
ing phone call or erase any characters
entered in the display. A long press takes

2 Models equipped with the optional navigation system only


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 205


05 Infotainment

Getting started

you to the main menu view (see


page 204).
Thumb wheel, used to scroll in the menus
shown on the display. Press the thumb
wheel to e.g., confirm a menu selection or
to answer an incoming call on a Bluetooth-
connected cell phone.
Voice control (for operating BluetoothŸ-
connected cell phones and the optional
navigation system)

05

206
05 Infotainment

General infotainment functions

FAV—storing a shortcut • iPod INFO—displaying additional


• Bluetooth* information
• AUX
Favorites can also be stored for TEL, MY
CAR, CAM* and NAV*. See page 128 for a
description of the menu system.
To program a function on the FAV button:
1. Select a mode (e.g., RADIO, MEDIA, etc.).
2. Select a waveband or function (AM, Disc,
etc.).
3. Press and hold FAV until the mode/func-
The FAV button can be used to store frequently tion's "favorite" menu is displayed.
used functions, making it possible to start the 4. Turn TUNE to scroll through the list of In certain cases, more information may be 05
stored function by simply pressing FAV. One alternatives displayed and press OK/ available (about a radio station, song, artist,
favorite (for example, Equalizer) can be pro- MENU to confirm (store) your choice. etc.) than is currently displayed on the screen.
grammed for each of the following infotainment > The next time the infotainment system Press the INFO button to display all of the
system functions: mode (RADIO, MEDIA, etc.) is selected, available information.
In RADIO mode a short press on FAV will start the
stored function.
• AM
• FM1/FM2
• SIRIUS1/SIRIUS2*
In MEDIA mode
• DISC
• USB

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 207


05 Infotainment

General infotainment functions

Basic sound settings • Center level1: Volume for the center If the front and rear seats are occupied, the
Press SOUND to display the basic sound set- speaker. sound stage setting Front seats is recom-
ting menu (Bass, Treble, etc). Continue press- • Surround level1 (only when Surround is mended. Select one of the options under
ing SOUND or OK/MENU to display the other on): Surround level. Audio settings Sound stage.
setting alternatives.
Audio volume and automatic volume
Adjust the setting by turning TUNE and save Advanced sound settings control
the new setting by pressing OK/MENU. The infotainment system compensates for dis-
Equalizer
Continue pressing SOUND or OK/MENU to Sound levels for different frequencies can be rupting noises in the passenger compartment
display: adjusted separately using this feature. by increasing the volume according to the
speed of the vehicle. The level of sound com-
• Surround:1 Can be set to On or Off. When To do so: pensation can be set at low, medium, high or
switched on, the system will automatically
select settings for the best sound quality, 1. Press OK/MENU to access Audio off. Select the level under Audio settings
which is normally DPLII and will settings and select Equalizer Volume compensation.
05 appear in the display. If the recording was 2. Turn TUNE to select one of the frequencies
made using Dolby Digital technology, play-
External audio source volume
and press OK/MENU.
back will be provided with this setting and If an external devices such as an MP3 player or
will appear in the display. If Sur- 3. Turn TUNE to adjust the sound setting and an iPod Ÿ is connected to the AUX socket, the
confirm the change by pressing OK/ device's volume may be different from the vol-
round is switched off, audio will be provi-
ded using 3 channel stereo. MENU. Do the same for the other frequen- ume of the internal sound sources such as the
cies. disc player or the radio. If the external sound
• Bass: Bass level. source's volume is too high, the quality of the
4. When you have finished making your set-
• Treble: Treble level. tings, turn TUNE to move the marker to the sound may be impaired. To help prevent this,
• Fader: Balance between the front and rear OK box and press OK/MENU or EXIT to adjust the input volume of the external audio
speakers. save the new settings. source:
• Balance: Balance between the right and
left speakers. Sound stage2
The sound experience can be optimized for the
driver's seat, both front seats or the rear seat.

1 Premium Sound Multimedia only


2 Premium Sound Multimedia only

208
05 Infotainment

General infotainment functions

NOTE intended to enable the user to adapt sound


reproduction to his/her personal tastes.
Sound quality may be affected if the MP3
player is being charged while the system is
in AUX mode. To help prevent this, avoid
charging the MP3 player in a 12-volt socket
while it is being played.

1. Press MEDIA and turn TUNE to AUX.


Press OK/MENU or wait for several sec-
onds.
2. Press OK/MENU and turn TUNE to AUX
input volume. Confirm by pressing OK/
MENU.
3. Turn TUNE to adjust the volume.
05
Optimal sound reproduction
The audio system is pre-calibrated for optimal
sound reproduction using digital signal pro-
cessing.
This calibration takes into account factors such
as the speakers, amplifier, cabin acoustics, the
listeners' seating positions, etc., for each com-
bination of vehicle/infotainment system.
There is also a dynamic calibration that takes
into consideration the volume level, radio
reception, and the speed of the vehicle.
The settings that are described in this manual,
(Bass, Treble, Equalizer etc.) are only

209
05 Infotainment

Radio

General functions Selecting a station (in wavebands AM/ NOTE


FM1/FM2)
• This list will only display the frequencies
Automatic tuning of the stations currently being received,
1. Press RADIO. Continue pressing this but- not a complete list of all radio frequen-
ton to toggle to the desired waveband cies on the currently selected wave-
(AM, FM1, etc.). band.
2. Release the button and wait several sec- • If the signal from the currently tuned
onds or press OK/MENU. station is weak, this may prevent the
radio from updating the list of stations.
3. Press the left or right arrow keys on the If this occurs, press while the list
center console control panel to search for of stations is displayed to switch to
the next available station. manual tuning mode and select a sta-
List of stations (in wavebands FM1/FM2 tion. If the list of stations is no longer
RADIO button for selecting the AM, FM1, only) displayed, turn TUNE in either direction
05 FM2, Sirius1* or Sirius2* wavebands. The radio automatically compiles a list of the to display the list again and press
Number key buttons (0-9) strongest FM stations whose signals are cur- .
rently being received. This enables you to find
Navigate among the menu alternatives in stations when driving in areas where radio sta-
the display by turning TUNE. The list will disappear from the display after
tions and their frequencies are unfamiliar. several seconds.
Confirm your selection or access the radio
To access this list: If the station list is no longer displayed, turn
menus by pressing OK/MENU.
Left/right arrow keys: Press and hold to go 1. Select the desired waveband (FM1or TUNE in either direction and press on the
to the next available station, press briefly FM2). number key pad on the center console to
to tune to a preset station. switch to manual tuning (or to switch back from
2. Turn TUNE one step in either direction.
manual tuning to the "list of stations" function).
RADIO menu selections can be made from the This displays the list of stations in the area.
center console or the steering wheel keypad. The currently tuned station will be indi- Manual tuning
See page 241 for more information about the cated in the list by magnified text. By default, the list of stations of the strongest
infotainment menu system. stations in the area will be displayed when you
3. Turn TUNE again in either direction to
turn TUNE (see the preceding section, "List of
select a station on the list.
stations"). While the list of stations is displayed,

210 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment

Radio

press on the number key pad on the cen- NOTE been stored on the number key button
ter console to switch to manual tuning, which used.
The radio is initially set to automatically
enables you to select a frequency from the search for stations in the area in which you A list of preset stations can be displayed. This
complete list of all radio frequencies available are driving (see the preceding section, "List function can be activated/deactivated in AM/
on the currently selected waveband. In other of stations"). FM mode in FM menu Show presets or in
words, in manual tuning mode, turning TUNE
However, if you have switched to manual AM menu Show presets
one step will change from e.g., 93.3 to 93.5,
tuning (by pressing on the number key
etc.). Scan
pad on the center console while the list of
To manually tune a station: stations is displayed), the radio will remain The function automatically searches the cur-
in manual tuning mode the next time it is rent waveband for radio stations. When a sta-
1. Press RADIO. Continue pressing this but- switched on. To switch back to "list of sta- tion is found, it is played for several seconds
ton to toggle to the desired waveband tions" mode, turn TUNE one step (to display before scanning is resumed. While the station
(AM, FM1, etc.) and wait for several sec- the full list of stations) and press . is playing it can be stored as a preset in the
onds or press OK/MENU to confirm.
Please note that if you press when the usual way (see "Manually storing preset sta-
2. Turn TUNE to select a frequency list of stations is not displayed, this will acti- tions").
05
vate the INFO function (see page 207 for  To start scanning in AM/FM mode, go to
more information about this function).
FM menu Scan or in AM menu
Scan.
Storing preset stations
Ten preset stations can be stored for each Stop station scanning by pressing EXIT.
waveband (AM, FM1, etc.).
NOTE
Stored preset stations are selected using the
number key buttons on the center console. Storing a station interrupts the SCAN func-
tion.
Manually storing preset stations
1. Tune to a station (see "Selecting a sta-
tion"). Radio text
Some stations transmit information on pro-
2. Hold in one of the number key buttons. gram content, artists, etc. This information can
> The sound will be muted for several sec- be shown on the display.
onds and when it returns, the station has

``

211
05 Infotainment

Radio

Activate/deactivate in FM mode under Radio developer of a broadcasting technology called channel and any sub-channels that may
text. IBOC or In Band On Channel, which refers to also be available on that particular fre-
the method of transmitting a digital radio quency. See also the section "Sub-chan-
broadcast signal centered on the same fre- nels" below).
൅reception (U.S. models
HD Radio൅
quency as the AM or FM station's present fre- • When receiving a digital signal there is no
only) quency. multipath disturbance or hisses/pops/
Introduction The IBOC system is referred to as a "hybrid" crackling due to outside influences.
since it is both analogue and digital. During How HD broadcasting works
hybrid operation, receivers still continue to HD Radio works similarly to conventional radio
receive the analogue (non-digital) signal. HD and broadcasts of this type are available in
radio receivers incorporate both modes of many areas of the United States. However,
reception, where the receiver will automatically there are a few key differences:
switch to the analogue signal if the digital signal
cannot be decoded or is lost by the receiver. • Instead of transmitting one analogue sig-
When you have tuned to an HD Radio station, nal, stations send out a bundled signal –
05 both analogue and digital.
the symbol will appear in the audio sys-
tem display. They symbol is "grayed-out" when • An HD radio receiver can receive both dig-
HD Radio is in standby mode and white when ital and analogue broadcasts. Depending
the radio is actively receiving an HD broadcast. on the terrain and location of the vehicle
Display when the radio is receiving an HD Radio (which will influence the signal strength),
broadcast More information about HD radio and IBOC the receiver will determine which signal to
can be found on Ibiquity's website, receive.
NOTE www.hdradio.com and www.ibiquity.com.
Limitations
HD radio volume may fade in and out at Benefits of digital broadcasting
times due to coverage limitations. • Main channel vs. sub-channels (FM
• Better sound (FM sounds near CD quality only): The main channel is the only channel
and AM as analogue FM). that can receive in hybrid mode (both dig-
HD radio is a brand name registered by the • Some FM frequencies offer a greater num- ital and analogue). If a frequency has sub-
Ibiquity digital corporation1. They are the ber of listening choices through “multicast- channels, they are broadcast in digital
ing” (consisting of a frequency's main mode only. The main FM channel will be

1 HD Radio (TM) technology is manufactured under license from iBiquity Digital Corp. U.S. and Foreign Patents. HD Radio(TM) and the HD and HD Radio logos are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity
Digital Corp.

212
05 Infotainment

Radio

displayed as, for example, 93.9 WNYC NOTE 3. Turn TUNE and move the marker to HD
(Volvo uses the symbol ">" to indicate Radio
there are sub-channels available) The sub- There may be a noticeable difference in
sound quality when a change from analogue 4. Press OK/MENU to turn HD off (the X will
FM channels will be displayed as 93.9 – 2 disappear from the box on the display
WNYC, 93.9 - 3 WNYC, etc. to digital or digital to analogue occurs, such
as: screen).
• Reception coverage area: Due to current This will disable the radio's capability to receive
IBOC transmitter power limitations, the • Volume increase or decrease
digital broadcasts but it will continue to func-
reception coverage area in digital mode is • Equalizer settings, i.e., Bass/ Midrange/
tion as a conventional (analogue) AM/FM
somewhat more limited than the station's Treble cut or boost
receiver. Please note that when HD is switched
analogue coverage area. Please be aware • Time alignment (Digital program mate-
that as with any radio broadcast technol- off, it will not be possible to tune to sub-chan-
rial in extreme cases can be as much as nels (see the following section for a more
ogy, terrain, time of day, foliage level and 8 seconds behind the analogue). This
building location can have positive or neg- detailed explanation of sub-channels).
will noticeable as a "stuttering" effect.
ative effects on radio reception. Repeat steps 2-4 above to reactivate HD (an X
The above items are dependant on the
• Analogue to digital/digital to analogue broadcaster's equipment settings and do will appear in the box on the display screen).
blending: Analogue to digital blending will not indicate a fault in the vehicle's radio 05
occur as the signal strength reaches a pre- receiver or antenna systems. Sub-channels
set threshold in the receiver. This will be
noticeable in fringe areas (areas with weak
reception) and is normal.
Switching HD on or off
The factory setting for HD radio is on. However,
when driving through areas with weak HD sig-
nals (fringe areas), you may experience that the
radio repeatedly switches between analogue/
digital and digital/analogue reception. If this
happens, it may be desirable to switch HD off.
To do so:
1. Be sure the audio system is switched on
and in one of the AM or FM modes.
2. Press OK/MENU in the center console Example of an HD Radio station with sub-channels
control panel.

``

213
05 Infotainment

Radio

In many cases, a main HD Radio station (FM NOTE Sirius satellite radio*
wavebands only) will also have sub-channels
offering additional types of programming or • When the radio has gone into HD mode, Listening to satellite radio
music. it may take several seconds before the The Sirius satellite system consists of a number
">" symbol (if the current frequency has of high elevation satellites in geosynchronous
In such cases, the “-” symbol will be displayed any sub-channels) is displayed to the orbit.
to the left of the frequency number and a num- left of the frequency. Pressing and hold-
ber will be displayed to the right of the fre- ing the arrow keys for approximately
quency number indicating that the currently
NOTE
1 second before the main-/sub-channel
tuned frequency has at least one sub-channel. icon is displayed will cause the radio to • The digital signals from the Sirius satel-
The "2" in the illustration indicates that you are tune to the next available radio station, lites are line-of-sight, which means that
currently listening to the first sub-channel on not to the current station's sub-chan- physical obstructions such as bridges,
frequency 93.9. nels. tunnels, etc, may temporarily interfere
• When you are no longer in broadcasting with signal reception.
Selecting sub-channels
To listen to a station's sub-channel(s), press range of the currently tuned sub-chan- • Avoid any obstructions, such as metal-
nel, No HD reception will be dis- lic objects transported on roof racks or
05 and hold the right arrow key on the center con-
played. The radio will then be muted in a ski box, or other antennas that may
sole or on the steering wheel keypad for
and it will be necessary to tune to or impede signals from the SIRIUS satel-
approximately 1 second. To go back to the lites.
search for a new radio station.
main channel, press and hold the left arrow key
on the center console or on the steering wheel
keypad for approximately 1 second. To go to Sub-channels can also be stored as presets, Selecting Sirius radio mode
subchannel 2 (if available), press and hold the see page 211 for information on storing sta- 1. With the infotainment system switched on,
right arrow key on the center console or on the tions. press RADIO.
steering wheel keypad for approximately If you press a sub-channel's preset button, it 2. Continue pressing RADIO (or turn TUNE to
1 second. may take up to 6 seconds before the channel scroll) to select SAT 1 or SAT 2 and press
If you are currently tuned to a frequency's main becomes audible. If you press this button while OK/MENU (or wait for several seconds).
channel, pressing and holding the left arrow you are out of digital range of the transmitter,
Activating Sirius radio
key for approximately 1 second will tune to the No HD reception will be displayed.
1. Tune to a satellite channel that has no
next lower radio frequency. audio, which means that the channel is
unsubscribed and the text Subscription

214 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment

Radio

update is needed is displayed (see also > The channels in the selected category NOTE
"Selecting a channel"). are displayed.
• The numbers of skipped or locked
2. Call Sirius at 1-888-539-SIRIUS (7474). channels will not be displayed.
NOTE
3. If you tune to an unsubscribed channel, the • If a channel is locked, the access code
Sirius ID will be displayed. The Sirius ID can • The category ALL is default, which ena- must be entered before the channel can
also be accessed from the menu (press bles you to scroll through the entire list be selected. See "Unlocking a channel"
OK/MENU, turn TUNE to scroll to the of available satellite channels. on page 217.
Advanced settings menu, press OK/ • The channel categories are automati-
MENU, scroll to Sirius ID and press OK/ cally updated several times a year. This
Direct channel entry
MENU to display the number). takes approximately two minutes and
The Sirius satellite channels are in numerical
will interrupt normal broadcasting. A
4. Updating subscription will be displayed message will be displayed while updat- order throughout all of the categories. To
while the subscription is being updated, ing is in progress. Information on chan- access a channel directly:
after which the display will return to the nel or feature updates is available at 1. Turn TUNE to access the channel list.
normal view. www.sirius.com.
2. Use the number key buttons to enter the 05
SIRIUS ID channel's number.
The SIRIUS ID (sometimes referred to as the Selecting a channel
There are three ways of tuning in a channel: 3. Press OK/MENU. The radio will tune to this
Electronic Serial Number or ESN) is required
channel, even if it belongs to a category
when contacting the Sirius Call Center. It is • Using the left and right arrow keys to go to other than the currently selected one.
used to activate your account and when mak- the next channel. Skipped channels (see
ing any account transactions. page 217) will be excluded. Scanning
• By turning the TUNE control and selecting SCAN automatically searches through the list
Selecting a channel category
a channel from the list of satellite channels. The search will only be
1. Turn TUNE to display a list of channels.
carried out in the selected category, see
2. Press EXIT.
• Through direct channel entry. page 211 for more detailed information on the
scan function.
3. Turn TUNE to scroll through the list of cat-
egories and press OK/MENU to make a Storing a channel
selection. A total of 20 satellite channels can be stored;
10 channels each for Sirius 1 and 2, see

``

215
05 Infotainment

Radio

page 211 for detailed information on storing 2. Turn TUNE to scroll to Song memory and Radio text
channels. press OK/MENU. This text provides information about the song
• A long press on one of the number keys 3. Turn TUNE to scroll to Song seek and that is currently playing. To turn this feature on
stores the currently tuned channel on that press OK/MENU to activate or deactivate or off, press OK/MENU and scroll to Show
key. the function. radio text and press OK/MENU to toggle
between on or off.
• A short press on a number key while the
radio is in SAT 1 or SAT 2 mode will tune NOTE
to the preset satellite channel stored on Advanced Sirius settings
that button, regardless of the currently When the song has ended, the radio will
remain tuned to the channel on which the This menu function enables you to make set-
selected channel category. song was played. tings on certain Sirius satellite radio functions.
To access this menu:
Searching for and storing songs
The Song seek function provides notification Song memory 1. Press OK/MENU.
when Sirius is broadcasting the songs selected Up to ten songs can be saved in the system's 2. Scroll to the Advanced settings menu
in song memory. Song memory enables you memory. and press OK/MENU.
05 to store the name of the song for future
To add the currently playing song to the list:
advance notification when that song is being
played. 1. Press OK/MENU. WARNING
2. Scroll to Song memory and press OK/ Settings should be made when the vehicle
Song seek is at a standstill.
When a satellite radio channel plays one of the MENU.
songs stored in the song memory while the 3. Scroll to Add song to memory and press
Song seek feature is activated, the listener will The following settings can be made in the Sir-
OK/MENU. ius menu:
be alerted by a text message and an audible
signal. If a new song is selected when the memory is • Channel skip settings can be made
full, you will be prompted to delete a song from
Press OK/MENU to listen to the song or EXIT the list. To do so: • Channel lock settings can be made
to cancel. • The channel access code can be displayed
1. Press OK/MENU. or changed (see also "Locking a channel"
To activate/deactivate the song seek function:
2. Turn TUNE to scroll through the list of on page 217)
1. Press OK/MENU. songs. Select a song and press OK/ • Your Sirius ID can be displayed
MENU to delete it from the list.
• Reset Sirius settings

216
05 Infotainment

Radio

Skip options be skipped the next time the ignition is 7. Press OK/MENU to select Lock all
This function is used to remove a channel from switched on. channels in the category or turn TUNE
the list of available channels. to scroll to a channel and press OK/
Channel lock MENU to select it. Multiple channels can
Skipping a channel Access to specific channels can be restricted be selected.
1. Press OK/MENU. (locked). A locked channel will not provide
audio, song titles, or artist information. The selected channel is now locked and a
2. Scroll to the Advanced settings menu.
checked box will be displayed to indicate this.
3. Press OK/MENU to enter the Skip It will be necessary to enter the channel access
NOTE
options menu. code2 in order to listen to a locked channel.
All channels are initially unlocked.
4. Press OK/MENU to enter Channel skip Unlocking a channel
list. A channel's access code2 is required to unlock
Locking a channel
5. Press OK/MENU to select All categories 1. Press OK/MENU. a channel.
or turn TUNE to scroll to a category and Unlock all channels
press OK/MENU to select it. 2. Scroll to the Advanced settings menu.
This permanently removes all channels from 05
6. Press OK/MENU to select Skip all 3. Press OK/MENU and turn TUNE to scroll the locked list and makes them available for
channels in the highlighted category or to the Lock options menu and press OK/ selection.
turn TUNE to scroll to a channel and press MENU.
Temp. unlock all channels
OK/MENU to select or deselect it. Multiple 4. Use the number keys in the central control This function will temporarily unlock all chan-
channels can be selected. panel to enter the channel access code2 nels and make them available for selection. The
Unskip all channels and press OK/MENU. channels remain on the locked list and will
This removes all channels from the skip list and 5. Press OK/MENU to enter the Channel again be locked the next time the ignition is
makes them available for selection. switched on.
lock list.
Temporary unskip all channels CHANGE CODE
6. Press OK/MENU to select All categories
This function will temporarily unskip all chan- This function makes it possible to change the
or turn TUNE to scroll to a category and
nels and make them available for selection. The channel access code. The default code is
press OK/MENU to select it.
channels remain on the skip list and will again 0000.
To change the code:

2 The default code is 0000. If you have changed the code and forgotten it, see the section "If you have forgotten the access code."
``

217
05 Infotainment

Radio

1. Select Change code in the Lock


options menu and press OK/MENU.
2. Enter the new code and press OK/MENU.
3. Confirm the new code and press OK/
MENU.
If an incorrect code is entered, the text
Incorrect code is displayed.
If you have forgotten the access code:
1. Select Sirius ID in the Advanced
settings menu and press OK/MENU.
2. Press and hold the OK/MENU button for
several seconds.
05 3. The current code will be displayed.
Your Volvo retailer can also provide you with
assistance.
SIRIUS ID
This function displays the 12-digit Sirius acti-
vation ID.

218
05 Infotainment

Media player

CD/DVD functions arrow keys: Fast back/forward and change may take several seconds until the disc begins
track or chapter1. playing, depending on its quality and the
Forward/back and change tracks or chap- amount of information it contains.
ter1. Disc eject
The media player supports and can play the For reasons of traffic safety, an ejected disc
following main types of discs and files: must be removed within 12 seconds or it will
• Purchased CDs (CD Audio) be automatically drawn back into the slot.
• Home-burned CDs with audio and /or Pause
video files When the audio system volume is turned off
• Home-burned DVDs with audio and /or completely, the player will pause and will
video files resume playing when the volume is turned up
• Purchased DVDs again.
Center console control panel
See page 222 for a list of compatible formats. Navigating a disc and playing tracks
Disc slot
05
Media menu selections can be made from the CD audio discs
MEDIA button center console or the steering wheel keypad. Turn TUNE to access the disc's playlist and to
Eject See page 241 for more information about the navigate in this list. Press OK/MENU to con-
infotainment menu system. firm a choice and begin listening. Press EXIT
Number keys to cancel.
Playing a disc
TUNE:Turn to navigate among menu Press MEDIA several times until DISC is dis- The / buttons on the center console or
selections/folders/tracks. played. Release the button and wait several steering wheel keypad can also be used to
OK/MENU: Press to confirm your selec- seconds or press OK/MENU. If there is a disc change tracks.
tion or access the menus for the currently in the player, it will begin playing automatically. Home-burned CD/DVD audio/video files
selected source (e.g., DISC).Left/right Otherwise, Insert Disc will be displayed. Insert Turn TUNE to access the disc's playlist and to
the disc into the slot with the text side upward
navigate in this list. Press OK/MENU to con-
and it will begin playing automatically.
firm a choice and begin listening. Use EXIT to
If a disc with audio/video files is inserted, its stop or to go back in the disc's folder structure.
folder structure will be read by the system. It
1 DVDs only
``

219
05 Infotainment

Media player

The / buttons on the center console or NOTE on audio CDs. The database contains songs
steering wheel keypad can also be used to that are currently popular. If the media player
Video images will only be visible when the finds a track in the database, the album title
change audio/video files. vehicle is not moving. When the vehicle is and artist's name are displayed, and the title,
The following symbols are used in the display: traveling faster than approximately 4 mph
(6 km/h), No visual media available while artist and album for each song is also dis-
• - audio files driving will be displayed. Sound from the played. If the current audio CD is not found in
film will still be audible and video images will the database, CD text from the disc is used. If
• - video files
be shown again when the vehicle stops. no CD text is available, only track 1, track 2,
• - folders etc., will be displayed.
When a file has been played, the player will NOTE Scan2
continue to play the rest of the files (of the same This function plays the first ten seconds of
type) in the current folder. When all of the files Some copy protected audio files or home-
burned audio files may not be read by the each track/audio file. To start scanning:
in the folder have been played, the player will player.
automatically go to the next folder and play the 1. Press OK/MENU.
files in it (unless Repeat folder is activated). 2. Turn TUNE to Scan.
05 DVD videos
The system automatically detects and changes See page 221 for information. > The first ten seconds of each track/
settings if a disc containing only audio or only audio file will be played.
video files is inserted in the player and will play Fast forward/reverse 3. Stop scanning by pressing EXIT. The cur-
these files. However, the system will not Press and hold the / buttons to fast rent track/audio file will continue playing.
change settings if a disc containing both audio forward/reverse. This is done at one speed for
and video files is inserted and the player will audio files but several speeds can be chosen Random2
continue to play the current type of file. This function plays the tracks in random order
for video files. Press the / buttons sev-
eral times to increase the speed. Release the (shuffle). The random tracks/sound files can be
button to return to normal viewing speed. scrolled through in the normal way. To listen to
tracks in random order:
GracenoteŸ track identification 1. Press OK/MENU,
If the vehicle is equipped with the optional nav-
igation system, this system uses a hard drive 2. Turn TUNE to Random
containing a database that recognizes music

2 Not video DVDs

220
05 Infotainment

Media player

3. Press OK/MENU to activate/deactivate NOTE be paused). Press OK/MENU to select a chap-


the random play function. ter and return to the normal view. If a film was
Video images will only be visible when the playing, it will resume). Press EXIT to access
Press the / buttons on the center con- vehicle is not moving. When the vehicle is
the list of titles.
sole or steering wheel keypad to change traveling faster than approximately 4 mph
tracks/audio files. (6 km/h), No visual media available while Turn TUNE to select a title and press OK/
driving will be displayed. Sound from the MENU to confirm and return to the list of chap-
Repeat folder3 film will still be audible and video images will ters. Press EXIT to cancel and return to the
This function makes it possible to play files in be shown again when the vehicle stops. normal view (without having made a selection).
a folder repeatedly. When the last file has been Changing chapters or title
played, the first file will begin again. To acti- Navigating in a DVD's menus TurnTUNE to access the list of chapters and
vate: navigate in this list (the film will pause if it is
1. Press OK/MENU. currently playing). Press OK/MENU to choose
a chapter and return to the normal view in the
2. Turn TUNE to Repeat folder.
display (if a film was playing, it will resume).
3. Press OK/MENU to activate/deactivate Press EXIT to access the list of titles. 05
the function.
In the list of titles, turn TUNE to make a selec-
tion and press OK/MENU to confirm. This also
Playing video DVDs returns you to the list of chapters. Press EXIT
Play to cancel and return to the normal view (without
When playing a video DVD, a disk menu may having made a selection).
appear on the display, giving you access to It is also possible to change chapters by press-
extra functions and settings such as choice of
Buttons in the center console control panel, ing / on the center console control
subtitle and language, scene selection, etc.
shown above, are used to navigate in a DVD's panel or on the steering wheel keypad.
menus.
Advanced settings
Changing chapters or titles
Turn TUNE to access the list of chapters and Angle
navigate among them (if a film is playing, it will If the DVD supports this function, it is possible
to select a camera angle for a certain scene.

3 Home-burned discs/USB only


``

221
05 Infotainment

Media player

This can be done in DVD mode under Disc To return to the factory settings, select
menu Advanced settings Angle. Reset .
DivXŸ Video On Demand Compatible formats
The media player can be registered to play The media player can play a number of differ-
DivX VOD files from home-burned discs or ent types of files and disc formats, and is com-
USB. The registration code can be found by patible with the formats listed in the following
pressing the MY CAR button, and going to table.
Settings Information DivX® VOD
code. See page 128 for more information NOTE
about the menu system.
Dual format (double-sided discs) such as
See also www.divx.com/vod for more informa- DVD Plus or CD-DVD are thicker than nor-
tion. mal discs and may not play in your infotain-
ment system.
Screen settings If a disc containing both CDDA and MP3
05 Screen settings can be made (when the vehicle tracks is played, all MP3 tracks will be
is not moving) for: ignored.
• Brightness
• Contrast Audio CD-Audio, mp3, wma,
1. PressOK/MENU and choose Screen formats aac, m4a
Settings and confirm by pressing OK/ Video for- CD-Video, DVD-Video, divx,
MENU. mats avi, asf
2. Turn TUNE to the desired setting and
press OK/MENU.
3. Change the setting by turning TUNE and
confirm the change by pressing OK/
MENU.
Press OK/MENU or EXIT to return to the
screen settings list.

222
05 Infotainment

AUX/USB sockets

Connecting external devices 1. Press MEDIA several times to come to the NOTE
desired source (iPod, USB or AUX).
Release the button and wait for several • The system supports a number of
seconds or press OK/MENU. iPodŸ models produced in 2005 or later.
> For example, if a USB device has been • In order to help avoid damage to the
selected, the text Connect USB will be USB socket, it will be switched off if
displayed. there is a short circuit or if the con-
nected device uses too much current
2. Connect the device to one of the sockets (which can happen if the device does
in the center console storage compartment not comply with the USB standard). The
(see the illustration). USB socket will reactivate the next time
the ignition is switched on if the problem
The text Reading USB will be displayed while
no longer exists. If the problem persists,
the system reads the device's folders. This may
contact a trained and authorized Volvo
Sockets for auxiliary devices in the storage com- take a short time, depending on the folder
service technician.
partment between the front seats structure and the number of files.
05
An auxiliary device, such as an iPodŸ or MP3 When this information has been loaded, track MEDIA menu selections can be made from the
player can be connected to the audio system information will be displayed and a track can center console or the steering wheel keypad.
via one of the sockets in the center console be selected. See page 241 for more information about the
storage compartment. A device connected to infotainment menu system.
Tracks can be selected in two ways:
the USB socket can be operated using the
vehicle's infotainment system controls. • Turn TUNE and press OK/MENU Navigating and playing tracks1
An iPodŸ or an MP3 player with rechargeable • Use the right or left arrow keys Turn TUNE to access the device's playlist and
batteries will also be charged if the device is ( / ) on the center console control to navigate in this list. Press OK/MENU to
connected to the USB socket (if the vehicle's panel or on the steering wheel keypad either select a sub-folder or confirm a choice
ignition is on or if the engine is running). and begin playback. Press EXIT to cancel and
exit the playlist or to go back in the folder struc-
To connect a device: ture.

1 USB and iPodŸ only


``

223
05 Infotainment

AUX/USB sockets

The / buttons on the center console or for video files. Press the / buttons sev- Repeat2
steering wheel keypad can also be used to eral times to increase the speed. Release the This function makes it possible to play files in
change tracks/files. button to return to normal viewing speed. a folder repeatedly. When the last file has been
played, the first file will begin again. To acti-
The following symbols are used in the display: Scan1 vate:
• - audio files This function plays the first ten seconds of
1. Press OK/MENU.
each track/audio file. To start scanning:
• - video files 2. Turn TUNE to Repeat folder.
1. Press OK/MENU.
• - folders 3. Press OK/MENU to activate/deactivate
2. Turn TUNE to Scan.
When a file has been played, the player will the function.
continue to play the rest of the files (of the same > The first ten seconds of each track/
type) in the current folder. When all of the files audio file will be played.
External sound sources
in the folder have been played, the player will 3. Stop scanning by pressing EXIT. The cur-
automatically go to the next folder1 (unless
USB flash drive
rent track/audio file will continue playing.
To simplify the use of a USB flash drive, it is
Repeat folder is activated) and play the files
05 advisable to only store music files on the drive.
in it. Random1
This function plays the tracks in random order It will take considerably longer for the system
The system automatically detects and changes to index the files on the drive if it contains any-
(shuffle). The random tracks/sound files can be
settings if a device containing only audio or thing other than compatible music files.
scrolled through in the normal way. To listen to
only video files is connected to the USB socket
tracks in random order:
and will play these files. However, the system
will not change settings if the device contains 1. Press OK/MENU,
both audio and video files and will continue to 2. Turn TUNE to Random
play the current type of file.
3. Press OK/MENU to activate/deactivate
Fast forward/reverse1 the random play function.
Press and hold the / buttons to fast
Press the / buttons on the center con-
forward/reverse. This is done at one speed for
sole or steering wheel keypad to change
audio files but several speeds can be chosen
tracks/audio files.

1 USB and iPodŸ only


2 USB only

224
05 Infotainment

AUX/USB sockets

NOTE The system will only play audio files from an


iPodŸ.
• The system supports removable media
that uses the USB 2.0 standard and the
FAT32 file system. It can index up to
NOTE
1,000 folders and a maximum of 254 When an iPodŸ is used as a sound source,
sub-folders/files for each folder. How- the vehicle's audio system has a menu
ever, the highest folder level can sup- structure similar to the one in the iPodŸ. See
port up to 1,000 sub-folders/files. the iPod's manual for detailed information.
• When using a longer type of USB
device, connecting it with a USB Compatible file formats via the USB
adapter cable will help reduce mechan- socket
ical wear on the USB socket and on the The following audio and video files are suppor-
device. ted by the system when playing a device con-
nected to the USB socket.
USB hub 05
A USB hub can be connected to the USB Audio formats mp3, wma, aac,
socket, making it possible to connect several m4a
USB devices at the same time. To select one
of the devices, go to the menu USB menu Video formats divx, avi, asf
Select USB device
MP3 player
Many MP3 players have a file indexing system
that is not supported by the vehicle's audio
system. In order to use an MP3 player, the sys-
tem must be set to USB Removable device/
Mass Storage Device.
iPodŸ
An iPodŸ receives current and its battery is
charged through the USB cable.

225
05 Infotainment

BluetoothŸ media

Streaming audio NOTE Overview


Introduction Any Bluetooth media players used must
The vehicle's media player is equipped with support Audio/Video Remote Control Pro-
BluetoothŸ and can play streaming audio files file (AVRCP) and Advanced Audio Distribu-
tion Profile (A2DP). The player must use
from a BluetoothŸ device such as a cell phone AVRCP version 1.3 and A2DP 1.2. If older
or PDA. Navigation and control of the device versions of these standards are used, cer-
can be done through the vehicle's center con- tain features (e.g., scan or random) may not
sole control panel or the steering wheel key- function.
pad. On certain external devices, it is also pos- Not all cell phones or media players are fully
sible to change tracks from the device. compatible with the vehicle's Bluetooth sys-
In order to listen streaming audio, the vehicle's tem. A list of compatible devices is available
at you Volvo retailer or at www.volvo-
media player must first be put in Bluetooth cars.us.
mode. To do so, Press MEDIA several times Center console control panel
until Bluetooth is displayed. Release the but- VOL: Volume control
05 The vehicle's media player can only play audio
ton and wait several seconds or press OK/
files through the BluetoothŸ function. MEDIA button
MENU.
Choices can be made in the Bluetooth menus TUNE: Turn to navigate among menu alter-
from the center console control panel or the natives and folders shown in the display.
steering wheel keypad. See page 241 for addi- OK/MENU: Press to confirm your selec-
tional information about navigating the various tion or access the menus.
menus. EXIT: Press to go back in the menu struc-
ture or cancel a function.
Left/right arrow keys: Short press: change
tracks. Long press: fast forward/reverse
within a track. The arrow keys on the steer-
ing wheel keypad can be used in the same
way.
MEDIA menu selections can be made from the
center console or the steering wheel keypad.

226
05 Infotainment

BluetoothŸ media

See page 241 for more information about the BluetoothŸ-names of the devices found 1. Press MEDIA several times until
infotainment menu system. will appear in the center console dis- Bluetooth is displayed, release the button
play. and wait for several seconds or press OK/
Pairing and connecting an external MENU.
5. Select the device to be paired and press
device OK/MENU. 2. Be sure the external device's BluetoothŸ
Before an external device can be connected, it function is turned on and that the device is
must be paired to the infotainment system. The 6. Using the external device’s keypad, enter
the digits shown in the audio system’s dis- "discoverable." See the devices user's
procedure for connecting an external device guide if necessary.
varies, depending whether or not the device play and press the device's button used to
has previously been paired to the infotainment confirm a choice. 3. Press OK/MENU.
system. A maximum of 10 external devices can The external device will be automatically paired 4. Turn TUNE to Change Bluetooth
be paired and each device only needs to be and connected to the infotainment system. device and confirm by pressing OK/
paired once. To pair a device: MENU.
Audio files can now be selected using the
1. Press MEDIA several times until / buttons in the center console or on > After a short time, the external device's
Bluetooth is displayed, release the button the steering wheel keypad. name will appear in the display. If other 05
and wait for several seconds or press OK/ devices that have been paired are in
MENU. Automatic connection range, their names will also be dis-
When the BluetoothŸ function is active and the played.
2. Press OK/MENU.
most recently paired device is within range, it 5. Select the device to be connected by turn-
> When Add device is displayed, press
is automatically connected. When the infotain- ing TUNE and pressing OK/MENU to con-
OK/MENU. ment system searches for the most recently firm.
3. Be sure the external device's BluetoothŸ paired device, its name is shown in the display.
> The external device will be connected to
function is turned on and that the device is To connect another paired device, press
the infotainment system.
"discoverable." See the device's user's EXIT. See the following section for information
guide if necessary. about switching to another device. Audio files can now be selected using the
/ buttons in the center console or on
4. Press OK/MENU. Switching to another device the steering wheel keypad.
> The infotainment system will search for It is possible to switch among paired
external devices that are in range, which BluetoothŸ devices that are in the vehicle. To Removing a paired device
may take several minutes. The do so: 1. In Bluetooth mode, press OK/MENU.

``

227
05 Infotainment

BluetoothŸ media

2. Turn TUNE to Remove Bluetooth BluetoothŸ version information


device and press OK/MENU. This feature offers information about the
3. Select the device to be removed by turning BluetoothŸ version installed in the vehicle's
TUNE and confirm by pressing OK/ infotainment system. This information can be
MENU. found under Bluetooth menu Bluetooth
> A question asking if you would like to software version in car.
remove the device will be displayed.
4. Press OK/MENU to confirm or EXIT to
cancel.

Disconnecting an external device


The external device is automatically discon-
nected from the audio system if it is moved out
of range.
05
Random
This function plays the audio files on the exter-
nal device in random order (shuffle). This func-
tion can be activated/deactivated under:
Bluetooth menu Random
Press the / buttons on the center con-
sole or steering wheel keypad to change
tracks.

Scanning audio files on an external


device
This function plays the first ten seconds of
each audio file. This function can be activated/
deactivated under: Bluetooth menu Scan.

228
05 Infotainment

Bluetooth® hands-free connection

Introduction cell phone can always be used regardless of USA: FCC ID A269ZUA130
whether or not the phone is connected to the
FCC WARNING
hands-free system.
Changes or modifications not expressly
TEL menu selections can be made from the
approved by the party responsible for compli-
center console or the steering wheel keypad.
ance could void the user’s authority to operate
See page 241 for more information about the
the equipment.
infotainment menu system.
IC RSS-Gen
NOTE This equipment complies with FCC/IC radia-
tion exposure limits set forth for uncontrolled
Not all cell phones are fully compatible with equipment and meets the FCC radio frequency
the hands-free system. A list of compatible (RF) Exposure Guidelines in Supplement C to
phones is available at your Volvo retailer or
OET65 and RSS-102 of the IC radio frequency
at www.volvocars.us
System overview (RF) Exposure rules. This equipment has very
Cell phone low levels of RF energy that it deemed to com-
WARNING ply without maximum permissive exposure 05
Location of the microphone evaluation (MPE). But it is desirable that it
Never use the hands-free feature or any
other device in your vehicle in a way that should be installed and operated with at least
Steering wheel keypad
distracts you from the task of driving safely. 8 in. (20 cm) and more between the radiator
Center console control panel and display Distraction can lead to a serious accident. and person’s body (excluding extremities:
hands, wrists, feet and ankles).
Bluetooth® hands-free Compliance Canada: IC 700BIAM2101
This feature makes it possible to set up a wire-
FCC/IC common sentence
less connection between a BluetoothŸ-ena-
This device complies with Part 15 of FCC Rules
bled cell phone and the vehicle’s infotainment
and RSS-Gen of IC Rules. Operation is subject
system. This enables the infotainment system
to the following two conditions: (1) this device
to function as a hands-free connection and
may not cause interference, and (2) this device
allows you to remote-control a number of the
must accept any interference, including inter-
phone’s functions. The microphone used by
ference that may cause undesired operation of
this system is located near the driver's side sun
this device.
visor (2). The buttons and other controls on the

``

229
05 Infotainment

Bluetooth® hands-free connection

Bluetooth® functions in the center Getting started 2. Activate the vehicle’s BluetoothŸ hands-
console control panel Use the controls on the steering wheel keypad free system by briefly pressing the TEL
and in the center console to access, navigate button. Continue by pressing OK/MENU.
and make selections in the hands-free sys- 3. Select Change phone and press OK/
tem’s menus. MENU.
Activating/deactivating > Add phone will be displayed. If other
A short press on the TEL button in the center cell phones have already been paired
console activates the hands-free system. The with the infotainment system, their
symbol in the display indicates that the names will also be displayed. Press OK/
hands-free system is active. MENU.
4. With the cell phone in discoverable mode,
A long press on the TEL button deactivates the press OK/MENU.
hands-free system and disconnects the cell > The infotainment system will search for
phone. cell phones that are in range, which
05 Number keys containing letters and num-
bers for dialing numbers, adding phone Connecting cell phones takes approximately 30 seconds. Any
book entries, etc. The procedure for connecting a cell phone var- phones detected will be displayed with
ies, depending on the phone itself and on their BluetoothŸ names. The hands-free
TEL: Press this button to activate/deacti-
whether or not the phone has been previously system’s BluetoothŸ name will appear in
vate the BluetoothŸŸ function.
paired with the infotainment system (see page the cell phone’s display as My Car.
TUNE: Turn to navigate among the menu
227 for instructions on pairing an external 5. Select one of the cell phones shown in the
alternatives in the display.
device). center console display.
OK/MENU: Press to answer an incoming
There are two ways of pairing a cell phone to 6. Using the cell phone’s keypad, enter the
call, confirm your selection or access the
the hands-free system for the first time: digits shown in the center console display
phone menus. Incoming calls can also be
answered by pressing the thumb wheel on Method 1: using the vehicle's menus and press the button on the cell phone
the steering wheel keypad. used to confirm a choice.
1. Activate the cell phone’s BluetoothŸ func-
EXIT: Press to end or reject calls, erase tion to make the phone discoverable (refer
characters that have been entered, end an to the phone’s owner’s manual if neces-
ongoing function. This function is also sary) or go to www.volvocars.com
available on the steering wheel keypad.

230
05 Infotainment

Bluetooth® hands-free connection

Method 2: using the cell phone’s menus Making a call When the cell phone is disconnected from the
1. Ensure that is shown at the top of the hands-free system, a call in progress can be
1. Activate the hands-free system by briefly
center console display and that the hands- continued using the cell phone’s own speaker
pressing the TEL button in the center con-
free function is in telephone mode. and microphone.
sole. If there is a cell phone connected,
disconnect it from the hands-free system. 2. Dial the desired phone number using the Even if the cell phone has been disconnected
center console keypad or use the speed manually, some phones may reconnect auto-
2. Make the vehicle discoverable via the
dial function (see page 236). In normal matically to the most recently used hands-free
BluetoothŸ function by pressing OK/
view (see page 203 for information about unit, for example when a new call is initiated.
MENU and activating the menu selection
Phone settings Discoverable. the various display views). It is also possi-
ble to turn TUNE clockwise to access the Handling calls
3. Perform a search with the cell phone's phone book and then counter-clockwise
BluetoothŸ function (see the cell phone's for the call list. See page 233 for more Incoming calls
user's guide if necessary). information about the phone book.  Press OK/MENU (or the thumb wheel on
the steering wheel keypad) to answer a
4. Select My Car in the list of devices shown 3. Press OK/MENU
call, even if the infotainment system is cur- 05
in the cell phone’s display.
End or reject a call by pressing EXIT. rently in another mode (e.g., RADIO or
5. When prompted, enter a PIN code of your MEDIA).
choice in the cell phone using the cell Disconnecting the cell phone
The cell phone is automatically disconnected Press EXIT to reject a call.
phone's keypad. Enter the same PIN code
in the infotainment system using the sys- from the infotainment system if it is moved out
Automatic answer
tem's keypad in the center console. of range.
This function means that incoming calls will be
6. Connect to My Car from the cell phone. The cell phone can be manually disconnected answered automatically. Activate or deactivate
from the hands-free system by pressing and the function in the menu system under Phone
The cell phone will be paired (registered) and holding TEL or in phone mode, going to Phone main menu Call options Auto answer.
will be connected automatically to the infotain-
menu Phone off. See also page 233 for
ment system. For more information on pairing Call settings
more information about connections.
and connecting a cell phone, see page 233. While a call is in progress, press OK/MENU or
The hands-free system is also deactivated the thumb wheel on the steering wheel keypad
when the ignition is switched off (or if the to access the following functions:
driver’s door is opened on vehicles equipped
with the optional keyless drive).

``

231
05 Infotainment

Bluetooth® hands-free connection

• Mute: mute the infotainment system’s Voice mail Ringing volume


microphone. In normal view, a speed dial number for voice In phone mode, go to Phone main menu
• Mobile phone: transfer the call from mail can be programmed and accessed by Phone settings Sounds and volume
hands-free to the cell phone. On certain pressing and holding 1. Ring volume and adjust the volume by turning
cell phones, the connection will be broken, The number for voice mail can be changed in VOL. Save the setting by pressing EXIT.
which is normal. The hands-free function
phone mode in Phone main menu Call
will ask if you would like to reconnect. Ringing tones
options Voice mailbox no. Change
• Dial number: dial a third party during an The hands-free system’s integrated ringing
ongoing call using the number keys (the voicemail number. tones can be selected in Phone main menu
current call will be put on hold). Phone settings Sounds and volume
Sound settings Ring signals Ring signal 1, etc.
Call lists
Call lists are copied to the hands-free function Call volume
each time a cell phone is connected and the Call volume can be only be adjusted during a NOTE
lists are updated while the phone is connected. call. Use the buttons in the steering wheel key- The connected cell phone’s ring tone may
05 In normal view, turn TUNE counter-clockwise pad or the infotainment system’s VOL control. not be switched off when one of the hands-
to see the All calls list. free system's ringing tones is used.
infotainment system volume
In phone mode, the various call lists can be If no phone call is in progress, volume for the
displayed in Phone main menu Call lists: If you prefer to use the connected cell phone’s
infotainment system can be adjusted in the
ring tone1, go to Phone main menu Phone
• All calls normal way with the infotainment system's
VOL control or from the steering wheel keypad. settings Sounds and volume Ring
• Missed calls signals Mobile phone ring signal.
infotainment system sound can be automati-
• Answered calls
cally muted when a phone call is received in
• Dialed calls (certain cell phones show this Phone main menu Phone settings
list in reverse order)
Sounds and volume Mute radio/media.
• Call duration
If no number has been stored, this menu can
be accessed by pressing and holding 1.

1 Not supported by all cell phones.

232
05 Infotainment

Bluetooth® hands-free connection

More information about pairing and BluetoothŸ version NOTE


connecting cell phones For information about the version of
Changes made from the infotainment sys-
A maximum of 10 cell phones can be paired BluetoothŸ installed in the vehicle, go to Phone tem to a contact in the cell phone's phone
with the hands-free system. Pairing only needs main menu Phone settings Bluetooth book will result in a new contact being
to be done once for each phone. After pairing, software version in car. added to the infotainment system's phone
the cell phone no longer needs to be in sight or book. However, this contact will not be
discoverable. Only one cell phone can be con- saved in the cell phone's phone book. The
nected to hands-free at a time. Phone book infotainment system's display will show
The hands-free system uses two phones duplicate contacts with different icons.
Automatic connection books (one with the cell phone's list of contacts Please also note that if a speed dial number
When the hands-free system is active and the and one with contacts saved directly in the is saved or if a contact's information is edi-
most recently connected cell phone is within infotainment system), which are combined to ted, this will result in a new contact in the
range, it is connected automatically. If this form one phone book. infotainment system's phone book.
phone is not within range, the hands-free sys-
tem will attempt to connect one of the other
• The infotainment system downloads the
phone book from a connected cell phone. The symbol must be displayed before
paired cell phones. When the infotainment sys- This phone book will only be displayed the phone book can be used and the hands- 05
tem searches for the most recently connected when this cell phone is connected to the free function must be in phone mode.
phone, this phone’s name appears in the dis- hands-free system.
play. The infotainment system saves a copy of each
• The infotainment system also has an inte- paired cell phone's phone book. This phone
Manual connection grated phone book made up of contacts book can be copied each time the phone is
To connect a phone other than the one that that have been saved in the system, connected.
was most recently connected or to switch regardless of which cell phone is currently
connected when the contact is saved.  Activate/deactivate this function in phone
between cell phones that are already paired
These contacts will be displayed regard- mode in Phone main menu Phone
with the hands-free system, go to Phone main
less of the cell phone that is connected. If settings Download phone book.
menu Change phone. a contact has been saved in the infotain-
ment system, the symbol will be dis- If the phone book contains information about
Removing a paired phone from the list someone who is trying to call you, this infor-
In phone mode, a paired phone can be played next to it.
mation will be shown in the display.
removed from the list of phones in Phone main
menu Remove Bluetooth device.

``

233
05 Infotainment

Bluetooth® hands-free connection

Contact shortcuts Buttons in the center console Searching for contacts


A quick way of searching the phone book for Button Function
contacts in normal view is to turn TUNE clock-
wise to access the phone book and then coun- Space . , - ? @ : ; / ( ) 1
ter-clockwise to select a contact from the list.
Press OK/MENU to call. ABCÅÄÆÀÇ2
Each name in the phone book has a default
phone number. If the symbol is displayed to DEFÈÉ3
the right of it, this indicates that there are addi-
tional phone numbers for this contact. To use
GHIÌ4
a phone number other than the default one,
press the button on the center console
JKL5
control panel. Turn TUNE to select a different Searching for contacts using the text wheel
phone number and press OK/MENU to call.
List of characters
05 MNOÖØÑÒ6
It is also possible to search for a contact by
using the center console keypad to enter the Switch between character entry modes
first letter(s) of the contact's name (see also the PQRSß7 (see the following table)
following table "Buttons in the center console" Phone book (list of contacts)
for each button's function). TUVÜÙ8 To search for or edit a contact in phone mode,
The list of contacts can also be accessed from go to Phone main menu Phone book
normal view by pressing and holding the button WXYZ9 Search.
on the center console keypad with the first let-
ter of the contact's name. For example, press- 1. Turn TUNE to the desired letter and press
Shift between upper and lower OK/MENU to confirm. The number/letter
ing and holding button 6 would provide direct case
access to the section of the list with contacts keys on the center console can also be
whose names begin with M. +0pw used.
2. Continue to the next letter, etc. The results
#* of the search will be displayed in the phone
book (3).

234
05 Infotainment

Bluetooth® hands-free connection

3. To switch from letter entry mode to the Adding a new contact 3. Continue to the next letter, etc. The name
entry mode for numbers or special charac- entered will be displayed in the character
ters, or to go to the phone book, turn entry field (2).
TUNE to one of the selections (see the
4. To switch from letter entry mode to the
explanation in the following table) in the list
entry mode for numbers or special charac-
for switching character entry mode (2) and
ters, or to toggle between upper and lower
press OK/MENU.
case letters, etc., turn TUNE to one of the
selections (see the explanation in the fol-
Character entry modes
lowing table) in the list (1) and press OK/
123/ Toggle between letters and num- MENU.
ABC bers by pressing OK/MENU.
When you have finished entering the name,
More Switch to special characters by select OK in the list in the display (1) and press
pressing OK/MENU. Enter the name of a new contact OK/MENU. Continue by entering the phone
number in the same way.
Switch between character entry modes
This leads to the phone book (3). 05
(see the following table) When you have entered the phone number,
Turn TUNE to select a contact
Character entry field press OK/MENU and select a tag for the num-
and press OK/MENU to display
ber (Mobile phone, Home, Work or
the contact's information. New contacts can be added in phone mode in General). Press OK/MENU to confirm.
Phone main menu Phone book New
Press EXIT briefly to erase a single character. When all of the contact's information has been
contact.
Press and hold EXIT to erase all of the char- entered, press EXIT to save.
acters that have been entered. 1. When Name is highlighted, press OK/
MENU to go to the character entry mode 123/ Toggle between letters and num-
If a number button on the center console is (see the illustration). ABC bers by pressing OK/MENU.
pressed while the text wheel is displayed, a list
of characters (1) will be displayed. Briefly press 2. Turn TUNE to the desired letter and press
More Switch to special characters by
the button once to enter its first letter, twice to OK/MENU to confirm. The number/letter
pressing OK/MENU.
enter the second letter, etc. Continue to press keys on the center console can also be
the button to display other characters. Con- used. OK Save and return to Add contact
tinue with the next character, etc. by pressing OK/MENU.
To enter a number, press and hold the button.
``

235
05 Infotainment

Bluetooth® hands-free connection

Toggle between upper and lower is activated in Phone main menu Phone
case letters by pressing OK/ book Receive vCard.
MENU.
Memory status
Press OK/MENU and the cursor In phone mode, the memory status of the info-
will move to the character entry tainment system's phone book and the con-
field (2) at the top of the display. nected cell phone's phone book can be seen
The cursor can now be moved by in Phone main menu Phone book
turning TUNE to a position where Memory status.
new characters can be entered
or deleted by pressing EXIT. In Clearing the phone book
order to add characters, return to In phone mode, all entries in the infotainment
text entry mode by pressing OK/ system's phone book can be cleared in Phone
MENU. main menu Phone book Clear phone
book.
05 Speed dial
Speed dial numbers can be added in phone NOTE
mode in Phone main menu Phone book
Clearing the entries in the infotainment sys-
Speed dial. tem's phone book does not delete entries in
To use speed dial to make a call in phone the cell phone's phone book.
mode, press a button on the center console
keypad followed by OK/MENU. If a contact
has not been saved on the speed dial number
used, you will be prompted to save a contact
on the number selected.

Accept vCards
vCards from other cell phones can be added to
the infotainment system's phone book. To ena-
ble this feature, put the infotainment system in
discoverable mode for BluetoothŸ. The feature

236
05 Infotainment

Cell phone voice control

Introduction WARNING Getting started


The infotainment system's voice control fea-
As the driver, you have full responsibility for
ture1 enables the driver to voice-activate cer- operating the vehicle safely and adhering to
tain functions in a BluetoothŸ-connected cell all applicable traffic regulations.
phone or the navigation system.
The voice control feature provides access to a
NOTE number of functions in the BluetoothŸ hands-
• The information in this section applies free and navigation systems while allowing you
to using voice commands to operate a to keep your hands on the steering wheel. Input
BluetoothŸ-connected cell phone. is in dialogue form using spoken commands
See also the section "BluetoothŸ from the user and verbal prompts from the sys-
hands-free connection" beginning on tem. Voice control uses the same microphone
page 229 for detailed information about as the BluetoothŸ hands-free system (see the Voice control button on the steering wheel
using a cell phone with the vehicle's illustration on page 229) and system prompts
infotainment system. are provided through the infotainment sys- Activating the system 05
• The navigation system has a separate tem's front speakers. Before any phone voice commands can be
user's guide containing information used, a BluetoothŸ-enabled cell phone must
about voice commands for operating be paired with the infotainment system. If a
that system. phone command is given, the system will
inform you If there is no cell phone paired. See
Voice commands offer convenience and help page 230 for information on pairing a cell
avoid distractions so that you can concentrate phone.
on driving and focus your attention on road and Press the voice control button (1 in the illustra-
traffic conditions. tion) to activate the system and initiate a com-
mand dialogue. The system will display com-
monly used commands on the screen when the
button has been pressed.

1 Available in vehicles equipped with the optional Volvo Navigation System only
``

237
05 Infotainment

Cell phone voice control

While using the voice control system, keep the Voice control support features The tutorial is divided into three lessons, which
following points in mind: • Tutorial: A feature that helps acquaint you take a total of approximately 5 minutes to com-
with the system and the procedure for giv- plete.
• When giving commands, speak at your ing commands.
usual speed and in a normal tone of voice By default, the system will begin with the first
after the tone • Training: A feature that enables the voice lesson. To skip to the next lesson, press the
control system to become familiar with voice control button and say "next." Go back
• The vehicle's doors, windows and moon- your voice and pronunciation, and allows
roof should be closed when using the voice to a previous lesson by saying "previous."
control system you to set up user profiles. Two user pro-
files can be voice trained. Press and hold the voice control button to exit
• Avoid background noises in the cabin the tutorial.
when using the system These support features are accessed by press-
ing the MY CAR button in the center console Training
and turning TUNE to scroll to the desired menu The system will display up to fifteen phrases for
NOTE you to say. To start the voice training proce-
selection.
If you are uncertain of the commands that dure, press MY CAR and go to Settings
you can use, saying "help" will prompt the Tutorial
The tutorial feature can be started in two ways: Voice settings Voice training. Select User
05 system to provide a number of commands
that can be used in a specific situation. 1 or User 2 and press OK/MENU to begin.
Voice control commands can be cancelled NOTE After the training has been completed, remem-
by: The tutorial feature can only be started when ber to set your user profile in Voice user
the vehicle is parked and the parking brake setting.
• Saying "cancel"
is applied.
• Not speaking Other voice control settings found in MY
• Pressing and holding the voice control CAR
button • By pressing the voice control button and • Voice user setting: Two user profiles can
saying "Voice tutorial."
• Pressing EXIT or one of the mode but- be set by pressing MY CAR and going to
tons (RADIO, MEDIA, etc.). • By pressing MY CAR and going to Settings Voice settings Voice user
Settings Voice settings Voice setting. Select User 1 or User 2.
tutorial. Press OK/MENU to begin the
tutorial lesson.
• Voice output volume: Press MY CAR and
go to Settings Voice settings Voice
output volume. Press OK/MENU and turn
TUNE to raise or lower the volume. Press
EXIT to save the change and exit the menu.

238
05 Infotainment

Cell phone voice control

Using voice commands General commands. See page 128 for more "Delete" (which will erase the entire phone
The driver initiates a voice command dialogue information on the menu system. number).
by pressing the voice control button (see the
Dialing a number Dialing from a call list
illustration on page 237).
The system understands the digits zero to nine. The dialogue below enables you make a call
When a dialogue has been initiated, commonly These numbers can be spoken individually, in from one of your cell phone's call lists.
used commands will be shown in the display. groups of several digits at a time, or the entire The user initiates the dialogue by saying:
Grayed-out texts or texts in parentheses are number can be given at once. Numbers above
Phone > dial from call list
not part of the spoken command. nine will not be recognized.
or
Once you become familiar with the system, you The following is an example of a voice com-
can speed up the command dialogue by briefly mand dialogue. The system's response may Phone dial from call list
pressing the voice control button to skip vary depending on the situation. Continue by responding to the system's
prompts from the system.
The user initiates the dialogue by saying: prompts.
Commands can be given in several ways. Phone > dial number
For example, the command "Phone call con- Calling a contact
or The dialogue below enables you to call the pre- 05
tact" can be spoken as:
Phone dial number defined contacts in your cell phone. See the
• "Phone > Call contact"—say "Phone," wait phone's user's guide if necessary.
for a system response, and then continue System response
by saying "Call contact." Number please The user initiates the dialogue by saying:
• "Phone call contact"—give the entire com- Phone > call contact
User action
mand at one time Begin saying the digits in the phone number. If or
The following is a list of features that can be you say several digits and pause, the system Phone call contact
voice-controlled with a BluetoothŸ-connected will repeat them and prompt you by saying
cell phone. "Continue." Continue by responding to the system's
prompts.
Shortcuts Continue saying the digits. When you have fin-
ished, complete the command by saying When calling contacts, keep the following in
Shortcut commands for using the phone can mind:
be found in the MY CAR menu system, under "Dial."
Settings Voice settings Voice • You can also change the number by using • If there are several contacts with similar
the commands "Correction" (which dele- names, they will be presented in the dis-
command list Phone commands and
tes the last group of digits spoken) or
``

239
05 Infotainment

Cell phone voice control

play in numbered lines and the system will


prompt you to pick a line number
• If there are more lines in the list than can
be displayed at one time, saying "Down"
will enable you to scroll downward in the
list (and saying "up" will take you back up
through the list).

Dialing voicemail
The dialogue below enables you to call your
voicemail to check any messages that you may
have received. Your voicemail phone number
must be registered in the BluetoothŸ function,
see page 232.
The user initiates the dialogue by saying:
05 Phone > dial voicemail
or
Phone dial voicemail
Continue by responding to the system's
prompts.

240
05 Infotainment

Infotainment system menus

Navigating in the menus TEL RADIO menus


Infotainment settings are made via the sys- TUNE Main AM menu
tem's menus. Press one of the mode buttons
AM menu
(RADIO, MEDIA, or TEL—see the illustration OK/MENU
on page 202) to select it and access its specific Show presets
menus. When a mode has been selected, press Search paths Scan
OK/MENU to access its menus. Throughout this manual, search paths to the
menu system functions are listed as shown in Audio settings1
Menu selections can be made using the con-
trols in the center console and certain functions the following example: FM1Autostore, if the Sound stage
can also be controlled from the steering wheel following steps have been taken first:
Equalizer
keypad. Each mode is described in its respec- 1. Press the desired mode button, (RADIO,
tive section. MEDIA, etc). Continue pressing the button Volume compensation
to navigate through the various selections Reset all audio settings
Controls in the center console displayed (e.g., FM1). Release the button
and wait several seconds to automatically Main FM1/FM2 menu 05
accept the selection or turn TUNE and
FM menu
press OK/MENU.
Show radio text
2. Turn TUNE or use the thumb wheel on the
steering wheel keypad to scroll to the Show presets
desired menu selection, such as Audio Scan
settings, and press OK/MENU to confirm
a selection. Advanced settings

3. Turn TUNE again to scroll to the desired Reset all FM settings


submenu (e.g., Equalizer) where applica- Audio settings1
ble and press OK/MENU.
RADIO Main Sirius1*/Sirius2* menu
MEDIA SIRIUS radio off.\nPress RADIO button to
activate SIRIUS.

1 The audio settings are the same for all infotainment system modes
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 241


05 Infotainment

Infotainment system menus

Song memory Audio settings1 Main DVD Video menu


Add song Disc menu

Song seek MEDIA menus DVD disc menu

Delete song Play/Pause/Continue


Main CD Audio menu
View song memory Disc menu Stop

Channel list information Random Subtitles

Station name Scan Audio tracks

Artist Audio settings1 Advanced settings

Title Angle
Main CD/DVD Data menu DivX® VOD code
Information Disc menu
Show presets Audio settings1
05 Play/pause
Category list Stop Main iPod menu
Advanced SIRIUS settings Random iPod menu
Skip options Repeat folder Random
Channel skip list Change subtitles Scan
Lock options Change tracks Audio settings1
Channel lock list Scan
Main USB menu
Unlock all channels Audio settings1 USB menu
Temporarily unlock all chan-
Random
nels
Play/pause
Change code
Stop

1 The audio settings are the same for all infotainment system modes

242
05 Infotainment

Infotainment system menus

Repeat folder TEL menus Download phone book


Select USB device Bluetooth software version in
Main BluetoothŸ hands-free menu
car
Change subtitles Phone main menu
Call options
Change track Call list
Auto answer
Scan All calls
Voicemail number
Audio settings1 Missed calls
Phone off
Answered calls
Main Bluetooth media menu
Bluetooth menu Dialed calls

Random Call duration

Change Bluetooth device Phone book

Remove Bluetooth device Search


05
Scan New contact

Bluetooth software version in car Speed dials


Receive vCard
Audio settings1
Memory status
Main AUX menu Clear phone book
AUX menu
Change phone
AUX input volume
Remove Bluetooth device
Audio settings1
Phone settings
Discoverable
Sounds and volume

1 The audio settings are the same for all infotainment system modes

243
Driving recommendations..................................................................... 246
Refueling............................................................................................... 250
Loading................................................................................................. 255
Cargo area ........................................................................................... 259
Towing a trailer...................................................................................... 262
Emergency towing................................................................................ 265

244
DURING YOUR TRIP
06 During your trip

Driving recommendations

General information • Do not exceed posted speed limits. WARNING


Economical driving conserves natural
• Avoid carrying unnecessary items (extra Driving with the tailgate open: Driving with
load) in the vehicle. the tailgate open could lead to poisonous
resources
Better driving economy may be obtained by • Maintain correct tire pressure. Check tire exhaust gases entering the passenger com-
pressure regularly (when tires are cold). partment. If the tailgate must be kept open
thinking ahead, avoiding rapid starts and stops for any reason, proceed as follows:
and adjusting the speed of your vehicle to • Remove snow tires when threat of snow or
immediate traffic conditions. ice has ended. • Close the windows

Observe the following rules: • Note that roof racks, ski racks, etc, • Set the ventilation system control to air
increase air resistance and also fuel con- flow to floor, windshield and side win-
• Bring the engine to normal operating tem- sumption. dows and the blower control to its high-
perature as soon as possible by driving est setting.
with a light foot on the accelerator pedal for
• At highway driving speeds, fuel consump-
tion will be lower with the air conditioning
the first few minutes of operation. A cold on and the windows closed than with the
engine uses more fuel and is subject to Weight distribution affects handling
air conditioning off and the windows open. At the specified curb weight your vehicle has a
increased wear.
• Using the onboard trip computer's fuel tendency to understeer, which means that the
• Whenever possible, avoid using the vehicle consumption modes can help you learn steering wheel has to be turned more than
for driving short distances. This does not how to drive more economically. might seem appropriate for the curvature of a
allow the engine to reach normal operating
Other factors that decrease gas mileage bend. This ensures good stability and reduces
temperature.
06 are: the risk of rear wheel skid. Remember that
• Drive carefully and avoid rapid acceleration these properties can alter with the vehicle load.
and hard braking. • Dirty air cleaner The heavier the load in the cargo area, the less
• Use the transmission's Drive (D) position • Dirty engine oil and clogged oil filter the tendency to understeer.
as often as possible and avoid using kick- • Dragging brakes
down. Handling, roadholding
• Incorrect front end alignment Vehicle load, tire design and inflation pressure
• Using the transmission's Sport mode1 may Some of the above mentioned items and others
decrease fuel consumption somewhat. all affect vehicle handling. Therefore, check
Use the transmission's Drive (D) position are checked at the standard maintenance that the tires are inflated to the recommended
as often as possible. See page 113 for intervals. pressure according to the vehicle load. See the
additional information about Sport mode. "Tire pressure" section. Loads should be dis-

1 Models with the T6 turbo engine only.

246
06 During your trip

Driving recommendations

tributed so that capacity weight or maximum CAUTION WARNING


permissible axle loads are not exceeded.
• Engine damage will occur if water is The cooling fan may start or continue to
Driving through water drawn into the air cleaner. operate (for up to 6 minutes) after the engine
• The vehicle can be driven through water up has been switched off.
• If the vehicle is driven through water
to a depth of approximately 10 in. (25 cm), deeper than 10 in (25 cm), water may
at a maximum speed of 6 mph (10 km/h). enter the differential and the transmis- • Remove any auxiliary lights from in front of
• Take particular care when driving through sion. This reduces the oil's lubricating the grille when driving in hot weather con-
flowing water. capacity and may shorten the service ditions.
life of these components. • Do not exceed engine speeds of 4500 rpm
• Clean the electrical connections for trailer
wiring after driving in mud or water. • Do not allow the vehicle to stand in if driving with a trailer in hilly terrain. The oil
water up to the door sills longer than temperature could become too high.
• When driving through water, maintain low absolutely necessary. This could result
speed and do not stop in the water. Conserving electrical current
in electrical malfunctions.
Keep the following in mind to help minimize
WARNING • If the engine has been stopped while the
battery drain:
vehicle is in water, do not attempt to
After driving through water, press lightly on restart it. Have the vehicle towed out of • When the engine is not running, avoid
the brake pedal to ensure that the brakes the water. using ignition mode II. Many electrical sys-
are functioning normally. Water or mud can tems (the audio system, the optional navi-
make the brake linings slippery, resulting in gation system, power windows, etc) will
delayed braking effect. Engine and cooling system function in ignition modes 0 and I. These
06
Under special conditions, for example when modes reduce drain on the battery.
driving in hilly terrain, extreme heat or with
heavy loads, there is a risk that the engine and • Please keep in mind that using systems,
cooling system will overheat. Proceed as fol- accessories, etc., that consume a great
deal of current when the engine is not run-
lows to avoid overheating the engine.
ning could result in the battery being com-
• Maintain a low speed when driving with a pletely drained. Driving or having the
trailer up long, steep hills. engine running for approximately
• Do not turn the engine off immediately 15 minutes will help keep the battery
when stopping after a hard drive. charged.
• The optional 12 volt socket in the cargo
area provides electrical current even with
``

247
06 During your trip

Driving recommendations

the ignition switched off, which drains the • Have a word with a trained and qualified mended. Be sure to use good quality oil but
battery. Volvo service technician if you intend to do not use cold-weather oil for hard driving
drive in countries where it may be difficult or in warm weather, see page 342 for more
Before a long distance trip to obtain the correct fuel. information on engine oil.
It is always worthwhile to have your vehicle
checked by a trained and qualified Volvo serv-
• Consider your destination. If you will be
driving through an area where snow or ice NOTE
ice technician before driving long distances. are likely to occur, consider snow tires.
Your retailer will also be able to supply you with Synthetic oil is not used when the oil is
bulbs, fuses, spark plugs and wiper blades for changed at the normal maintenance inter-
Cold weather precautions vals except at owner request and at addi-
your use in the event that problems occur. If you wish to check your vehicle before the tional charge.
As a minimum, the following items should be approach of cold weather, the following advice
checked before any long trip: is worth noting:
• The load placed on the battery is greater
• Check that engine runs smoothly and that • Make sure that the engine coolant contains during the winter since the windshield wip-
fuel consumption is normal. 50 percent antifreeze. Any other mixture ers, lighting, etc. are used more often.
will reduce freeze protection. This gives Moreover, the capacity of the battery
• Check for fuel, oil, and fluid leakage. protection against freezing down to decreases as the temperature drops. In
• Have the transmission oil level checked. –31 °F (–35 °C). The use of "recycled" anti- very cold weather, a poorly charged bat-
• Check condition of drive belts. freeze is not approved by Volvo. Different tery can freeze and be damaged. It is there-
types of antifreeze must not be mixed. fore advisable to check the state of charge
• Check state of the battery's charge.
more frequently and spray an anti-rust oil
06 • Volvo recommends using only genuine
• Examine tires carefully (the spare tire as Volvo antifreeze in your vehicle's radiator. on the battery posts.
well), and replace those that are worn.
Check tire pressures. • Try to keep the fuel tank well filled – this • Volvo recommends the use of snow tires
helps prevent the formation of condensa- on all four wheels for winter driving, see
• The brakes, front wheel alignment, and tion in the tank. In addition, in extremely page 283.
steering gear should be checked by a cold weather conditions it is worthwhile to
trained and qualified Volvo service techni- • To prevent the washer fluid reservoir from
add fuel line de-icer before refueling. freezing, add washer solvents containing
cian only.
• The viscosity of the engine oil is important. antifreeze. This is important since dirt is
• Check all lights, including high beams. Oil with low viscosity (thinner oil) improves often splashed on the windshield during
• Reflective warning triangles are legally cold-weather starting as well as decreas- winter driving, requiring the frequent use of
required in some states/provinces. ing fuel consumption while the engine is the washers and wipers. Volvo Washer
warming up. For winter use, 5W-30 oil, par- Solvent should be diluted as follows: Down
ticularly the synthetic type, is recom- to 14 °F (–10 °C): 1 part washer solvent and

248
06 During your trip

Driving recommendations

4 parts water Down to 5 °F (–15 °C): 1 part


washer solvent and 3 parts water Down to
0 °F (–18 °C): 1 part washer solvent and
2 parts water Down to –18 °F (–28 °C):
1 part washer solvent and 1 part water.
• Use Volvo Teflon Lock Spray in the locks.
• Avoid using de-icing sprays as they can
cause damage to the locks.

06

249
06 During your trip

Refueling

Fuel requirements ness of the emission control system and could sonal air quality standards, some areas require
result in loss of emission warranty coverage. the use of "oxygenated" fuel.
Deposit control gasoline (detergent State and local vehicle inspection programs
Volvo allows the use of the following "oxygen-
additives) will make detection of misfueling easier, pos-
ated" fuels; however, the octane ratings listed
Volvo recommends the use of detergent gas- sibly resulting in emission test failure for mis-
on page 251 must still be met.
oline to control engine deposits. Detergent fueled vehicles.
gasoline is effective in keeping injectors and Alcohol – Ethanol
intake valves clean. Consistent use of deposit NOTE Fuels containing up to 10% ethanol by volume
control gasolines will help ensure good driva- may be used. Ethanol may also be referred to
bility and fuel economy. If you are not sure Some U.S. and Canadian gasolines contain as Ethyl alcohol, or "Gasohol".
an octane enhancing additive called methyl-
whether the gasoline contains deposit control
cyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl Ethers – MTBE: Fuels containing up to
additives, check with the service station oper- (MMT). If such fuels are used, your Emission 15% MTBE may be used.
ator. Control System performance may be affec-
ted, and the Check Engine Light (malfunc- Methanol
NOTE tion indicator light) located on your instru- Do not use gasolines containing methanol
ment panel may light. If this occurs, please (methyl alcohol, wood alcohol). This practice
Volvo does not recommend the use of exter- return your vehicle to a trained and qualified
nal fuel injector cleaning systems. Volvo service technician for service. can result in vehicle performance deterioration
and can damage critical parts in the fuel sys-
tem. Such damage may not be covered under
Unleaded fuel Gasoline containing alcohol and ethers, the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
06 Each Volvo has a three-way catalytic converter "Oxygenated fuels"
and must use only unleaded gasoline. U.S. and Some fuel suppliers sell gasoline containing
Canadian regulations require that pumps deliv- "oxygenates" which are usually alcohols or
ering unleaded gasoline be labelled "UNLEA- ethers. In some areas, state or local laws
DED". Only these pumps have nozzles which require that the service pump be marked indi-
fit your vehicle's filler inlet. It is unlawful to dis- cating use of alcohols or ethers. However,
pense leaded fuel into a vehicle labelled there are areas in which the pumps are
"unleaded gasoline only". Leaded gasoline unmarked. If you are not sure whether there is
damages the three-way catalytic converter and alcohol or ethers in the gasoline you buy, check
the heated oxygen sensor system. Repeated with the service station operator. To meet sea-
use of leaded gasoline will lessen the effective-

250
06 During your trip

Refueling

Octane rating change gasoline brands to fully utilize your Use of Additives
engine's capacity, and for the smoothest pos- With the exception of gas line antifreeze during
Minimum octane sible operation. winter months, do not add solvents, thicken-
ers, or other store-bought additives to your
NOTE vehicle's fuel, cooling, or lubricating systems.
Overuse may damage your engine, and some
When switching to higher octane fuel or
changing gasoline brands, it may be neces- of these additives contain organically volatile
sary to fill the tank more than once before a chemicals. Do not needlessly expose yourself
difference in engine operation is noticeable. to these chemicals.

Fuel Formulations WARNING


G028920 Do not use gasoline that contains lead as a Never carry a cell phone that is switched
knock inhibitor, and do not use lead additives. on while refueling your vehicle. If the phone
Besides damaging the exhaust emission con- rings, this may cause a spark that could
trol systems on your vehicle, lead has been ignite gasoline fumes, resulting in fire and
Typical pump octane label injury.
strongly linked to certain forms of cancer.
Volvo recommends premium fuel for best per-
formance, but using 87 octane1 or above will Many fuels contain benzene as a solvent.
Unburned benzene has been strongly linked to WARNING
not affect engine reliability.
certain forms of cancer. If you live in an area Carbon monoxide is a poisonous, colorless, 06
Volvo engines are designed to achieve rated where you must fill your own gas tank, take and odorless gas. It is present in all exhaust
horsepower, torque, and fuel economy per- precautions. These may include: gases. If you ever smell exhaust fumes
formance using premium 91 octane fuel. inside the vehicle, make sure the passenger
• standing upwind away from the filler nozzle compartment is ventilated, and immediately
Demanding driving while refueling return the vehicle to a trained and qualified
In demanding driving conditions, such as oper- • refueling only at gas stations with vapor Volvo service technician for correction.
ating the vehicle in hot weather, towing a trailer, recovery systems that fully seal the mouth
or driving for extended periods at higher alti- of the filler neck during refueling
tudes than normal, it may be advisable to
• wearing neoprene gloves while handling a
switch to higher octane fuel (91 or higher) or to fuel filler nozzle.

1 AKI (ANTI KNOCK INDEX) is an average of the Research Octane Number (RON) and the Motor Octane Number (MON), MON+RON/2.
``

251
06 During your trip

Refueling

Opening/closing the fuel filler door tral locking button does not lock the fuel Manually opening the fuel filler door
filler door.
• Be sure the fuel filler door is not obstructed
and is completely closed after refueling.
• Open the fuel filler cap slowly during hot
weather.
Close the fuel filler door by pressing it a click
indicates that it is closed.

CAUTION
• Avoid spilling gasoline during refueling.
In addition to causing damage to the
environment, gasolines containing
The fuel filler door is located on the right rear alcohol can cause damage to painted If necessary, the fuel filler door can be opened
fender (indicated by an arrow beside the fuel surfaces, which may not be covered manually:
tank symbol on the information display ) under the New Vehicle Limited War-
1. Open the side hatch in the cargo compart-
ranty.
With the ignition switched off, press and ment (on the same side as the fuel filler
release the button on the lighting panel to door).
06 unlock the fuel filler door. Please note that the 2. Grasp the green cord with a handle.
fuel filler door will remain unlocked until the
3. Gently pull the cord straight rearward until
vehicle begins to move forward. An audible
the fuel filler door clicks open.
click will be heard when the fuel filler door
relocks.
• If you intend to leave your vehicle while it
is being refueled, this feature enables you
to lock the doors/tailgate while leaving the
fuel filler door unlocked.
• You can also keep the vehicle locked if you
remain inside it during refueling. The cen-

252
06 During your trip

Refueling

Opening/closing the fuel cap CAUTION avoid malfunctions that could damage the
three-way catalytic converter.
• Do not refuel with the engine running2.
• Do not park your vehicle over combustible
Turn the ignition off or to position I. If the materials, such as grass or leaves, which
ignition is on, an incorrect reading could can come into contact with the hot exhaust
occur in the fuel gauge. system and cause such materials to ignite
• Avoid overfilling the fuel tank. Do not under certain wind and weather condi-
press the handle on the filler nozzle tions.
more than one extra time. Too much fuel
in the tank in hot weather conditions can
• Excessive starter cranking (in excess of
one minute), or an intermittently firing or
cause the fuel to overflow. Overfilling flooded engine can cause three-way cata-
could also cause damage to the emis- lytic converter or exhaust system over-
sion control systems. heating.
Fuel vapor expands in hot weather. Open the • Remember that tampering or unauthorized
filler cap slowly. Emission controls modifications to the engine, the Engine
Control Module, or the vehicle may be ille-
After refueling, close the fuel filler cap by turn- Three-way catalytic converter gal and can cause three-way catalytic con-
ing it clockwise until it clicks into place. • Keep your engine properly tuned. Certain verter or exhaust system overheating. This
engine malfunctions, particularly involving includes: altering fuel injection settings or
the electrical, fuel or distributor ignition components, altering emission system 06
systems, may cause unusually high three- components or location or removing com-
way catalytic converter temperatures. Do ponents, and/or repeated use of leaded
not continue to operate your vehicle if you fuel.
detect engine misfire, noticeable loss of
power or other unusual operating condi- NOTE
tions, such as engine overheating or back-
firing. A properly tuned engine will help Unleaded fuel is required for vehicles with
three-way catalytic converters.

2 If the fuel filler cap is not closed tightly or if the engine is running when the vehicle is refueled, the Check Engine Light (malfunction indicator lamp) may indicate a fault. However, your vehicle's
performance will not be affected. Use only Volvo original or approved fuel filler caps.
``

253
06 During your trip

Refueling

Heated oxygen sensors


The heated oxygen sensors monitor the oxy-
gen content of the exhaust gases. Readings
are fed into a control module that continuously
monitors engine functions and controls fuel
injection. The ratio of fuel to air into the engine
is continuously adjusted for efficient combus-
tion to help reduce harmful emissions.

06

254
06 During your trip

Loading

Introduction WARNING Power tailgate*


The load carrying capacity of your vehicle is
determined by factors such as the number of
• Stop the engine, put the gear selector in
P, and apply the parking brake when
passengers, the amount of cargo, the weight
loading or unloading long objects.
of any accessories that may be installed, etc.
• The vehicle's driving characteristics
To increase loading space, the rear seat back- may change depending on the weight
rests can be folded down, see page 85. and distribution of the load.
When loading the cargo area, keep the follow- • A 44-pound (20 kg) object produces a
ing in mind: force of 2,200 pounds (1,000 kg) in a
head-on collision at 30 mph (50 km/h).
• Load objects in the cargo area against the

G031965
backrest whenever possible. • The cargo area and rear seat should not
be loaded to a level higher than 2 in.
• Unstable loads can be secured to the load (5 cm) below the upper edge of the rear Power tailgate closing button
anchoring eyelets with straps or web lash-
side windows. Objects placed higher
ings to help keep them from shifting. Automatic opening
than this level could impede the func-
• Stop the engine and apply the parking tion of the Inflatable Curtain. The power tailgate can be opened automati-
brake when loading or unloading long cally in the three ways:
objects. The gear selector can be knocked
out of position by long loads, which could • By pressing and holding the but-
set the vehicle in motion. 06
ton on the lighting panel until the tailgate
begins to open.
• By pressing and holding the button
on the remote key until the tailgate begins
to open.
• By pressing the rubber-covered button
under the outer handle on the tailgate.
The taillights illuminate automatically when the
automatic open function is used.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 255


06 During your trip

Loading

CAUTION Automatic closing If one of these actions is taken, the tailgate will
The power tailgate can be closed by pressing stop and reopen.
Be sure that there is adequate space above
and behind the vehicle before opening the the button on the tailgate (see the illus- Pinch protection
tailgate automatically. tration) or by pressing it down. If the tailgate is obstructed while it is being
The vehicle should not be driven or moved operated, the pinch protection function is acti-
with the tailgate in the open position. How- NOTE vated.
ever, if the vehicle is moved with the tailgate
in the open position, the automatic closing If the tailgate is pressed down e.g., by the • If the tailgate is being opened, the electri-
weight of snow or strong wind, it will close cal function will be switched off and the
function will be inoperative until one of the
following occurs: automatically. tailgate will be released from the electrical
system.
• The tailgate is closed manually
• If the tailgate is being closed, it will stop
• The ignition is switched off and the key WARNING and reopen.
is removed for approximately 10 Be sure that no one is near the tailgate when
minutes (the tailgate will function again it is opened or closed automatically. The Operating the tailgate manually
after restart). tailgate should never be obstructed in any The power tailgate can be disconnected from
way when it is operated. the vehicle’s electrical system by quickly pull-
ing the outer handle twice. The tailgate can
NOTE then be opened/closed manually.
Interrupting automatic opening/closing
If the tailgate has been opened and closed Automatic opening or closing the tailgate can
06 continuously for more than 60 seconds, the
automatic function will be deactivated to be interrupted in four ways: Folding down the rear seat backrests
avoid overloading the electrical system. The • By pressing the The rear seat backrests can be folded down for
automatic function can be used again after button on the additional loading space. See page 86 for infor-
approximately 10 minutes. lighting panel. mation.
If the vehicle's battery has been discharged • By pressing the button on the
or disconnected, the tailgate must be
opened and closed once manually to reset remote key.
the system. • By pressing the button on the lower edge
of the tailgate.
• By pressing the rubber-covered button
under the outer handle on the tailgate.

256
06 During your trip

Loading

Load anchoring eyelets WARNING Grocery bag holder*


• Cover sharp edges on long loads to help
prevent injury to occupants. Secure the
load to help prevent shifting during sud-
den stops.
• Always secure large and heavy objects
with a seat belt or cargo retaining
straps.
• Always secure the load to help prevent
it from moving in the event of sudden

G017745
stops.
• Switch off the engine, apply the parking
brake and put the gear selector in P Grocery bag holder under the floor of the cargo
The load anchoring eyelets on both sides of the when loading and unloading the vehicle. area
vehicle are used to fasten straps, etc., to help
anchor items in the cargo area. The grocery bag holder holds shopping bags
in place.
1. Open the hatch in the floor of the cargo
area.
06
2. Secure the shopping bags with the strap.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 257


06 During your trip

Loading

Roof loads • The vehicle's wind resistance and fuel con-


sumption will increase with the size of the
Using load carriers load.
Load carriers are available as Volvo accesso-
• Drive smoothly. Avoid rapid starts, fast
ries. Observe the following points when in use: cornering and hard braking.
• To avoid damaging your vehicle and to
achieve maximum safety when driving, we
recommend using the load carriers that
Volvo has developed especially for your
vehicle.
• Volvo-approved removable roof racks are
designed to carry the maximum allowable
roof load for this vehicle: 220 lbs (100 kg).
For non-Volvo roof racks, check the man-
ufacturer's weight limits for the rack.
• Never exceed the rack manufacturer's
weigh limits and never exceed the maxi-
mum rated roof load of 220 lbs (100 kg).
• Avoid single-point loads. Distribute loads
06 evenly.
• Place heavier cargo at the bottom of the
load.
• Secure the cargo correctly with appropri-
ate tie-down equipment.
• Check periodically that the load carriers
and load are properly secured.
• Remember that the vehicle's center of
gravity and handling change when you
carry a load on the roof.

258
06 During your trip

Cargo area

Steel cargo grid* Installing the steel cargo grid Installing the cover
For information about the necessary tools and 1. Press the end piece on one side of the
procedures for installing/removing the steel cargo area cover into the retaining bracket
cargo grid, please refer to the assembly in the side panel of the cargo area .
instructions1 that were included when the grid
2. Do the same on the opposite side .
was purchased.
3. Press both sides of the cover until they
Cargo area cover* click into place . The red mark will no
longer be visible.
4. Check that both ends of the cover are

G031978
securely locked in place.

Removing the cover


Your vehicle can be equipped with a steel grid 1. Press one of the end pieces of the cover
that helps prevent objects in the cargo area inward.
from moving forward into the passenger com- 2. Pull the cover carefully upward and out-
partment. ward. The other end will release automati-
cally from its retaining bracket.

G031977
Folding the grid up/down
Grasp the lowering edge of the grid and pull it 06
Folding down the cargo area cover's rear
rearward/upward, or push it downward/for-
flap
ward. Use The cargo area cover's rear flap points hori-
• Pull the cover over the cargo and hook it zontally when the cover is retracted (rolled up).
NOTE into the holes in the rear cargo area pillars.
To fold it down:
If the steel grid is to be used with the • To retract (roll up) the cover, release it from
the holes and guide it toward the rear seat  Pull the flap slightly rearward past its sup-
optional cargo area cover, the grid must be ports and fold it down.
folded down before the cargo area cover is backrest.
put in place.

1 Assembly instruction no. 30715972.


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 259


06 During your trip

Cargo area

NOTE WARNING
On models equipped with this cover, it • Be sure that the cargo net's upper
should be removed before a child seat is attachment hooks are properly inserted
attached to the child restraint anchors. in the brackets and that the lower straps
are correctly attached and pulled taut.

Cargo net* • A damaged cargo net should never be


used.
• Objects in the cargo area should be
securely anchored, even if the cargo net
is correctly installed and in use.

Mounting the cargo net Cargo net in rear position


The cargo net is easiest to put in place through 4. Mounting in the rear position: With the net's
one of the rear doors. rod attached to the rear upper brackets,
hook the lower straps in the floor eyelets in
1. Fold out the cargo net and be sure that the
the cargo area. Pull the net strap taut.
upper hinged rod is straight and locked in
G034213

position.
06 Cargo net mounted in rear position 2. Insert one end of the rod into the front or
rear bracket (near the ceiling). Be sure that
Your vehicle can be equipped with a cargo net the lock on the lower strap is facing toward
made of strong nylon fabric that helps prevent you.
objects in the cargo area from moving forward
into the passenger compartment. 3. Insert the other end of the rod in the oppo-
site bracket.
The net can be attached in two different places:
– Be sure to press the end hooks on the rod
• Rear position: behind the rear seat back- as far forward as possible in the brackets.
rest
• Front position: behind the front seat back-
rests

260 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


06 During your trip

Cargo area

Removing and storing the cargo net

Cargo net in front position

Mounting in the front position: With the Press the release buttons on the locks on
net's rod attached to the front upper brack- the straps and pull out a small section of
ets, hook the lower straps in the eyelets in the strap.
the front seat rails. Attaching the net is eas-
ier if the front seat backrests are upright Press in the catches on the straps' hooks
and the seats are moved slightly forward. and remove the hooks from the eyelet.
06
If the front seats are moved rearward, they Fold up the net's rod at the center and roll
should not press hard against the net. up the net.
When not in use, the cargo net can be stored
CAUTION under floor of the cargo area.
Pressure from the front seats against the
cargo net could damage the net and/or its
brackets.

5. Pull the net strap taut.

261
06 During your trip

Towing a trailer

Introduction when driving in hot climates or hilly terrain. WARNING


Volvo recommends the use of Volvo trailer Use a lower gear and turn off the air con-
hitches that are specially designed for the vehi- ditioner if the temperature gauge needle • Bumper-attached trailer hitches must
enters the red range. not be used on Volvos, nor should
cle. safety chains be attached to the
• If the automatic transmission begins to bumper.
NOTE overheat, a message will be displayed in
the text window. • Trailer hitches attaching to the vehicle
See page 339 for the maximum trailer and rear axle must not be used.
tongue weights recommended by Volvo. • Avoid overload and other abusive opera-
tion. • Never connect a trailer's hydraulic
brake system directly to the vehicle
• Observe the legal requirements of the • Hauling a trailer affects handling, durabil- brake system, nor a trailer's lighting
ity, and economy.
state/province in which the vehicles are system directly to the vehicle lighting
• All Volvo models are equipped with • It is necessary to balance trailer brakes system. Consult your nearest author-
with the towing vehicle brakes to provide a ized Volvo retailer for correct installa-
energy-absorbing shock-mounted bump-
safe stop (check and observe state/local tion.
ers. Trailer hitch installation should not
regulations).
interfere with the proper operation of this • When towing a trailer, the trailer's safety
bumper system. • Do not connect the trailer's brake system wire must be correctly fastened to the
directly to the vehicle's brake system. hole or hook provided in the trailer hitch
Trailer towing does not normally present any
particular problems, but take into considera- • More frequent vehicle maintenance is on the vehicle. The safety wire should
required. never be fastened to or wound around
06 tion:
the drawbar ball.
• Increase tire pressure to recommended full • Remove the ball and drawbar assembly
when the hitch is not being used.
pressure. See the tire inflation tables
beginning on page 275. • Volvo recommends the use of synthetic
engine oil when towing a trailer over long
• When your vehicle is new, avoid towing distances or in mountainous areas.
heavy trailers during the first 620 miles
(1,000 km).
• Maximum speed when towing a trailer:
50 mph (80 km/h).
• Engine and transmission are subject to
increased loads. Therefore, engine coolant
temperature should be closely watched

262
06 During your trip

Towing a trailer

NOTE Detachable trailer hitch (accessory) 4. Slide the locking bolt through the hitch
assembly/ball holder.
• When parking the vehicle with a trailer
on a hill, apply the parking brake before 5. Insert the cotter pin in the hole at the end
putting the gear selector in P. Always of the locking bolt.
follow the trailer manufacturer's recom-
mendations for wheel chocking. Removing the ball holder
1. Remove the cotter pin from the locking bolt
• When starting on a hill, put the gear C
and slide the locking bolt out of the ball
selector in D before releasing the park- holder/hitch assembly.
ing brake. See also page 119 for more
detailed information about starting off D 2. Pull the ball holder out of the hitch assem-
on a hill while towing a trailer. E bly.
B

G010496
• If you use the manual (Geartronic) shift A
positions while towing a trailer, make NOTE
sure the gear you select does not put Ball holder
A cover for the hitch assembly is also
too much strain on the engine (using too included in the kit.
Locking bolt
high a gear).
• The drawbar assembly/trailer hitch may Cotter pin
be rated for trailers heavier than the Trailer Stability Assist (TSA)
Hitch assembly
vehicle is designed to tow. Please Trailer Stability Assist is a system designed to 06
adhere to Volvo's recommended trailer Safety wire attachment help stabilize a vehicle that is towing a trailer
weights. when the vehicle and trailer have begun to
• Avoid driving with a trailer on inclines of Installing the ball holder sway and is part of the Dynamic Stability and
more than 15 %. 1. If necessary, remove the cotter pin from Traction Control system (DSTC). See page
the locking bolt and slide the locking bolt 144 for information on DSTC.
Trailer cable out of the hitch assembly.
Function
An adapter is required if the vehicle's trailer 2. Slide the ball holder into the hitch assem- A vehicle towing a trailer may begin to sway for
hitch has a 13-pin connector and the trailer has bly. various reasons. Normally this only occurs at
7 pins. Use an adapter cable approved by high speeds but, for example, if the trailer is
3. Align the hole in the ball holder with the one
Volvo. Make sure the cable does not drag on overloaded or if the load is unevenly distributed
in the hitch assembly.
the ground. in the trailer, there is risk of swaying at speeds

``

263
06 During your trip

Towing a trailer

between approximately 45-55 mph (70-90 km/ movement. If the system detects a tendency to
h). sway, the brakes are applied individually on the
front wheels, which has a stabilizing effect on
Swaying may be caused by factors such as:
the vehicle and trailer. This is often enough to
• The vehicle and trailer are hit by a sudden, enable the driver to regain control of the vehi-
strong crosswind cle.
• The vehicle and trailer are traveling on an If this is not adequate to stop the swaying
uneven road surface or drive over a bump motion, the brakes are applied to all of the
• Sudden movements of the steering wheel wheels on the vehicle and on the trailer if it is
equipped with brakes, and engine power is
Facts about TSA temporarily reduced. As the swaying motion
• TSA intervenes at speeds above approxi- begins to decrease and the vehicle-trailer have
mately 40 mph (60 km/h)
once again become stable, TSA will no stop
• The DSTC symbol ( ) in the instru- regulating the brakes/engine power and the
ment panel will flash when TSA is working driver regains control of the vehicle.
• If the driver switches off the DSTC sys-
tem's Spin Control function, TSA will also
be switched off (but will be on again the
next time the engine is started)
06
• TSA may not intervene when the vehicle
and trailer begin to sway if the driver tries
to compensate for the swaying motion by
moving the steering wheel rapidly

How TSA works


Once swaying has begun, it can be very diffi-
cult to stop, which makes it difficult to control
the vehicle and trailer.
The TSA system continuously monitors the
vehicle's movements, particularly lateral

264
06 During your trip

Emergency towing

Towing eyelet ded on the right sides of either the front or NOTE
rear bumper (see illustration).
On certain models equipped with a trailer
There are two different types of covers over hitch, the towing eyelet cannot be screwed
the openings for the towing eyelet and they into the hole in the rear bumper. The towing
have to be opened differently. rope should be attached to the trailer hitch
instead. For this reason, the detachable
• If the cover has a notch, insert a coin, section of the trailer hitch should be safely
etc., into the notch and pry open the stowed in the vehicle at all times.
edge of the cover. Open the cover com-
pletely and remove it.
• If the cover has a mark along one edge CAUTION
Location of the towing eyelet
or in a corner, press the mark while pry- If the vehicle is being towed on a flat bed
ing out the opposite side/corner using a truck, the towing eyelets must not be used
coin, etc. Open the cover and remove it. to pull the vehicle up onto the flat bed.
Screw the towing eyelet in place, first by hand
and then using the tire iron until it is securely in WARNING
place.
• Remember that the power brakes and
After the vehicle has been towed, the eyelet power steering will not function when
should be removed and returned to its storage engine is not running. The braking and
location. steering systems will function but con- 06
siderably higher pressure will be
Press the cover for the attachment point back
required on the brake pedal and greater
into position.
steering effort must be exerted.
Attaching the towing eyelet • The towing eyelets must not be used for
pulling the vehicle out of a ditch or for
Attaching the towing eyelet any similar purpose involving severe
The towing eyelet is located under the floor strain. Do not use the towing eyelets to
of the cargo area, with the spare tire and pull the vehicle up onto a flat bed tow
may be partially concealed. This eyelet truck.
must be screwed into the positions provi-

``

265
06 During your trip

Emergency towing

Precautions when the vehicle is in tow CAUTION please refer to the towing information on
• Attach jumper cables (see page 110) to page 265.
provide current for releasing the optional • Please check with state and local
electric parking brake and to move the gear authorities before attempting this type CAUTION
selector from the P position. of towing, as vehicles being towed are
subject to regulations regarding maxi- • Sling-type equipment applied at the
• The gear selector must be in position N. mum towing speed, length and type of front will damage radiator and air con-
• Maximum speed: 50 mph (80 km/h). Do not towing device, lighting, etc. ditioning lines.
exceed the maximum allowable towing •
• If the vehicle's battery is dead, do not It is equally important not to use sling-
speed. attempt to start the vehicle by pushing type equipment at the rear or apply lift-
• Maximum distance with front wheels on or pulling it as this will damage the ing equipment inside the rear wheels;
ground: 50 miles (80 km). three-way catalytic converter(s). The serious damage to the rear axle may
engine must be jump started using an result.
• While the vehicle is being towed, try to
keep the tow rope taut at all times. auxiliary battery (see page 110). • If the vehicle is being towed on a flat bed
• The vehicle should only be towed in the • If the vehicle is being towed on a flat bed truck, the towing eyelets must not be
forward direction. truck, the towing eyelets must not be used to secure the vehicle on the flat
used to pull the vehicle up onto the flat bed. Consult the tow truck operator.
bed or to secure the vehicle on the flat
NOTE bed. Consult the tow truck operator.
During towing, ignition mode II should be
06 used so that the lighting can be switched on.
Towing vehicles with front wheel drive/
All Wheel Drive
CAUTION Volvo recommends the use of flat bed equip-
Vehicles with AWD (All Wheel Drive) with the ment.
front wheels off the ground should not be • If wheel lift equipment must be used,
towed at speeds above 50 mph (70 km/h) or please use extreme caution to help avoid
for distances longer than 30 miles (50 km). damage to the vehicle. In this case, the
vehicle should be towed with the rear
wheels on the ground if at all possible.
• If it is absolutely necessary to tow the vehi-
cle with the front wheels on the ground,

266
06 During your trip

06

267
General information .............................................................................. 270
Tire inflation........................................................................................... 273
Inflation pressure—U.S. models .......................................................... 275
Inflation pressure—Canadian models................................................... 276
Tire designations .................................................................................. 277
Glossary of tire terminology ................................................................. 279
Vehicle loading ..................................................................................... 280
Uniform Tire Quality Grading ............................................................... 282
Snow chains, snow tires, studded tires ............................................... 283
Temporary Spare ................................................................................. 284
Tire Sealing System.............................................................................. 285
Changing a wheel ................................................................................ 291
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)............................................. 294

268
WHEELS AND TIRES
07 Wheels and tires

General information

Introduction without the "all-season" rating. However, for Tire age


Your vehicle is equipped with tires according optimum road holding on icy or snow-covered Tires degrade over time, even when they are
to the vehicle's tire information placard on the roads, we recommend suitable winter tires on not being used. It is recommended that tires
B-pillar (the structural member at the side of all four wheels. generally be replaced after 6 years of normal
the vehicle, at the rear of the driver's door When replacing tires, be sure that the new tires service. Heat caused by hot climates, frequent
opening). are the same size designation, type (radial) and high loading conditions or Ultra Violet (U.V.)
preferably from the same manufacturer, on all exposure can accelerate the aging process.
CAUTION four wheels. Otherwise there is a risk of altering The temporary spare1 should also be replaced
the car's roadholding and handling characte- at 6-year intervals, even if it has never been
Some Volvo models are equipped with an used.
Ultra High Performance tire and wheel com- ristics.
bination designed to provide maximum dry A tire's age can be determined by the DOT
pavement performance with consideration New Tires stamp on the sidewall (see the illustration).
for hydroplaning resistance. They may be
more susceptible to road hazard damage A tire with e.g., visible cracks or discoloration
and, depending on driving conditions, may should be replaced immediately.
achieve a tread life of less than 20,000 miles
(30,000 km). Even if this vehicle is equipped Improving tire economy
with Volvo’s advanced AWD or DSTC sys- • Maintain correct tire pressure. See the tire
tem, these tires are not designed for winter inflation tables beginning on page 275.
driving, and should be replaced with winter
tires when weather conditions dictate. • Drive smoothly: avoid fast starts, hard
braking and tire screeching.

The tires have good road holding characteris-


• Tire wear increases with speed.
tics and offer good handling on dry and wet • Correct front wheel alignment is very
surfaces. It should be noted however that the important.
07
tires have been developed to give these fea- Remember that tires are perishable goods. As • Unbalanced wheels impair tire economy
tures on snow/ice-free surfaces. of 2000, the manufacturing week and year and driving comfort.
(Department of Transportation (DOT) stamp)
Most models are equipped with "all-season" will be indicated with 4 digits (e.g., 1510 means
• Tires must maintain the same direction of
tires, which provide a somewhat higher degree rotation throughout their lifetime.
that the tire illustrated was manufactured dur-
of road holding on slippery surfaces than tires ing week 15 of 2010).

1 Option or accessory on some models

270
07 Wheels and tires

General information

• When replacing tires, the tires with the • Incorrectly mounted tires impair the car's WARNING
most tread should be mounted on the rear braking properties and ability to force
wheels to reduce the chance of oversteer aside rain, snow and slush. • The wheel and tire sizes for your Volvo
during hard braking. are specified to meet stringent stability
• The tires with the most tread should always and handling requirements. Unap-
• Hitting curbs or potholes can damage the be at the rear (to reduce the risk of skid-
proved wheel/tire size combinations
tires and/or wheels permanently. ding).
can negatively affect your vehicle's sta-
Summer and winter tires • Contact a Volvo workshop if you are bility and handling.
unsure about the tread depth.
• Any damage caused by installation of
Storing wheels and tires unapproved wheel/tire size combina-
When storing complete wheels (tires mounted tions will not be covered by your new
on rims), they should be suspended off the vehicle warranty. Volvo assumes no
responsibility for death, injury, or
floor or placed on their sides on the floor.
expenses that may result from such
Tires not mounted on rims should be stored on installations.
their sides or standing upright, but should not
be suspended.
Tire wear
G021778

CAUTION
Tire rotation
Tires should preferably be stored in a cool, Your vehicle has no required tire rotation. Tire
The arrows shows the direction of rotation of the dry, dark place, and should never be stored wear is affected by a number of factors such
tire in close proximity to solvents, gasoline, oils, as tire inflation, ambient temperature, driving
etc.
• When switching between summer and style, etc.
winter tires, mark the tires to indicate
where they were mounted on the car, e.g., 07
LF = left front, RR = right rear
• Tires with tread designed to roll in only one
direction are marked with an arrow on the
sidewall.

``

271
07 Wheels and tires

General information

NOTE are printed on the side of the tire. When


approximately 1/16" (1.6 mm) is left on the
• If the tires are rotated, they should only tread, these strips become visible and indicate
be moved from front to rear or vice that the tire should be replaced. Tires with less
versa. They should never be rotated left than 1/16" (1.6 mm) tread offer very poor trac-
to right/right to left. tion.
• Ideally, tire rotation should be done the
When replacing worn tires, it is recommended
first time after approximately 3,000
miles (5,000 km) and thereafter at that the tire be identical in type (radial) and size
6,000-mile (10,000-km) intervals. Some as the one being replaced. Using a tire of the
customers find that tire rotation may same make (manufacturer) will prevent altera-
help to get extra mileage from tire life. tion of the driving characteristics of the vehicle.
• Tire rotation should only be performed
if front/rear tire wear is fairly even and
tread height is above 1/16" (1.6 mm).

Tread wear indicator

07
G021829

The tires have wear indicator strips running


across or parallel to the tread. The letters TWI

272
07 Wheels and tires

Tire inflation

Inflation placard NOTE WARNING


• The placards shown indicate inflation • Under-inflation is the most common
pressure for the tires installed on the cause of tire failure and may result in
vehicle at the factory only. severe tire cracking, tread separation,
• A certain amount of air seepage from or "blow-out," with unexpected loss of
the tires occurs naturally and tire pres- vehicle control and increased risk of
sure fluctuates with seasonal changes injury.
in temperature. Always check tire pres- • Under-inflated tires reduce the load car-
sure regularly. rying capacity of your vehicle.

G032521
• Use a tire gauge to check the tire inflation When weather temperature changes occur, tire
pressure, including the spare, at least once inflation pressures also change. A 10-degree
Tire inflation placard a month and before long trips. You are temperature drop causes a corresponding
strongly urged to buy a reliable tire pres- drop of 1 psi (7 kPa) in inflation pressure. Check
Tire inflation sure gauge, as automatic service station your tire pressures frequently and adjust them
Check tire inflation pressure regularly. gauges may be inaccurate. to the proper pressure, which can be found on
See the tire inflation tables beginning on page • Use the recommended cold inflation pres- the vehicle's tire information placard or certifi-
275. A tire inflation pressure placard is also sure for optimum tire performance and cation label.
located on the driver's side B-pillar (the struc- wear.
Checking tire pressure
tural member at the side of the vehicle, at the • Under-inflation or over-inflation may cause
rear of the driver's door opening). This placard uneven treadwear patterns. Cold tires
indicates the designation of the factory-moun- Inflation pressure should be checked when the
ted tires on your vehicle, as well as load limits NOTE tires are cold.
07
and inflation pressure. A certain amount of air seepage from the The tires are considered to be cold when
tires occurs naturally and tire pressure fluc- they have the same temperature as the sur-
tuates with seasonal changes in tempera- rounding (ambient) air.
ture. Always check tire pressure regularly.
This temperature is normally reached after the
vehicle has been parked for at least 3 hours.

``

273
07 Wheels and tires

Tire inflation

After driving a distance of approximately 6. Repeat this procedure for each tire, includ- Speed ratings
1 mile (1.6 km), the tires are considered to be ing the spare.
hot. If you have to drive farther than this dis- W 168 mph (270 km/h)
tance to pump your tire(s), check and record NOTE
the tire pressure first and add the appropriate Y 186 mph (300 km/h)
air pressure when you get to the pump. • If you overfill the tire, release air by
pushing on the metal stem in the center Load ratings
If checking tire pressure when the tire is hot, of the valve. Then recheck the pressure See page 277 for an explanation of the load
never "bleed" or reduce air pressure. The tires with your tire gauge. rating on the sidewall of the tire.
are hot from driving and it is normal for pres- • Some spare tires require higher inflation
sures to increase above recommended cold pressure than the other tires. Consult
pressures. A hot tire at or below recommended the tire inflation tables or see the infla-
cold inflation pressure could be significantly tion pressure placard.
under-inflated.
To check inflation pressure:
1. Remove the cap from the valve on one tire, Tire ratings
then firmly press the tire gauge onto the
Speed ratings
valve.
The speed ratings in the table translate as fol-
2. Add air to reach the recommended air low:
pressure.
3. Replace the valve cap. Speed ratings
4. Visually inspect the tires to make sure there M 81 mph (130 km/h)
are no nails or other objects embedded
07 that could puncture the tire and cause an Q 100 mph (160 km/h)
air leak.
T 118 mph (190 km/h)
5. Check the sidewalls to make sure there are
no gouges, cuts, bulges or other irregular- H 130 mph (210 km/h)
ities.
V 149 mph (240 km/h)

274
07 Wheels and tires

Inflation pressure—U.S. models

Tire inflation pressure table


The following tire pressures are recommended by Volvo for your vehicle. Refer to the tire inflation placard (see page 273 for its location) for information
specific to the tires installed on your vehicle at the factory.
Tire size Cold tire pressure for up to 5 persons
Front Rear
psi/kPa psi/kPa

235/65 R17 35/240 35/240


235/60 R18
235/55 R19
255/45 R20

Temporary spare tire 61/420 61/420

07

275
07 Wheels and tires

Inflation pressure—Canadian models

Tire inflation pressure table


The following tire pressures are recommended by Volvo for your vehicle. Refer to the tire inflation placard (see page 273 for its location) for information
specific to the tires installed on your vehicle at the factory.
Tire size Cold tire pressure for up to 5 persons Optional tire pressure for up to 3 persons
Front Rear Front Rear
psi/kPa psi/kPa psi/kPa psi/kPa

235/65 R17 39/270 39/270 35/240 35/240


235/60 R18
235/55 R19
255/45 R20

Temporary spare tire 61/420 61/420 61/420 61/420

07

276
07 Wheels and tires

Tire designations

Information on the sidewall 1. 215: the width of the tire (in millimeters) 7. M+S or M/S = Mud and Snow, AT = All
from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. The Terrain, AS = All Season
5 6 7 9 8 larger the number, the wider the tire. 8. U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number
2. 65: The ratio of the tire's height to its width (TIN): This begins with the letters "DOT"
in percent. and indicates that the tire meets all federal
4 3. R: Radial tire. standards. The next two numbers or letters
10 are the plant code where it was manufac-
3 4. 15: The diameter of the wheel rim (in tured, the next two are the tire size code
inches). and the last four numbers represent the
2 5. 95: The tire's load index. In this example, a week and year the tire was built. For exam-
11
1 load index of 95 equals a maximum load of ple, 1510 means that the tire was manu-
G010753
12 1521 lbs (690 kg). factured during week 15 of 2010. The num-
6. H: The tire's speed rating, or the maximum bers in between are marketing codes used
speed at which the tire is designed to be at the manufacturer's discretion. This infor-
Federal law mandates that tire manufacturers
driven for extended periods of time, carry- mation helps a tire manufacturer identify a
place standardized information on the sidewall
ing a permissible load for the vehicle, and tire for safety recall purposes.
of all tires (see the illustration).
with correct inflation pressure. For exam- 9. Tire Ply Composition and Material
The following information is listed on the tire ple, H indicates a speed rating of 130 mph Used: Indicates the number of plies indi-
sidewall: (210 km/h). cates or the number of layers of rubber-
The tire designation: coated fabric in the tire tread and sidewall.
NOTE Tire manufacturers also must indicate the
NOTE ply materials in the tire and the sidewall,
The tire's load index and speed rating may
which include steel, nylon, polyester, and
Please be aware that the following tire des- not appear on the sidewall because they are
not required by law. others. 07
ignation is an example only and that this
particular tire may not be available on your 10. Maximum Load: Indicates the maximum
vehicle. load in pounds and kilograms that can be
carried by the tire. Refer to the vehicle's tire
information placard located on the B-Pillar
for the correct tire pressure for your vehi-
cle.

``

277
07 Wheels and tires

Tire designations

11. Treadwear, Traction, and Temperature


grades: see page 282 for more informa-
tion.
12. Maximum permissible inflation
pressure: the greatest amount of air pres-
sure that should ever be put in the tire. This
limit is set by the tire manufacturer.

07

278
07 Wheels and tires

Glossary of tire terminology

Terms • PSI: Pounds per square inch, a standard B-pillar and in the tire inflation table in this
The tire suppliers may have additional mark- unit of air pressure. chapter.
ings, notes or warnings such as standard load, • B-pillar: The structural member at the side • Cold tires: The tires are considered to be
radial tubeless, etc. of the vehicle behind the front door. cold when they have the same temperature
• Bead area of the tire: Area of the tire next as the surrounding (ambient) air. This tem-
• Tire information placard: A placard perature is normally reached after the vehi-
showing the OE (Original Equipment) tire to the rim.
cle has been parked for at least 3 hours.
sizes, recommended inflation pressure, • Sidewall of the tire: Area between the
and the maximum weight the vehicle can bead area and the tread.
carry.
• Tread area of the tire: Area of the perim-
• Tire Identification Number (TIN): A num- eter of the tire that contacts the road when
ber on the sidewall of each tire providing mounted on the vehicle.
information about the tire brand and man-
ufacturing plant, tire size and date of man-
• Rim: The metal support (wheel) for a tire or
a tire and tube assembly upon which the
ufacturer. tire beads are seated.
• Inflation pressure: A measure of the • Maximum load rating: a figure indicating
amount of air in a tire. the maximum load in pounds and kilo-
• Standard load: A class of P-metric or Met- grams that can be carried by the tire. This
ric tires designed to carry a maximum load rating is established by the tire manufac-
at 35 psi [37 psi (2.5 bar) for Metric tires]. turer.
Increasing the inflation pressure beyond
this pressure will not increase the tires load
• Maximum permissible inflation
pressure: the greatest amount of air pres-
carrying capability. sure that should ever be put in the tire. This
• Extra load: A class of P-metric or Metric limit is set by the tire manufacturer.
tires designed to carry a heavier maximum 07
load at 41 psi [43 psi (2.9 bar) for Metric
• Recommended tire inflation pressure:
inflation pressure, established by Volvo,
tires]. Increasing the inflation pressure which is based on the type of tires that are
beyond this pressure will not increase the mounted on a vehicle at the factory. This
tire's load carrying capability. information can be found on the tire infla-
• kPa: Kilopascal, a metric unit of air pres- tion placard(s) located on the driver's side
sure.

279
07 Wheels and tires

Vehicle loading

Loads Permissible axle weight 2. Determine the combined weight of the


Properly loading your vehicle will provide maxi- The maximum allowable weight that can be driver and passengers that will be riding in
mum return of vehicle design performance. carried by a single axle (front or rear). These your vehicle.
numbers are shown on the Federal/Canadian 3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver
Before loading your vehicle, familiarize yourself Motor Vehicle Safety Standards (FMVSS/
with the following terms for determining your and passengers from XXX kilograms or
CMVSS) label. The total load on each axle must XXX pounds.
vehicle's weight ratings, with or without a never exceed its maximum permissible weight.
trailer, from the vehicle's Federal/Canadian 4. The resulting figure equals the available
Motor Vehicle Safety Standards (FMVSS/ Gross vehicle weight (GVW) amount of cargo and luggage load
CMVSS) label, and the vehicle's tire informa- The vehicle's curb weight + cargo + passen- capacity. For example, if the "XXX" amount
tion placard: gers. equals 1400 lbs. and there will be five
150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the
Curb weight amount of available cargo and luggage
The weight of the vehicle including a full tank
NOTE
load capacity is 650 lbs. (1400 – 750
of fuel and all standard equipment. It does not • The location of the various labels in your (5 × 150) = 650 lbs.)
include passengers, cargo, or optional equip- vehicle can be found on page 336.
ment. 5. Determine the combined weight of luggage
• A table listing important weight limits for
your vehicle can be found on page and cargo being loaded on the vehicle.
Capacity weight 339. That weight may not safely exceed the
All weight added to the curb weight, including available cargo and luggage load capacity
cargo and optional equipment. When towing, calculated in Step 4.
trailer hitch tongue load is also part of cargo Steps for Determining Correct Load
Limit 6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load
weight.
from your trailer will be transferred to your
1. Locate the statement "the combined
weight of occupants and cargo should vehicle. Consult this manual1 to determine
NOTE how this reduces the available cargo and
07 never exceed XXX pounds" on your vehi-
For trailer towing information, please refer to cle's placard. luggage load capacity of your vehicle.
the section "Towing a trailer" on page 262.

1 See page 262.

280
07 Wheels and tires

Vehicle loading

WARNING
• Exceeding the permissible axle weight,
gross vehicle weight, or any other
weight rating limits can cause tire over-
heating resulting in permanent defor-
mation or catastrophic failure.
• Do not use replacement tires with lower
load carrying capacities than the tires
that were original equipment on the
vehicle because this will lower the vehi-
cle's GVW rating. Use only tires with the
correct load carrying capacity. Consult
your Volvo retailer for information.

07

281
07 Wheels and tires

Uniform Tire Quality Grading

Quality grading information may have poor traction performance. The trac- WARNING
ALL PASSENGER VEHICLE TIRES MUST tion grade assigned to this tire is based on
braking (straight-ahead) traction tests and is The temperature grade for this tire is estab-
CONFORM TO FEDERAL SAFETY lished for a tire that is properly inflated and
REQUIREMENTS IN ADDITION TO THESE not a measure of cornering (turning) traction.
not overloaded. Excessive speed, under-
GRADES inflation, or excessive loading, either sepa-
WARNING rately or in combination, can cause heat
Quality grades can be found, where appli-
buildup and tire failure.
cable, on the tire sidewall between the tread The traction grade assigned to this tire is
shoulder and maximum section width. For based on braking (straight-ahead) traction
example: tests and is not a measure of cornering
(turning) traction.
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A

TREADWEAR TEMPERATURE
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating The temperature grades are A (the highest), B,
based on the wear rate of the tire when tested and C, representing the tire's resistance to the
under controlled conditions on a specified gov- generation of heat and its ability to dissipate
ernment test course. For example, a tire gra- heat when tested under controlled conditions
ded 150 would wear one and one half (1 1/2) on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel.
times as well on the government course as a Sustained high temperature can cause the
tire graded 100. The relative performance of material of the tire to degenerate and reduce
tires depends upon the actual conditions of tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to
their use, however, and many depart signifi- sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds
cantly from the norm due to variation in driving to a minimum level of performance that all pas-
habits, maintenance practices and differences senger vehicle tires must meet under the Fed-
07 in road characteristics and climate. eral Motor Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B
and A represent higher levels of performance
TRACTION on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are required by law.
AA, A, B, and C, as measured under controlled
conditions on specified government test sur-
faces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C

282
07 Wheels and tires

Snow chains, snow tires, studded tires

Winter driving conditions CAUTION cornering, braking, and accelerating. Fail-


ure to do so could reduce traction to an
Snow chains • Check local regulations regarding the unsafe level or adversely affect handling.
Snow chains can be used on your Volvo with use of snow chains before installing.
• Do not mix tires of different design as this
the following restrictions: • Use single-sided snow chains only. could also negatively affect overall tire road
• Snow chains should be installed on front • Always follow the chain manufacturer's grip.
wheels only. Use only Volvo approved installation instructions carefully. Install • Winter tires wear more quickly on dry roads
snow chains. chains as tightly as possible and in warm weather. They should be removed
• If accessory, aftermarket or "custom" tires retighten periodically. when the winter driving season has ended.
and wheels are installed and are of a size • Never exceed the chain manufacturer's • Studded tires should be run-in
different than the original tires and wheels, specified maximum speed limit. (Under 300 – 600 miles (500 – 1000 km) during
chains in some cases CANNOT be used. no circumstances should you exceed which the vehicle should be driven as
Sufficient clearances between chains and 31 mph (50 km/h). smoothly as possible to give the studs the
brakes, suspension and body components • Avoid bumps, holes or sharp turns opportunity to seat properly in the tires.
must be maintained. when driving with snow chains. The tires should have the same rotational
• Some strap-on type chains will interfere direction throughout their entire lifetime.
• The handling of the vehicle can be
with brake components and therefore adversely affected when driving with
CANNOT be used. chains. Avoid fast or sharp turns as well NOTE
• All Wheel Drive models: Snow chains as locked wheel braking. Please consult state or provincial regula-
should only be installed on the front tions restricting the use of studded winter
wheels. tires before installing such tires.
Snow tires, studded tires1
• Certain size tires may not allow the assem-
bly of snow chains/traction devices. Tires for winter use:
Consult your Volvo retailer for additional snow
• Owners who live in or regularly commute 07
through areas with sustained periods of
chain information. snow or icy driving conditions are strongly
advised to fit suitable winter tires to help
retain the highest degree of traction.
• It is important to install winter tires on all
four wheels to help retain traction during

1 Where permitted

283
07 Wheels and tires

Temporary Spare

Spare tire
The spare tire in your vehicle1 is called a "Tem-
porary Spare".
Recommended tire pressure (see the placard
on the B-pillar or on the fuel filler door) should
be maintained irrespective of which position on
the vehicle the temporary spare tire is used on.
In the event of damage to this tire, a new one
can be purchased from your Volvo retailer.

WARNING
Current legislation prohibits the use of the
"Temporary Spare" tire other than as a tem-
porary replacement for a punctured tire. It
must be replaced as soon as possible by a
standard tire. Road holding and handling
may be affected with the "Temporary
Spare" in use. Do not exceed 50 mph
(80 km/h).

CAUTION
The vehicle must not be driven with wheels
07 of different dimensions or with a spare tire
other than the one that came with the vehi-
cle. The use of different size wheels can
seriously damage your car's transmission.

1 Not on models equipped with the Tire sealing system.

284
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Sealing System

Location Accessing the tire sealing system WARNING


The tire sealing system is stowed under the
floor of the cargo area. To access it: • After using the tire sealing system, the
vehicle should not be driven farther than
1. Lift the floor hatch in the cargo area. approximately 120 miles (200 km).
2. Lift out the tire sealing system. • Have the tire inspected by a trained and
qualified Volvo service technician as
NOTE soon as possible to determine if it can
be permanently repaired or must be
• The tire sealing system is only intended replaced.
to seal holes on the tire’s tread area, not
the sidewall. • The vehicle should not be driven faster
than 50 mph (80 km/h) while using a tire
• Tires with large holes or tears cannot be that has been temporarily repaired with
repaired with the tire sealing system. the tire sealing system.
Introduction • After use, stow the tire sealing system
• After using the tire sealing system, drive
properly to help prevent rattling. carefully and avoid abrupt steering
Certain models are equipped with a tire sealing
system* that enables you to temporarily seal a maneuvers and sudden stops.
hole in the tread surface and re-inflate a flat tire,
or to adjust a tire’s inflation pressure.
The system consists of an air compressor, a
container for the sealing compound, wiring to
connect the system to the vehicle’s electrical
system via one of the 12-volt sockets, and a
hose used to connect the system to the tire’s 07
inflation valve.
The 12-volt sockets are located in the front
tunnel console, on the rear side of the center
console in the rear seat and in the cargo
area*, see page 195.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 285


07 Wheels and tires

Tire Sealing System

Tire sealing system–overview WARNING • Inhalation: Move the person to fresh air.
If irritation persists, get medical atten-
Please keep the following points in mind tion.
when using the tire sealing system:
• The sealing compound bottle (no. 8 in
NOTE
the illustration) contains 1.2-Ethanol
and natural rubber-latex. These sub- Do not break the seal on the bottle. This
stances are harmful if swallowed. occurs automatically when the bottle is
screwed into the holder.
• The contents of this bottle may cause
allergic skin reactions or otherwise be
potentially harmful to the skin, the cen-
tral nervous system, and the eyes.
Precautions:
Speed limit sticker • Keep out of reach of children.

On/Off switch • Do not ingest the contents.


• Avoid prolonged or repeated contact
Electrical wire with the skin.
Bottle holder (orange cover) • Hands should be washed thoroughly
after handling.
Protective hose cover First aid:
Air release knob • Skin: Wash affected areas of skin with
soap and water. Get medical attention
Hose
07 if symptoms occur.
Bottle with sealing compound • Eyes: Flush with plenty of water for least
15 minutes, occasionally lifting the
Air pressure gauge upper and lower eyelids. Get medical
attention if symptoms occur.

286
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Sealing System

Tire sealing system–temporarily NOTE WARNING


repairing a flat tire
Do not remove any foreign objects (nails, Contact with the sealing compound may
etc.) from the tire before using the sealing cause skin irritation. If contact occurs, wash
system. the affected area immediately with soap and
water.
• Stage 2: The tire’s inflation pressure is
checked and adjusted if necessary. 4. Unscrew the orange cover over the bottle
holder and unscrew the cap on the bottle
WARNING of sealing compound.

• Never leave the tire sealing system


NOTE
unattended when it is operating.
• Keep the tire sealing system away from Do not break the seal on the bottle. This
children. occurs automatically when the bottle is
screwed into the holder.
• Be sure the vehicle is parked safely off
the road and away from moving traffic.
5. Screw the bottle into the bottle holder.
• Apply the parking brake.
WARNING
Stage 1: Sealing the hole
The bottle is equipped with a catch to keep
1. Open the cover on the tire sealing kit. it securely in place and help prevent sealing
G014338

2. Peel off the speed limit sticker and affix it compound leakage. Once in place, the bot-
to the steering wheel hub where it will be tle cannot be unscrewed. This must be done
Temporarily repairing a flat tire is done in two by a trained and qualified Volvo service 07
clearly visible to the driver.
stages: technician.
3. Ensure that the on/off switch is in posi-
• Stage 1: The hole is sealed by pumping tion 0 (the 0 side of the switch should be 6. Remove the valve cap from the tire’s infla-
sealing compound into the tire. The car is pressed down).
then driven a short distance to distribute tion valve and screw the tire sealing sys-
the sealing compound in the tire. tem’s hose connector onto the valve as
tightly as possible by hand.

``

287
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Sealing System

7. Connect the electrical wire to the nearest NOTE 12. Unscrew the hose from the tire’s inflation
12-volt socket in the vehicle. valve and reinstall the valve cap.
The air pressure gauge will temporarily
8. Start the vehicle’s engine. show an increase in pressure to approxi- 13. Immediately drive the vehicle for approxi-
mately 88 psi (6 bar) while the sealing com- mately 2 miles (3 km) at a maximum speed
WARNING pound is being pumped into the tire. The of 50 mph (80 km/h) to distribute the seal-
pressure should return to a normal level ing compound in the tire.
The vehicle´s engine should be running after approximately 30 seconds.
when the tire sealing system is used to avoid
battery drain. Therefore, be sure the vehicle CAUTION
is parked in a well ventilated place, or out- 10. Within seven minutes, inflate the tire to
If your vehicle is equipped with the Tire
doors, before using the system. between 22—44 psi (1.8—3.0 bar). Switch
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS), the
off the compressor briefly to get a clear use of the sealing compound may lead to
reading from the pressure gauge. incorrect tire pressure readings or in rare
9. Start the tire sealing system’s compressor
by pressing the on/off switch to position I. cases, damage to the tire pressure sensor.
CAUTION Use the tire sealing system to check and
adjust the damaged tire's inflation pressure.
WARNING The compressor should not be used for
more than 10 minutes at a time to avoid
• Never stand next to the tire being inflated overheating. NOTE
when the compressor is in operation.
• If cracks, bubbles, etc. form on the tire, • Safely stow the tire sealing system in a
switch off the compressor immediately. WARNING convenient place as it will soon be used
again to check the tire’s inflation pres-
• If there is visible damage to the sidewall If the pressure remains below 22 psi
sure.
or the rim, the tire cannot be repaired. (1.8 bar) after approximately seven minutes,
The vehicle should not be driven if this turn off the compressor. In this case, the • The empty bottle of sealing compound
07 occurs. Contact a towing service or hole is too large to be sealed and the vehicle cannot be removed from the bottle
should not be driven. holder. Consult a trained and qualified
Volvo On Call Roadside Assistance if
applicable. Volvo service technician to have the
11. Switch off the compressor and disconnect bottle removed and properly disposed
the electrical wire from the 12-volt socket. of.

288
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Sealing System

WARNING Replacing the sealing compound Inflating tires


container The tire sealing system can be used to inflate
If heavy vibrations, unsteady steering
behavior, or noises should occur while driv- The sealing compound container must be the tires. To do so:
ing, reduce speed and park the vehicle in a replaced if:
1. Park the car in a safe place.
safe place. Recheck the tire for bumps, • the tire sealing system has been used to
cracks, or other visible damage, and 2. The compressor should be switched off.
repair a tire
recheck its inflation pressure. If the pressure Ensure that the on/off switch is in position
is below 19 psi (1.3 bar), do not continue • the container’s expiration date has passed
driving. Have the vehicle towed to a trained (see the date on decal). 0 (the 0 side of the switch should be
and qualified Volvo service technician. pressed down).
NOTE 3. Take out the electrical wire and hose.
Stage 2: Checking inflation pressure • After use, the sealing compound bottle, 4. Remove the valve cap from the tire’s infla-
1. Connect the tire sealing system as descri- the hose, and certain other system tion valve and screw the hose connector
bed in stage 1. components must be replaced. Please onto the valve as tightly as possible by
2. Refer to the inflation pressure tables for the consult your Volvo retailer for replace- hand.
ment parts.
correct inflation pressure. If the tire needs 5. Connect the electrical wire to the nearest
to be inflated, start the tire sealing system’s • If the sealing compound bottle’s expi- 12-volt socket in the vehicle.
compressor. If necessary, release air from ration date has passed, please take it to
the tire by turning the air release knob a Volvo retailer or a recycling station 6. Start the vehicle’s engine.
counterclockwise. that can properly dispose of harmful
substances. WARNING
CAUTION • The vehicle’s engine should be running
The compressor should not be used for when the tire sealing system is used to
more than 10 minutes at a time to avoid avoid battery drain. Therefore, be sure 07
overheating. the vehicle is parked in a well ventilated
place, or outdoors, before using the sys-
tem.
WARNING
• Children should never be left unattended
If you interrupt your trip for more than 1 in the vehicle when the engine is running.
hour, check the inflation pressure in the
damaged tire again before continuing.

``

289
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Sealing System

7. Check the tire’s inflation pressure on the


gauge. Switch off the compressor briefly to
get a clear reading from the pressure
gauge.
8. Refer to the tire inflation tables for the cor-
rect inflation pressure. If the tire needs to
be inflated, start the tire sealing system’s
compressor (press the on/off switch to
position I). If necessary, release air from the
tire by turning the air release knob coun-
terclockwise.

CAUTION
The compressor should not be used for
more than 10 minutes at a time to avoid
overheating.

9. Turn off the compressor (press the on/off


switch to position 0) when the correct infla-
tion pressure has been reached.
10. Unscrew the hose from the tire’s inflation
valve and reinstall the valve cap.
07 11. Disconnect the electrical wire from the
12-volt socket.

290
07 Wheels and tires

Changing a wheel

Removing a wheel WARNING After use


The foam block and spare wheel must be
Current legislation prohibits the use of the replaced in the reverse order. Note the arrow
“Temporary Spare” tire other than as a tem-
porary replacement for a punctured tire. It on the upper foam block. It should point for-
must be replaced as soon as possible by a ward.
standard tire. Road holding and handling
may be affected with the “Temporary Changing a wheel
Spare” in use. 1. Apply the parking brake and put the gear
selector in P.

CAUTION 2. Take out the jack*, lug wrench*, the towing


eyelet and the wheel cover removal tool*
The vehicle must never be driven with more stowed under the floor of the trunk.
than one temporary spare wheel.
3. Remove the wheel cover (where applica-
Location of jack*, towing eyelet1 and tools* ble) using the removal tool or remove the
The spare wheel is located in the spare wheel
Spare wheel wheel cover by hand.
well with the rim side down. There are two foam
The spare wheel is only intended for temporary blocks, one under the spare wheel and one 4. Block the wheels that are on the ground
use. Replace it with a normal wheel as soon as over/inside. The upper one contains all tools. with wooden blocks or large stones.
possible. The car's handling may be altered by
the use of the spare wheel. The correct tire The same bolt runs through to secure the spare
pressure for the spare wheel is stated in the tire wheel and the foam blocks.
pressure tables beginning on page 275. Taking out the spare wheel
1. Open the floor hatch.
2. Undo the retaining bolt. 07
3. Lift out the foam block with tools.
4. Lift out the spare wheel.
The other two blocks can remain in the spare
wheel well.

1 The towing eyelet may be partially concealed under the rear edge of the cargo area. See the illustration on page 265 for its location.
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 291


07 Wheels and tires

Changing a wheel

Jack attachment points


7. There are two jack attachment points on
Lug wrench and towing eyelet each side of the vehicle. Position the jack
6. With the vehicle still on the ground, use the
5. Screw the towing eyelet into the lug correctly in the attachment (see the illus-
lug wrench/towing eyelet to loosen the
wrench as shown in the illustration. tration) and crank while simultaneously
wheel nuts ½ – 1 turn by exerting down-
guiding the base of the jack to the ground.
ward (counterclockwise) pressure.
The base of the jack must be flat on a level,
CAUTION firm, non-slippery surface. Before raising
The towing eyelet must be screwed into the the vehicle, check that the jack is still cor-
lug wrench as far as possible. rectly positioned in the attachment.

07

292
07 Wheels and tires

Changing a wheel

WARNING
• The jack must correctly engage the jack
attachment.
• Be sure the jack is on a firm, level, non-
slippery surface.
• Never allow any part of your body to be
extended under a vehicle supported by
a jack.
• Use the jack intended for the vehicle
when changing a tire. For any other job,
use stands to support the vehicle.
Tighten the lug nuts
• Apply the parking brake and put the
WARNING gear selector in the Park (P) position. 3. Install the wheel nuts and tighten hand-
tight. Using the lug wrench, tighten cross-
There are two attachment points near the • Block the wheels standing on the
rear of the vehicle. Only the rear-most ground, use rigid wooden blocks or wise until all nuts are snug.
attachment point is intended for the jack large stones. 4. Lower the vehicle to the ground and alter-
(see the illustration).
• The jack should be kept well-greased nately tighten the bolts crosswise to
and clean, and should not be damaged. 103 ft. lbs. (140 Nm).
8. Raise the vehicle until the wheel to be
changed is lifted off the ground.
• No objects should be placed between 5. Install the wheel cover (where applicable).
the base of jack and the ground, or The opening in the wheel cover for the tire's
9. Unscrew the wheel nuts completely and between the jack and the attachment inflation valve must be positioned over the
remove the wheel. bar on the vehicle. valve.
07

Re-installing the wheel


1. Clean the contact surfaces on the wheel
and hub.
2. Lift the wheel and place it on the hub.

293
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)

Introduction NOTE Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute


for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driv-
If a fault occurs in TPMS, the tire pressure er's responsibility to maintain correct tire pres-
NOTE warning light will flash for approximately sure, even if under-inflation has not reached
USA – FCC ID: KR5S122780002 1 minute and Tire press. syst Service
the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low
required will be displayed.
This device complies with part 15 of the tire pressure telltale.
FCC rules. Operation is subject to the fol-
lowing conditions: (1) This device may not Each tire, including the spare (if provided), Your vehicle has also been equipped with a
cause harmful interference, and (2) this should be checked monthly when cold and TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when
device must accept any interference inflated to the inflation pressure recommended the system is not operating properly. The
received, including interference that may by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with
cause undesired operation. the low tire pressure telltale. When the system
placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your
vehicle has tires of a different size than the size detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for
The tire pressure monitoring system1 uses sen- indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation approximately one minute and then remain
sors mounted in the tire valves to check infla- pressure label, you should determine the continuously illuminated. This sequence will
tion pressure levels. When the vehicle is mov- proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.) continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as
ing at a speed of approximately 20 mph long as the malfunction exists. When the mal-
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has function indicator is illuminated, the system
(30 km/h) or faster, these sensors transmit
been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring may not be able to detect or signal low tire
inflation pressure data to a receiver located in
system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pres- pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may
the vehicle.
sure telltale when one or more of your tires is occur for a variety of reasons, including the
When low inflation pressure is detected, TPMS significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when installation of replacement or alternate tires or
will light up the tire pressure warning light the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS
( ) (also referred to as a telltale) in the should stop and check your tires as soon as from functioning properly. Always check the
instrument panel and will display one of the possible, and inflate them to the proper pres- TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one
07 sure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated
following messages in the text window: Tire or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to
pressure low or Tire needs air now. tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires
tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to
efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the function properly.
vehicle's handling and stopping ability.

1 This system is standard on U.S. models and optional on Canadian models

294
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)

NOTE Changing wheels with TPMS CAUTION


Please note the following when changing or
TPMS indicates low tire pressure but does replacing the factory installed TPMS wheels/ When inflating tires with TPMS valves, press
not replace normal tire maintenance. For the pump's mouthpiece straight onto the
information on correct tire pressure, please tires on the vehicle: valve to help avoid bending or otherwise
refer to the Tire inflation pressure tables or • Only the factory-mounted wheels are damaging the valve.
consult your Volvo retailer. equipped with TPMS sensors in the valves.
• If the vehicle is equipped with a temporary NOTE
Erasing warning messages spare tire, this tire does not have a TPMS
When a low tire pressure warning message has sensor. • If you change to tires with a different
been displayed, and the tire pressure warning recommended inflation pressure, the
• If wheels without TPMS sensors are moun- TPMS system must be recalibrated to
light has come on: ted on the vehicle, TIRE PRESS SYST
these tires. On U.S. models, this must
1. Use a tire pressure gauge to check the SERVICE REQUIRED will be displayed
be done by a trained and qualified Volvo
inflation pressure of all four tires. each time the vehicle is driven above
service technician. On Canadian mod-
25 mph (40 km/h) for 10 minutes or more.
2. Re-inflate the tire(s) to the correct pressure els, see the following section "Recali-
(consult the tire pressure placard or the
• Once TPMS sensors are properly installed, brating TPMS."
the warning message should not reappear.
inflation pressure tables beginning on page If the message is still displayed, drive the
• If a tire is changed, or if the TPMS sen-
275. sor is moved to another wheel, the sen-
vehicle for several minutes at a speed of
sor's seal, nut, and valve core should be
3. In certain cases, it may be necessary to 20 mph (30 km/h) or faster to erase the
replaced.
drive the vehicle for several minutes at a message.
speed of 20 mph (30 km/h) or faster. This • When installing TPMS sensors, the
• Volvo recommends that TPMS sensors be vehicle must be parked for at least
will erase the warning text and the warning fitted on all wheels used on the vehicle.
15 minutes with the ignition off. If the
light will go out. Volvo does not recommend moving sen-
vehicle is driven within 15 minutes, a
sors back and forth between sets of 07
TPMS error message will be displayed.
WARNING wheels.

Incorrect inflation pressure could lead to tire Recalibrating TPMS (Canadian models
failure, resulting in a loss of control of the
vehicle.
only)
In certain cases, it may be necessary to reca-
librate TPMS to conform to Volvo's recom-
mended tire inflation pressures (see the infla-

``

295
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)

tion pressure table on page 276), for example, 3. Press the MY CAR key in the center con-
if higher inflation pressure is necessary when sole control panel and select Settings
transporting heavy loads, etc. Car settings Tire pressure
This is done in the vehicle's menu system (see 4. Select Tire pressure system ON/Off and
page 129).
press OK/MENU.
To recalibrate:
1. Switch off the engine.
2. Inflate the tires to the desired pressure and
put the ignition in mode I or II (see page
81 for additional information).
3. Press the MY CAR key in the center con-
sole control panel and select Settings
Car settings Tire pressure
4. Press OK/MENU, select Calibrate tire
pressure and press OK/MENU again.
5. Drive the vehicle at a speed above
25 mph (40 km/h) continuously for at least
1 minute.
> When the calibration message is no
longer displayed, TPMS has been reca-
07 librated to the new inflation pressure.

Activating/deactivating TPMS (Canadian


models only)
1. Switch off the engine.
2. Put the ignition in mode I or II (see page
81 for additional information).

296
07 Wheels and tires

07

297
Volvo maintenance................................................................................ 300
Maintaining your car............................................................................. 301
Hood and engine compartment............................................................ 303
Engine oil............................................................................................... 304
Fluids..................................................................................................... 306
Replacing bulbs.................................................................................... 308
Wiper blades and washer fluid.............................................................. 315
Battery................................................................................................... 317
Fuses..................................................................................................... 320
Vehicle care........................................................................................... 328

298
MAINTENANCE AND SPECIFICATIONS
08 Maintenance and specifications

Volvo maintenance

Introduction recommended that receipts for vehicle emis- prehensive periodic maintenance schedule up
Volvo advises you to follow the maintenance sion maintenance be retained in case ques- to 150,000 miles (240,000 km) of vehicle main-
program outlined in the Warranty and Service tions arise concerning maintenance. Inspec- tenance. The schedule includes components
Records Information booklet. This mainte- tion and maintenance should also be per- that affect vehicle emissions. This page
nance program contains inspections and serv- formed anytime a malfunction is observed or describes some of the emission-related com-
ices necessary for the proper function of your suspected. ponents.
vehicle. The maintenance services contain
Applicable warranties – U.S/Canada
several checks that require special tools and
In accordance with applicable U.S. and Cana-
training, and therefore must be performed by a
dian regulations, the following list of warranties
qualified technician. To keep your Volvo in top
is provided.
condition, specify time-tested and proven
Genuine Volvo Parts and Accessories. • New Vehicle Limited Warranty

The Federal Clean Air Act – U.S


• Parts and Accessories Limited Warranty
The Federal Clean Air Act requires vehicle • Corrosion Protection Limited Warranty
manufacturers to furnish written instructions to • Seat Belt and Supplemental Restraint Sys-
the ultimate purchaser to assure the proper tems Limited Warranty
servicing and function of the components that • Emission Design and Defect Warranty
control emissions. These services, which are
listed in the "Warranty and Service Records
• Emission Performance Warranty
Information" booklet, are not covered by the These are the federal warranties; other warran-
warranty. You will be required to pay for labor ties are provided as required by state/provin-
and material used. cial law. Refer to your separate Warranty and
Service Records Information booklet for
Maintenance detailed information concerning each of the
Your Volvo passed several major inspections warranties.
before it was delivered to you, in accordance
with Volvo specifications. The maintenance Periodic maintenance helps minimize
procedures outlined in the Warranty and Serv- emissions
08 Periodic maintenance will help keep your vehi-
ice Records Information booklet, many of
which will positively affect your vehicle's emis- cle running well. Your Warranty and Service
sions, should be performed as indicated. It is Records Information booklet provides a com-

300
08 Maintenance and specifications

Maintaining your car

Owner maintenance As needed: They are specially reinforced to bear the weight
Periodic maintenance requirements and inter- Wash the car, including the undercarriage, to of the vehicle. A garage jack can also be placed
vals are described in your vehicle's Warranty reduce wear that can be caused by a buildup under the front of the engine support frame.
and Service Records Information booklet. of dirt, and corrosion that can be caused by salt Take care not to damage the splash guard
residues. under the engine. Ensure that the jack is posi-
The following points can be carried out tioned so that the vehicle cannot slide off it.
between the normally scheduled maintenance Clean leaves and twigs from air intake vents at
Always use axle stands or similar structures.
services. the base of the windshield, and from other pla-
ces where they may collect. If a two-post hoist is used to lift the vehicle, the
Each time the car is refueled: front and rear lift arm pads should be centered
• Check the engine oil level. NOTE under the reinforced lift plates on the inboard
• Clean the windshield, windshield wipers, edge of the sill rail (see illustration).
Complete service information for qualified
headlights, and tail lights. technicians is available online for purchase
or subscription at www.volvotechinfo.com. Emission inspection readiness
Monthly:
• Check cold tire pressure in all tires. Inspect What is an Onboard Diagnostic System
the tires for wear. Hoisting the vehicle (OBD II)?
• Check that engine coolant and other fluid OBD II is part of your vehicle's computerized
levels are between the indicated "min" and engine management system. It stores diagnos-
"max" markings. tic information about your vehicle's emission
• Clean interior glass surfaces with a glass controls. It can light the Check Engine light
cleaner and soft paper towels. (MIL) if it detects an emission control "fault." A
• Wipe driver information displays with a soft "fault" is a component or system that is not
cloth. performing within an expected range. A fault
may be permanent or temporary. OBD II will
• Visually inspect battery terminals for cor- store a message about any fault.
rosion. Corrosion may indicate a loose ter-
minal connector, or a battery near the end How do states use OBD II for emission
of its useful service life. Consult your Volvo inspections?
retailer for additional information. 08
Many states connect a computer directly to a
If a garage jack is used to lift the vehicle, the vehicle's OBD II system. The inspector can
two jack attachments points should be used. then read "faults." In some states, this type of

``

301
08 Maintenance and specifications

Maintaining your car

inspection has replaced the tailpipe emission way driving is typically needed to allow
test. OBD II to reach readiness. Your Volvo
retailer can provide you with more infor-
How can my vehicle fail OBD II emission mation on planning a trip.
inspection? • Maintain your vehicle in accordance with
Your vehicle can fail OBD II emission inspec- your vehicle's maintenance schedule.
tion for any of the following reasons.
• If your Check Engine (MIL) light is lit, your
vehicle may fail inspection.
• If your vehicle's Check Engine light was lit,
but went out without any action on your
part, OBD II will still have a recorded fault.
Your vehicle may pass or fail, depending
on the inspection practices in your area.
• If you had recent service that required dis-
connecting the battery, OBD II diagnostic
information may be incomplete and "not
ready" for inspection. A vehicle that is not
ready may fail inspection.

How can I prepare for my next OBD II


emission inspection?
• If your Check Engine (MIL) light is lit – or
was lit but went out without service, have
your vehicle diagnosed and, if necessary,
serviced by a qualified Volvo technician.
• If you recently had service for a lit Check
Engine light, or if you had service that
08 required disconnecting the battery, a
period of driving is necessary to bring the
OBD II system to "ready" for inspection. A
half-hour trip of mixed stop-and-go/high-

302
08 Maintenance and specifications

Hood and engine compartment

Opening and closing the hood WARNING Battery

Check that the hood locks properly when Relay and fuse box
closed.
Washer fluid reservoir
Air cleaner
Engine compartment, overview
WARNING
The cooling fan may start or continue to
operate (for up to 6 minutes) after the engine
has been switched off.

WARNING
The ignition should always be completely
switched off before performing any opera-
tions in the engine compartment.
The distributor ignition system operates at
G031911

very high voltages. Special safety precau-


The appearance of the engine compartment tions must be followed to prevent injury.
Pull the lever located under the left side of may vary depending on engine model. Always turn the ignition off when:
the dash to release the hood lock. An infor- Coolant expansion tank • Replacing distributor ignition compo-
mation symbol will illuminate when the nents e.g. plugs, coil, etc.
hood is open. Power steering fluid reservoir
• Do not touch any part of the distributor
Lift the hood slightly. Press the release Engine oil dipstick ignition system while the engine is run-
control (located under the right front edge ning. This may result in unintended
Radiator movements and body injury.
of the hood) to the left, and lift the hood
Filler cap for engine oil 08
Cover over brake fluid reservoir

303
08 Maintenance and specifications

Engine oil

Checking the engine oil Checking and adding oil NOTE


The oil level should be checked at regular inter-
Before checking the oil:
vals, particularly during the period up to the
first scheduled maintenance service. • The car should be parked on a level sur-
face.
• See page 342 for oil specifications.
• If the engine is warm, wait for at least
• Refer to the Warranty and Service Records 10 – 15 minutes after the engine has
Information booklet for information on the been switched off.
oil change intervals.

CAUTION
• Not checking the oil level regularly can
result in serious engine damage if the oil
level becomes too low. Location of the filler cap and dipstick
• Oil that is lower than the specified qual-
ity can damage the engine.
• Volvo does not recommend the use of
oil additives.
• Always add oil of the same type and

G021737
viscosity as already used.
• Never fill oil above the MAX mark. This The oil level must be between the MIN and MAX
could cause an increase in oil consump- marks on the dipstick
tion.
Checking the oil
1. Pull out the dipstick and wipe it with a lint-
free rag.
Volvo recommends Castrol oil products
2. Reinsert the dipstick, pull it out, and check
08 the oil level. The level must be between the
MIN and MAX marks.

304
08 Maintenance and specifications

Engine oil

3. Add oil if necessary. If the level is close to


the MIN mark, add approximately
0.5 US quarts (0.5 liters) of oil.
4. Recheck the level and add more oil if nec-
essary until the level is near the MAX mark.

WARNING
Do not allow oil to spill onto or come into
contact with hot exhaust pipe surfaces.

NOTE
Synthetic oil is not used when the oil is
changed at the normal maintenance inter-
vals except at owner request and at addi-
tional charge. Please consult your Volvo
retailer.

08

305
08 Maintenance and specifications

Fluids

Coolant CAUTION WARNING


• If necessary, top up the cooling system • Never remove the radiator cap while the
with Volvo Genuine Coolant/Antifreeze engine is warm. Wait until the vehicle
only (a 50/50 mix of water and anti- cools.
freeze). • If it is necessary to top off the coolant
• Different types of antifreeze/coolant when the engine is warm, unscrew the
may not be mixed. expansion tank cap slowly so that the
• If the cooling system is drained, it overpressure dissipates.
should be flushed with clean water or
premixed anti-freeze before it is refilled
with the correct mixture of water/anti- Brake fluid
freeze.
Location of the coolant reservoir • The cooling system must always be
kept filled to the correct level, and the
Normally, the coolant does not need to be
level must be between the MIN and
changed. If the system must be drained, con- MAX marks. If it is not kept filled, there
sult a trained and qualified Volvo service tech- can be high local temperatures in the
nician. engine which could result in damage.
See page 343 for information on cooling sys- Check coolant regularly!
tem capacities. • Do not top up with water only. This
reduces the rust-protective and anti-
freeze qualities of the coolant and has a
lower boiling point. It can also cause
damage to the cooling system if it Location of the brake fluid reservoir
should freeze.
Checking the level
• Do not use chlorinated tap water in the The fluid reservoir is concealed under the
vehicle's cooling system.
round cover at the rear of the engine compart-
08 ment. The round cover must be removed first
before the reservoir cap can be accessed.

306
08 Maintenance and specifications

Fluids

The brake fluid should always be between the Filling WARNING


MIN and MAX marks on the inside of the res- 1. Turn and open the cover.
ervoir. Check, without removing the cap, that If a problem should occur in the power
2. Unscrew the reservoir cap and fill the fluid. steering system or if the vehicle has no elec-
there is sufficient fluid in the reservoir.
The level must be between the MIN and trical current and must be towed, it is still
Fluid type: DOT 4+ boiling point >536 °F MAX marks. possible to steer the vehicle. However, keep
in mind that greater effort will be required to
(280 °C), P/N 9437433 turn the steering wheel.
Replace: The fluid should be replaced accord- Power steering fluid
ing to the intervals specified in the Warranty CAUTION
and Service Records Information booklet.
Keep the area around the power steering
When driving under extremely hard conditions fluid reservoir clean when checking.
(mountain driving, etc), it may be necessary to
replace the fluid more often. Consult a trained
and qualified Volvo service technician.
Always entrust brake fluid changing to a
trained and qualified Volvo service technician.

WARNING
• If the fluid level is below the MIN mark
in the reservoir or if a brake-related Check the level frequently. The fluid does not
message is shown in the information require changing. The fluid level must be
display: DO NOT DRIVE. Have the car between the MIN and MAX marks. For capaci-
towed to a trained and qualified Volvo ties and recommended fluid grade, see
service technician and have the brake page 343.
system inspected.
• Dot 4+ should never be mixed with any
other type of brake fluid.
08

307
08 Maintenance and specifications

Replacing bulbs

Introduction WARNING
All bulb specifications are listed on page 314.
The following bulbs should only be replaced by
• Active Bending Lights* – due to the high
voltage used by these headlights, these
a trained and qualified Volvo service techni- bulbs should only be replaced by a
cian: trained and qualified Volvo service tech-
• Dome lighting, reading lights nician.
• Glove compartment lighting • Turn off the lights and remove the
remote key from the ignition before
• Footwell lighting
changing any bulbs.
• Turn signals in the door mirrors
• Approach lighting in the door mirrors WARNING
• Brake/fog/taillights Headlight housing • The engine should not be running when
changing bulbs.
• Rear parking lights
• Active Bending Lights • If the engine has been running just prior
to replacing bulbs in the headlight hous-
• LED bulbs ing, please keep in mind that compo-
nents in the engine compartment will be
NOTE hot.
For information regarding any other bulbs
not mentioned in this section, please con- The entire headlight housing must be lifted out
tact your Volvo retailer or a trained and when replacing all front bulbs.
authorized Volvo service technician.
CAUTION
Never touch the glass of bulbs with your fin-
gers. Grease and oils from your fingers
vaporize in the heat and will leave a deposit
on the reflector, which will damage it.
08

308 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


08 Maintenance and specifications

Replacing bulbs

NOTE Unplug the wiring connector by holding 2. Reinstall the headlight housing and locking
down the clip with your thumb. pins. Check that they are correctly
• Always switch off the ignition before inserted. The headlight housing must be
starting to replace a bulb. Pull out the connector with the other properly inserted and secured in place
• The optional Active Bending Light bulbs hand. before the lighting is switched on or the
contain trace amounts of mercury. 4. Lift out the housing and place it on a soft remote key is inserted into the ignition slot.
These bulbs should always be disposed surface to avoid scratching the lens.
of by a trained and qualified Volvo serv- 3. Check that the lights function properly.
ice technician. 5. Replace the defective bulb(s). The headlight wiring must be connected and
the housing must be securely in place before
Reinserting the headlight housing the ignition is switched on.
Removing the headlight housing
1. Switch off the ignition by briefly pressing
the START/STOP ENGINE button and Removing the cover to access the
remove the remote key from the ignition bulbs
slot1.
2. (Upper illustration under "Headlight hous-
ing")
Withdraw the headlight housing's lock-
ing pins.
Pull the headlight housing straight out.

CAUTION When reinserting the housing, be sure that the


long locking pin (to the left in the illustration) is
When disconnecting the connector, pull on
the connector itself and not on the wiring. securely in place in both of its retaining clamps.
1. Plug in the connector until it clicks into
3. (Lower illustration under "Headlight hous- place.
08
ing")

1 Does not apply to vehicles with the optional keyless drive.


``

309
08 Maintenance and specifications

Replacing bulbs

NOTE 3. Unplug the connector from the bulb. 3. Remove the bulb by turning it counter-
clockwise and pulling it straight out.
Before starting to replace a bulb, see 4. Remove the bulb by pressing the holder
page 308. downward. 4. Remove the connector from the bulb.
5. Press the new bulb into the socket until it 5. Press the new bulb into the socket and turn
1. Open the retaining clamps by pressing snaps into place. It can only be secured in it clockwise to put it in place. It can only be
them to the sides. one position. secured in one position.
2. Pull the cover straight out. 6. Put the cover back into position and rein- 6. Reinsert the bulb holder into the headlight
stall the headlight housing. housing.
Reinstall the cover in the reverse order.
7. Put the cover back into position and rein-
High beam, Halogen stall the headlight housing.
Low beam, Halogen

Extra high beam2

1. Remove the headlight housing from the


1. Remove the headlight housing from the
vehicle (see page 308).
vehicle (see page 308).
2. Remove the cover over the bulbs (see 1. Remove the headlight housing from the
2. Remove the cover over the bulbs (see
08 page 309). vehicle (see page 308).
page 309).

2 Models with optional Active Bending Lights only.

310
08 Maintenance and specifications

Replacing bulbs

2. Remove the cover over the bulbs (see 1. Remove the headlight housing from the
page 309). vehicle (see page 308).
3. Disconnect the wiring connector from the 2. Remove the bulb holder by turning it coun-
bulb holder. terclockwise and pulling it out of the head-
light housing.
4. Remove the bulb holder from the headlight
housing by pulling it straight out. 3. Pull out the holder to access the bulb.
5. Insert a new bulb in the holder until it snaps 4. Remove the burned out bulb by pressing it
in place. It can only be inserted in one way. in slightly and turning it counterclockwise.
6. Press the bulb holder into position in the 5. Press the new bulb into the holder and turn
headlight housing. it clockwise.
7. Reconnect the wiring connector to the bulb 6. Reinsert the bulb holder into the headlight
1. Remove the headlight housing from the
holder. housing and turn it clockwise.
vehicle (see page 308).
8. Put the cover back into position and rein- 7. Reinstall the headlight housing.
2. Remove the bulb holder by turning it coun-
stall the headlight housing.
terclockwise and pulling it out of the head-
Side marker lights light housing.
Turn signals 3. Pull out the burned out bulb and install a
NOTE new one. It can only be inserted in one
Before starting to replace a bulb, see position.
page 308.
4. Reinsert the bulb holder into the headlight
housing and turn it clockwise.
5. Reinstall the headlight housing.

08

``

311
08 Maintenance and specifications

Replacing bulbs

Rear fog light Location of taillight bulbs Brake lights and taillights

Taillight lens, right side


The rear fog light (located on the driver's side The brake lights and taillights are replaced from
of the vehicle) can be reached from behind the Parking/side marker lights (LED) inside the cargo area.
bumper Side reflector
1. Remove the bulb holder by turning it coun- NOTE
Brake light
terclockwise. Before starting to replace a bulb, see
2. Remove the burned out bulb by pressing it Backup light page 308.
in and turning it counterclockwise. Turn signal
1. Open the panel.
3. Insert a new bulb, press it in and turn it
Brake lights (LED)
clockwise. 2. Remove the bulb holder by turning it coun-
terclockwise.
4. Reinsert the bulb holder and turn it clock-
NOTE 3. Remove the burned out bulb by pressing it
wise.
If an error message remains in the display in and turning it counterclockwise.
after a faulty bulb has been replaced, con-
08 tact an authorized Volvo workshop. 4. Insert a new bulb, press it in and turn it
clockwise.
5. Reinsert the bulb holder and turn it clock-
wise.

312
08 Maintenance and specifications

Replacing bulbs

License plate lighting Cargo area lighting Vanity mirror lighting


Removing the mirror glass

G031942
1. Remove the screws with a screwdriver.
NOTE
2. Carefully detach the entire bulb housing 1. Insert a screwdriver underneath the lower
and pull it out. Before starting to replace a bulb, see
edge, in the center, turn and carefully pry
page 308.
3. Replace the bulb. up the lug on the edge.

4. Reinsert the entire bulb housing and 1. Insert a screwdriver and gently turn so that 2. Carefully detach and lift out the entire mir-
tighten the screws. the bulb housing comes loose. ror glass.

2. Replace the bulb. 3. Replace the bulb.

3. Check that the bulb illuminates and press Reinstalling the mirror glass
it back into the bulb housing. 1. Press the three lugs at top edge of the mir-
ror glass back into position.
2. Press the three lower lugs back into posi-
tion.
08

``

313
08 Maintenance and specifications

Replacing bulbs

Bulb specifications
Lighting Wattage Bulb
function
Active Bend- 65 H9
ing Lights
(extra high
beam)

Low beam 55 H7
(halogen)

High beam 65 H9
(halogen)

Front turn sig- 21 PY21W


nals

Cargo area 5 Festoon


lighting, bulb
license plate SV5.5
lighting

Vanity mirror 1.2 Festoon


bulb
SV5.5

Front side 5 W3W


marker lights

08 Glove com- 5 Festoon


partment bulb
lighting SV8.5

314
08 Maintenance and specifications

Wiper blades and washer fluid

Wiper blades 4. With the remote key in the ignition slot1, put
The windshield wiper blades are different the ignition in mode 0.
lengths. The blade on the driver’s side is longer 5. Move the right steering wheel lever up and
than the one on the passenger side. hold it for at least 1 second. The wipers will
then move to the vertical (service) position
Service position
on the windshield.
The wipers can be returned to the normal posi-
tion by briefly switching on the ignition (or by
starting the engine).

Replacing the windshield wiper blades

Wiper blades in service position


The wiper blades must be in the vertical (serv- With the wipers in the service position, fold
ice) position for replacement, washing or to lift out the wiper arm from the windshield.
them away from the windshield when e.g., Press the button on the wiper blade attach-
removing ice or snow. To put them in this posi- ment and pull the wiper blade straight out,
tion: parallel with the wiper arm.
1. While sitting in the driver's seat, close the Slide in the new wiper blade until it clicks
driver's door. into place.
2. Insert the remote key in the ignition slot1 Check that the blade is securely in place.
08
3. Put the ignition in mode II (see page 81).

1 Not necessary on vehicles with the optional keyless drive.


``

315
08 Maintenance and specifications

Wiper blades and washer fluid

Cleaning Filling washer fluid


Keeping the windshield and wiper blades clean
helps improve visibility and prolongs the serv-
ice life of the wiper blades. Clean the wiper
blades with a stiff-bristle brush and lukewarm
soap solution or car washing detergent.

Replacing the tailgate wiper blade

Location of the washer fluid reservoir


The windshield and headlight washers share a
common reservoir.
The washer fluid reservoir is located on the
G032770

driver's side of the engine compartment. Dur-


ing cold weather, the reservoir should be filled
1. Fold the wiper arm outward. with windshield washer solvent containing
antifreeze. For capacities, see page 343.
2. Grasp the inner section of wiper blade (at
the arrow).
3. Pull out the blade to release it from the
wiper arm.
4. Press the new wiper blade into place and
check that it seats securely.
08
5. Fold the wiper arm back toward the tailgate
window.

316
08 Maintenance and specifications

Battery

Warning symbols on the battery Risk of explosion • Because the battery’s starting capacity
decreases with time, it may be necessary
Wear protective goggles. to recharge it if the vehicle is not driven for
an extended period of time or if the vehicle
is usually only driven short distances.
Recycle properly • Never use a quick charger to charge the
Keep away from children. battery.

WARNING
• Never expose the battery to open flame
Avoid smoking, open flames, or electric spark.
and/or sparks. NOTE • Do not smoke near the battery.
• Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do
A used battery should be disposed of in an not allow battery fluid to contact eyes,
environmentally responsible manner. Con- skin, fabrics or painted surfaces. If con-
See the owner's manual. sult your Volvo retailer or take the battery to
a recycling station. tact occurs, flush the affected area
immediately with water. Obtain medical
help immediately if eyes are affected.
Handling
Contains corrosive acid. • Check that the battery cables are correctly NOTE
connected and tightened.
The life of the battery is shortened if it
• Never disconnect the battery when the becomes discharged repeatedly.
engine is running (for example, when
replacing the battery).
• If the battery is fully discharged a number
of times, this may shorten its service life.
• The service life of a battery is affected by 08
factors such as driving conditions and cli-
mate. Extreme cold may also further
decrease the battery’s starting capacity.

``

317
08 Maintenance and specifications

Battery

Maintenance mate. Extreme cold may also further


• Use a screw driver to open the caps or decrease the battery’s starting capacity.
cover and a flashlight to inspect the level. • Because the battery’s starting capacity
• If necessary, add distilled water. The level decreases with time, it may be necessary
should never be above the indicator. to recharge it if the vehicle is not driven for
an extended period of time or if the vehicle
• The fluid level should be checked if the is usually only driven short distances.
battery has been recharged.
• After inspection, be sure the cap over each CAUTION
battery cell or the cover is securely in
place. • Always use distilled or deionized water
(battery water).
• Check that the battery cables are correctly
connected and properly tightened. • Never fill above the level mark in the cell.
• Never disconnect the battery when the
engine is running, or when the key is in the
ignition. This could damage the vehicle's
Changing
electrical system.
• The battery should be disconnected from
the vehicle when a battery charger is used
directly on the battery.
• To help keep the battery in good condition,
the vehicle should be driven for at least 15
minutes a week or connected to a charger
with an automatic charging function.
• If the battery is fully discharged a number
of times, this may shorten its service life.
Keeping the battery fully charged helps
prolong its service life.
08
• The service life of a battery is affected by
factors such as driving conditions and cli-

318
08 Maintenance and specifications

Battery

Detach the ventilation hose from the 3. Screw in the battery with the screw in the
battery clamp.

Loosen the screw holding the battery 4. Connect the ventilation hose.
clamp. 5. Connect the red positive cable.
Move the battery to the side and lift it up. 6. Connect the black negative cable.
7. Press in the rear cover. (See Removal).
WARNING 8. Reinstall the cold section moulding. (See
PROPOSITION 65 WARNING! Removal).
WARNING Battery posts, terminals, and related acces- 9. Reinstall the front cover and secure it with
sories contain lead and lead compounds, the clips. (See Removal).
Connect and disconnect the positive and
chemicals known to the state of California
negative cables in the correct sequence.
to cause cancer and reproductive harm.
Wash hands after handling.
Removal
Switch off the ignition and wait at least Installation
5 minutes before disconnecting the battery so 1. Lower the battery into the battery box.
that all information in the vehicle's electrical
system can be stored in the control modules.
Open the clips on the front cover and
remove the cover.
Release the rubber moulding so that the
rear cover is free.
Remove the rear cover by pulling it away.

Detach the black negative cable.


2. Move the battery inward and to the side 08
Detach the red positive cable
until it reaches the rear edge of the box.

319
08 Maintenance and specifications

Fuses

Replacing fuses Location of the fuse boxes


There are relay/fuse boxes located in the
engine compartment, the passenger compart-
ment, and the cargo area.
If an electrical component fails to function, this
may be due to a blown fuse. The easiest way
to see if a fuse is blown is to remove it.
To do so:
1. Pull the fuse straight out. If a fuse is difficult
to remove, a special fuse removal tool is
located on the inside of the engine com-
partment fuse box cover.
2. From the side, examine the curved metal Under the glove compartment
wire in the fuse to see if it is intact. Under the glove compartment
If the wire is broken, insert a new fuse of the
Cargo area
same color and amperage (written on the fuse).
If fuses burn out repeatedly, have the electrical Engine compartment
system inspected by a trained and qualified
Volvo service technician.

WARNING
Never use metal objects or fuses with higher
amperage than those stated on the follow-
ing pages. Doing so could seriously damage
or overload the vehicle's electrical system.
08

320
08 Maintenance and specifications

Fuses

Engine compartment

08

``

321
08 Maintenance and specifications

Fuses

Engine compartment, upper Pos Function A Pos Function A


Engine compartment, front
Circuit breaker 60 Engine Control Module 10
Engine compartment, lower (ECM), transmission, SRS

Heated washer nozzles* 10
Positions

These fuses are all located in the engine com- Vacuum pump I5T 5
partment box. Fuses in are located under Headlight washers* 20
. Lighting panel 5
Windshield wipers 30
-
NOTE

• Fuses 16 – 33 and 35 – 41 may be -
changed at any time when necessary. Climate system blower 40
• Fuses 1 – 15, 34 and 42 – 44 are relays/ -
circuit breakers and should only be –
removed or replaced by a trained and Engine compartment box 5
qualified Volvo service technician. ABS pump 40
Auxiliary lights* 20
• There is a special fuse removal tool on
ABS valves 20
the underside of the cover. Horn 15

Engine Control Module 10
Pos Function A Active Bending Lights- 10 (ECM)
Circuit breaker 50 headlight leveling*
Control module, automatic 15
Central electrical module 20 transmission
Circuit breaker 50
ABS 15 feed 5 Compressor A/C 15
08
Circuit breaker 60
Speed-dependent steering 5 Relay coils 5
Circuit breaker 60
force*

322 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


08 Maintenance and specifications

Fuses

Pos Function A
Starter motor relay 30

Ignition coils 20

Engine Control Module 10


(ECM), throttle

Injection system 15

Engine valves 10

EVAP/heated oxygen sen- 15


sor/Injection

Crank case ventilation 20


heater

Fuel leakage detection 5

Cooling fan 80

Electro-hydraulic power 100


steering

08

``

323
08 Maintenance and specifications

Fuses

Under the glove compartment

Fold aside the upholstery covering the fuse Pos Function A Pos Function A
boxes.
1. Press the cover's lock and fold it up. - Controls in right rear pas- 20
senger's door
2. The fuses are accessible. -
Controls in left rear pas- 20
Positions-fuse box A - senger's door
Pos Function A Keyless drive* 20
12-volt socket (cargo area) 15
Circuit breaker - audio sys- 40
tem, subwoofer* Controls in driver's door 20 Power driver's seat* 20

08 - Controls in front passeng- 20 Power front passenger's 20


er's door seat*
-

324 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


08 Maintenance and specifications

Fuses

Pos Function A Pos Function A Pos Function A


Folding rear seat head 15 Heated rear passenger's 15 Steering wheel module 7.5
restraints* seat (left)*
Cental locking: fuel filler 10
- Park assist*, Volvo Naviga- 5 door/trunk lid
tion System*, Park assist
Audio system, Navigation 10 camera* Tailgate window washer 15
system display*
All Wheel Drive* control 5 Windshield washer 15
Audio system 15 module
Tailgate unlock 10
Bluetooth hands-free sys- 5 Active chassis system* 10
tem Tailgate lock 10
Positions-fuse box B
- Fuel pump 20
Pos Function A
Laminated panoramic roof* 5 Remote key receiver, Alarm 5
Tailgate wiper 15
Courtesy lighting movement sensor*, Climate
- system
Climate system sensor
-
12-volt sockets 15 Front courtesy lighting, 7.5
power seat(s)* Alarm, On-board diagnos- 5
Heated front passenger's 15 tic system
seat* Instrument panel informa- 5
tion display -
Heated driver's seat* 15
Adaptive cruise control/ 10
Airbag system, Occupant 10
- collision warning*
weight system
Courtesy lighting, rain sen- 7.5 08
Heated rear passenger's 15 Adaptive cruise control 5
seat (right)* sor*
front radar*

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 325


08 Maintenance and specifications

Fuses

Pos Function A
Accelerator pedal, Power 7.5
door mirrors, Heated rear
seats*

Brake lights 5

Laminated panoramic roof* 20

Immobilizer 5

08

326 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


08 Maintenance and specifications

Fuses

Cargo area

Located behind the upholstery on the left side of the cargo area

Positions Pos Rear fuse box A Pos Rear fuse box A


Pos Rear fuse box A
- Trailer socket 1* 40
Electric parking brake (left 30
side) - -

Electric parking brake (right 30 -


side)
-
Heated rear window 30
-
Trailer socket 2* 15 08

Power tailgate* 30

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 327


08 Maintenance and specifications

Vehicle care

Washing the car considerably and also helps prolong the CAUTION
The following points should be kept in mind service life of the wiper blades.
when washing and cleaning the car: • Wash off the dirt from the underside (wheel • During high pressure washing, the
spray mouthpiece must never be closer
housings, fenders, etc).
• The car should be washed at regular inter- to the vehicle than 13" (30 cm). Do not
vals since dirt, dust, insects and tar spots • In areas of high industrial fallout, more fre- spray into the locks.
adhere to the paint and may cause dam- quent washing is recommended.
• Dirt, snow, etc., on the headlights can
age. To help prevent corrosion, it is partic- reduce lighting capacity considerably.
ularly important to wash the car frequently NOTE Clean the headlights regularly, for
in the wintertime. example when refueling.
When washing the car, remember to remove
• Avoid washing your car in direct sunlight. dirt from the drain holes in the doors and Special laminated panoramic roof cau-
Doing so may cause detergents and wax sills. tions:
to dry out and become abrasive. To avoid
scratching, use lukewarm water to soften • Always close the laminated panoramic
the dirt before you wash with a soft roof and sun shade before washing your
sponge, and plenty of sudsy water. vehicle.

• Bird droppings: Remove from paintwork • Never use abrasive cleaning agents on
as soon as possible. Otherwise the finish the laminated panoramic roof.
may be permanently damaged. • Never use wax on the rubber seals
around the laminated panoramic roof.
• A detergent can be used to facilitate the
softening of dirt and oil.
• Dry the car with a clean chamois and Exterior components
remember to clean the drain holes in the Volvo recommends the use of special cleaning
doors and rocker panels. products, available at your Volvo retailer, for
• Tar spots can be removed with tar remover cleaning colored plastic, rubber, or ornamental
after the car has been washed. components such as chromed strips on the
exterior of your vehicle. The instructions for
• A stiff-bristle brush and lukewarm soapy using these products should be followed care-
water can be used to clean the wiper
08 fully. Solvents or stain removers should not be
blades. Frequent cleaning of the wind-
used.
shield and wiper blades improves visibility

328
08 Maintenance and specifications

Vehicle care

CAUTION CAUTION mal and the lights are designed to withstand


moisture. Normally, condensation will dissi-
• Avoid waxing or polishing plastic or rub- • Before driving into an automatic car pate after the lights have been on for a short
ber components wash, turn off the optional rain sensor to time.
• Polishing chromed strips can wear avoid damaging the windshield wipers.
away or damage the surface • Make sure that side view mirrors, auxil-
Polishing and waxing
• Polishes containing abrasive sub- iary lamps, etc, are secure, and that any
stances should not be used antenna(s) are retracted or removed. • Normally, polishing is not required during
Otherwise there is risk of the machine the first year after delivery, however, wax-
dislodging them. ing may be beneficial.
Automatic car wash • Before applying polish or wax the vehicle
• Chromed wheels: Clean chrome-
• We do NOT recommend washing your car plated wheels using the same deter- must be washed and dried. Tar spots can
in an automatic wash during the first few gents used for the body of the vehicle. be removed with kerosene or tar remover.
months (because the paint will not have Aggressive wheel-cleaning agents can Difficult spots may require a fine rubbing
hardened sufficiently). permanently stain chrome-plated compound.
• An automatic wash is a simple and quick wheels. • After polishing use liquid or paste wax.
way to clean your car, but it is worth
remembering that it may not be as thor-
• Several commercially available products
WARNING contain both polish and wax.
ough as when you yourself go over the car
with sponge and water. Keeping the under- • Waxing alone does not substitute for pol-
body clean is most important, especially in
• When the vehicle is driven immediately ishing a dull surface.
after being washed, apply the brakes,
the winter. Some automatic washers do including the parking brake, several • A wide range of polymer-based waxes can
not have facilities for washing the under- times in order to remove any moisture be purchased today. These waxes are easy
body. from the brake linings. to use and produce a long-lasting, high-
gloss finish that protects the bodywork
• Engine cleaning agents should not be against oxidation, road dirt and fading.
used when the engine is warm. This
constitutes a fire risk. • Do not polish or wax your vehicle in direct
sunlight (the surface of the vehicle should
not be warmer than 113 °F (45 °C).
Exterior lighting 08
Condensation may form temporarily on the
inside of the lenses of exterior lights such as
headlights, fog lights, or taillights. This is nor-
``

329
08 Maintenance and specifications

Vehicle care

CAUTION sunlight, grease and dirt can break down the 4. Dry the stain with soft paper towels or a
protection. Staining, cracking, scuffing, and towel, and allow the leather to dry com-
Volvo does not recommend the use of long- fading can result. pletely.
life or durable paint protection coatings,
some of which may claim to prevent pitting, Volvo offers an easy-to-use, non-greasy Protecting leather upholstery
fading, oxidation, etc. These coatings have leather care kit formulated to clean and beau- 1. Put a small amount of protectant cream on
not been tested by Volvo for compatibility tify your vehicle's leather, and to renew the a cloth and apply a thin coating of cream
with your vehicle's clear coat. Some of them protective qualities of its finish. The cleaner to the upholstery with light circular move-
may cause the clear coat to soften, crack, ments.
removes dirt and oil buildup. The light cream
or cloud. Damage caused by application of
paint protection coatings may not be cov- protectant restores a barrier against soil and 2. Allow the leather to dry for 20 minutes.
ered under your vehicle's paint warranty. sunlight.
This will help the leather resist staining and
Volvo also offers a special leather softener that protect against sunlight's harmful UV rays.
should be applied after the cleaner and pro-
Cleaning the interior tectant. It leaves leather soft and smooth, and
Only use cleaning agents and car care prod- reduces friction between leather and other fin-
ucts recommended by Volvo. Clean regularly ishes in the vehicle.
and follow the instructions included with the
car care product. Volvo recommends cleaning, protecting and
conditioning your vehicle's leather two to four
Upholstery care times a year. Ask your Volvo retailer about
Leather Care Kit 951 0251 and Leather Soft-
Fabric
ener 943 7429.
Clean with soapy water or a detergent. For
more difficult spots caused by oil, ice cream, Cleaning leather upholstery
shoe polish, grease, etc., use a clothing/fabric 1. Pour leather cleaner on a damp sponge
stain remover. Consult your Volvo retailer. and squeeze it until the cleaner foams.
AlcanteraTM suede-like material 2. Apply the foam to the stain by moving the
Suede-like upholstery can be cleaned with a sponge with circular movements.
soft cloth and mild soap solution. 3. Dampen the stain thoroughly with the
08 Leather care sponge. Let the sponge absorb the stain,
Volvo's leather upholstery is manufactured do not rub.
with a protectant to repel soiling. Over time,

330
08 Maintenance and specifications

Vehicle care

CAUTION gent. For best protection in winter, Volvo rec- Paint repairs require special equipment and
ommends the use of Volvo rubber floor mats. skill. Contact your Volvo retailer for any exten-
• Under no circumstances should gaso- Consult your Volvo retailer. sive damage.
line, naphtha or similar cleaning agents
be used on the plastic or the leather Spots on interior plastic, metal, or wood Minor scratches can be repaired by using
since these can cause damage. surfaces Volvo touch-up paint.
• Take extra care when removing stains Cleaning interior plastic components should Color code
such as ink or lipstick since the coloring be done with a cleaning agent specially Make sure you have the right color. The color
can spread. designed for this purpose. Consult your Volvo code number is stated on the model plate.
• Use solvents sparingly. Too much sol- retailer.
vent can damage the seat padding. Minor stone chips and scratches
• Start from the outside of the stain and Touching up paintwork Material:
work toward the center. • Primer – can
• Sharp objects (e.g. pencils or pens in a • Paint – touch-up pen
pocket) or Velcro fasteners on clothing
may damage the textile upholstery.
• Brush

• Clothing that is not colorfast, such as


• Masking tape
new jeans or suede garments, may stain If the stone chip has not gone down to the bare
the upholstery. metal and an undamaged color coat remains,
you can add paint immediately after removing
dirt.
Cleaning the seat belts
Clean only with lukewarm water and a mild
soap solution. NOTE
When touching up the vehicle, it should be
Cleaning floor mats Paint code on the model plate1 clean and dry. The surface temperature
The floor mats should be vacuumed or brushed Paint damage requires immediate attention to should be above 60 °F (15 °C).
clean regularly, especially during winter when avoid rusting. Make it a habit to check the finish
they should be taken out for drying. Spots on regularly, for instance washing the vehicle. 08
textile mats can be removed with a mild deter- Touch-up if necessary.

1 see page 336 for the location of the model plate.


``

331
08 Maintenance and specifications

Vehicle care

Minor scratches on the surface 4. If there is a longer scratch, you may want
If the stone chip has not penetrated down to to protect surrounding paint by masking it
the metal and an undamaged layer of paint off
remains, the touch-up paint can be applied as 5. After a few days, polish the touched-up
soon as the spot has been cleaned. areas. Use a soft rag and a small amount
of polish.
Repairing stone chips

G021832

1. Place a strip of masking tape over the dam-


aged surface. Pull the tape off so that any
loose flakes of paint adhere to it.
2. Thoroughly mix the primer and apply it with
a small brush.
3. When the primer surface is dry, the paint
can be applied using a brush. Mix the paint
08 thoroughly; apply several thin paint coats
and let dry after each application.

332
08 Maintenance and specifications

08

333
Label information.................................................................................. 336
Specifications........................................................................................ 338
Overview of information and warning symbols..................................... 345
Volvo programs..................................................................................... 348

334
SPECIFICATIONS
09 Specifications

09 Label information

Location of labels

336
09 Specifications

Label information 09

List of labels Vehicle Identification Number


Model (VIN). The VIN plate is located on the top
plate. Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). left surface of the dashboard. The Vehicle
Codes for color and upholstery, etc. The Identification Number (VIN) should always
model plate is located on the rear side of be quoted in all correspondence concern-
the B-pillar (the pillar between the front and ing your vehicle with the retailer and when
rear passenger doors) and the rear pas- ordering parts.
senger's door must be open in order to see Vehicle Emission Control Information.
it. Your Volvo is designed to meet all appli-
Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards cable emission standards, as evidenced by
(FMVSS) specifications (USA) and Min- the certification label on the underside of
istry of Transport (CMVSS) standards the hood. For further information regarding
(Canada). Your Volvo is designed to meet these regulations, please consult your
all applicable safety standards, as evi- Volvo retailer.
denced by the certification label on the
driver's side B-pillar (the structural mem-
ber at the side of the vehicle, at the rear of
the driver's door opening). For further infor-
mation regarding these regulations, please
consult your Volvo retailer.
Tire inflation
pressures. This label indicates the correct
inflation pressures for the tires that were on
the vehicle when it left the factory. Cana-
dian models have the upper decal; U.S.
models have the lower one.

337
09 Specifications

09 Specifications

Dimensions

Dimension In. (mm)


A Wheelbase 109.2 (2774)

B Length 182.2 (4628)

C Load length, floor, seatback down 70.4 (1789)

D Load length, floor 38.3 (972)

E Height 67.4 (1713)

F Load height 31.6 (802)

G Track, front 64.3 (1632)

338
09 Specifications

Specifications 09

Dimension In. (mm)


H Track, rear 62.4 (1586)

I Load width, floor 42.9 (1090)

J Width 74.4 (1891)

K Width, incl. door mirrors 84.3 (2142)

Weights
Category USA Canada
Gross vehicle weight 6-cyl. FWDA: 5200 lbs 6-cyl. FWD: 2360 kg
6-cyl. AWDB: 5355 lbs 6-cyl. AWD:2430 kg
6-cyl. turbo AWD: 5380 lbs 6-cyl. turbo AWD:2440 kg

Capacity weight 950 lbs (all models) 430 kg (all models

Permissible axle weights, front 6-cyl. FWD: 2740 lbs 6-cyl. FWD: 1245 kg
6-cyl. AWD: 2800 lbs 6-cyl. AWD:1270 kg
6-cyl. turbo AWD: 2840 lbs 6-cyl. turbo AWD:1290 kg

Permissible axle weights, rear 6-cyl. FWD: 2545 lbs 6-cyl. FWD: 1155 kg
6-cyl. AWD: 2640 lbs 6-cyl. AWD:1200 kg
6-cyl. turbo AWD: 2645 lbs 6-cyl. turbo AWD:1200 kg

Curb weight 3900 - 4140 lbs 1770 – 1900 kg

Max. roof load 220 lbs 100 kg

``

339
09 Specifications

09 Specifications

Category USA Canada


Max. trailer weights Without brakes: 1650 lbs Without brakes: 750 kg
With brakes, 1 7/8” ball: 2,000 lbs With brakes, 1 7/8” ball: 900 kg
With brakes, 2” ball: 3,300 lbs With brakes, 2” ball: 1500 kg

Max. tongue weight 165 lbs 75 kg


A FWD = Front Wheel Drive
B AWD = All Wheel Drive

Engine specifications
Specification/Model 3.2 6-cyl. 3.2 6-cyl. 3.0TA
Engine designation B6324S5 B6324S4 B6304T4

Output (kW/rps) 179/107 171/108 224/93

Output (hp/rpm) 240/6400 230/6500 300/5600

Torque (Nm/rps) 320/53 300/55 440/35 – 70

Torque (ft. lbs./rpm) 236/3200 221/3300 325/2100 – 4200

No. of cylinders 6 6 6

Bore (in/mm) 3.3/84 3.3/84 3.23/82

Stroke (in/mm) 3.78/96 3.78/96 3.67/93.2

340
09 Specifications

Specifications 09

Specification/Model 3.2 6-cyl. 3.2 6-cyl. 3.0TA


Displacement 3.19 liters (194.8 cu. in.) 3.19 liters (194.8 cu. in.) 2.95 liters (175 cu. in.)

Compression ratio 10.8:1 10.3:1 9.3:1


A This engine may not be available on all markets

``

341
09 Specifications

09 Specifications

Engine oil good fuel economy and engine protection. See American Petroleum Institute (API)
Engine oil must meet the minimum ILSAC the viscosity chart. symbol
specification GF-4, API SL, or ACEA A1/B1.
Lower quality oils may not offer the same fuel
economy, engine performance, or engine pro-
tection.
Volvo recommends Castrol.
Depending on your driving habits, premium or
synthetic oils may provide superior fuel econ-
omy and engine protection. Consult your Volvo
retailer for recommendations on premium or

G022917
synthetic oils.

G023491
Oil additives must not be used.
Viscosity chart The API Service Symbol "donut" is divided into
Synthetic oil is not used when the oil is
changed at the normal maintenance services. Extreme engine operation three parts:
This oil is only used at customer request, at Synthetic oils meeting SAE 0W-30 or 0W-40 • The upper section describes the oil's per-
additional charge. Please consult your Volvo and complying with oil quality requirements are formance level.
retailer. recommended for driving in areas of sustained
temperature extremes (hot or cold), when tow-
• The center identifies the oil's viscosity.
Oil viscosity ing a trailer over long distances, and for pro- • The lower section indicates whether the oil
Incorrect viscosity oil can shorten engine life longed driving in mountainous areas. has demonstrated energy-conserving
under normal use. SAE 5W-30 will provide properties in a standard test in comparison
to a reference oil.

342
09 Specifications

Specifications 09

Oil volume
Engine model Volume (incl. filter)
3.2 (6-cyl.) B6324S4/S5 7.18 US qts (6.8 liters)

3.0T (6 cyl.) B6304T4 7.18 US qts (6.8 liters)

Other fluids and lubricants


Fluid System Volume Specification
Transmission oilA Automatic (TF-80SC) 7.4 US qts (7 liters) Transmission fluid AW-1

Coolant 3.2 (6-cyl.) 9.4 US qts. (8.9 liters) Coolant with corrosion inhibitor
mixed with water (50/50 mix), see
3.0T 9.4 US qts. (8.9 liters) packaging.

Air conditioning All models 1.7 lbs (770 g) Refrigerant: R134a (HFC134a),
PAG oil

Brake fluid 0.63 US qts (0.6 liters) DOT 4+

Power steering 1.26 US qts (1.2 liters) Power steering fluid WSS
M2C204-A2 or equivalent product.

Washer fluid 6.8 US qts (6.5 liters) Use a washer antifreeze recom-
mended by Volvo, mixed with
4.7 US qts (4.5 litersB)
water.

Fuel tank volume 3.0T/3.2 6 cyl. 18.5 US gallons (70 liters)


A Under normal driving conditions the transmission oil does not need changing during its service life. However, it may be necessary under adverse driving conditions.
B Models without headlight washers

``

343
09 Specifications

09 Specifications

Electrical system
General information
12 volt system with a voltage-regulated alter-
nator. Single pole system in which the chassis
and engine block are used as conductors. The
negative terminal is connected to the chassis.

Performance, battery
Engine 3.2 6-cyl./3.0T

Voltage (V) 12

Cold start capacity (A) 520 – 700

Reserve capacity (min) 100 – 135

WARNING
PROPOSITION 65 WARNING!
Battery posts, terminals, and related acces-
sories contain lead and lead compounds,
chemicals known to the state of California
to cause cancer and reproductive harm.
Wash hands after handling.

CAUTION
If the battery is replaced, replace it with a
battery of the same cold start capacity and
reserve capacity as the original (see the
decal on the battery).

344
09 Specifications

Overview of information and warning symbols 09

Introduction Symbols in the main instrument panel Indicator symbols


The symbols in the vehicle's various displays Symbol Description P.
Warning symbols
are divided into three main categories:
Symbol Description P. no.
• Warning symbols
• Indicator symbols no. Fault in the Active 77
Bending Light
• Information symbols Low oil pressure 78 (ABL)*system
The following tables list the most common
symbols, their meaning and the pages in this Parking brake 78 Malfunction indicator 77
manual that provide more detailed information. light
A
Warning symbol A

The red warning symbol lights up to Anti-lock brake sys- 77


SRS airbags 78
indicate a problem related to safety and/or tem (ABS)
drivability. A message will also appear in the
A
main instruments panel's display. Seat belt reminder 79

Information symbol Rear fog light on 77


Generator not charg- 79
The information symbol lights up and a ing
text message is displayed to provide the driver Stability system 77
with necessary information about one of the Fault in the brake sys- 79 (DSTC), Hill Descent
vehicle's systems. tem Control, Trailer Stabil-
A
ity Assist*

Tire pressure monitor- 77


Warning symbol 79 ing sensor (TPMS)

A Canadian models Low fuel level 77

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 345


09 Specifications

09 Overview of information and warning symbols

Symbol Description P. Symbol Description P. Symbol Description P.


no. no. no.
Information symbol, 77 Adaptive Cruise Con- 151, Collision Warning with 173
see text in information trol *, Distance Alert* 157, Full Auto-brake and
display 159 Pedestrian Detection*

High beam indicator 76 Adaptive Cruise Con- 151, Driver Alert System* 175
trol * 157
Left turn signal indica- 76
tor
Adaptive Cruise Con- 151, Active Bending Lights 90
Right turn signal indi- 76 trol *, Distance Alert* 157, (ABL)*
cator 159
A Canadian models Adaptive Cruise Con- 151, Fuel filler door (arrow 76
trol *, Distance Alert* 157, indicates it is on right
Other information symbols 159 side of vehicle)
Symbol Description P.
Adaptive Cruise Con- 151, Rain sensor* 95
no. trol* 157
Adaptive Cruise Con- 151, Driver Alert System* 176
trol * 157
Radar sensor* 155
Adaptive Cruise Con- 151,
trol * 157 Driver Alert System*, 178
Lane Departure Warn-
Adaptive Cruise Con- 151, Camera* 171 ing*
trol *, Distance Alert* 157,
159 Laser sensor*

346 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


09 Specifications

Overview of information and warning symbols 09

Symbol Description P. Information symbols in the ceiling


console
no.
Symbol Description P.
Driver Alert System*, 178
no.
Lane Departure Warn-
ing* Seat belt reminder 19
Adaptive Cruise Con- 151,
trol * 157 Occupant Weight 26
Sensor
Information symbols in the center
console display
Symbol Description P.
no.
Audio files 219

CD folder 219

Video files 219

Bluetooth-connected 230
cell phone

BluetoothTM hands- 230


free

HD radio

Park Assist* 181

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 347


09 Specifications

09 Volvo programs

Volvo On Call Roadside Assistance


Your new Volvo comes with a four year ON
CALL roadside assistance. Additional informa-
tion, features, and benefits are described in a
separate information package in your glove
compartment.
If you require assistance, dial:
In the U.S. 1-800-638-6586 (1-800-63-
VOLVO)
In Canada 1-800-263-0475

Technician certification
In addition to Volvo factory training, Volvo sup-
ports certification by the National Institute for
Automotive Service Excellence (A.S.E.). Certi-
fied technicians have demonstrated a high
degree of competence in specific areas.
Besides passing exams, each technician must
also have worked in the field for two or more
years before a certificate is issued. These pro-
fessional technicians are best able to analyze
vehicle problems and perform the necessary
maintenance procedures to keep your Volvo at
peak operating condition.

348
09 Specifications

09

349
10 Index

1, 2, 3 ... Anti-lock brake system oil........................................................ 343


warning light......................................... 76 shiftlock override................................ 113
10
12-volt sockets........................................ 195 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)................. 116 Axle weight.............................................. 280
Approach lighting................................ 58, 93

A Audio system
AUX/USB sockets............................... 223 B
ABS (anti-lock brake system).................. 116 BluetoothŸ devices............................. 226
Battery
BluetoothŸ hands-free system........... 229
Accessory installation warning.................. 13 changing..................................... 318, 319
Bluetooth streaming audio................. 226
Active chassis system............................. 146 maintenance....................................... 318
general functions................................ 207
remote key, replacing........................... 61
Active yaw control................................... 144 getting started.................................... 202
specifications...................................... 344
Adaptive brake lights............................... 115 HD digital radio................................... 212
warning symbols................................. 317
introduction......................................... 200
Adaptive cruise control.................... 149, 151 Black box................................................... 11
media player....................................... 219
Airbags menus................................................. 241 Blind Spot Information System
disconnecting the front passenger’s overview.............................................. 200 (BLIS)....................................... 189, 190, 191
side................................................. 26, 27 radio functions.................................... 210 Bluetooth cell phone connection............. 229
front...................................................... 22 Sirius satellite radio............................ 214
inflatable curtain................................... 32 Booster cushion, integrated...................... 49
sound settings.................................... 208
side impact........................................... 30 steering wheel keypad........................ 205 Booster cushions....................................... 45
Air conditioning........................................ 139 voice control....................................... 237 Brake lights.............................................. 115
Air distribution.......................................... 135 Auto-dim rearview mirror......................... 101 Brake system
Air distribution table................................. 141 Automatic locking retractor....................... 38 ABS..................................................... 116
checking fluid level............................. 306
Air vents................................................... 136 Automatic transmission
emergency brake assistance.............. 116
All Wheel Drive......................................... 114 Geartronic................................... 112, 113
fluid..................................................... 343
general description..................... 112, 113
Anti-freeze....................................... 248, 306 general information............................. 115

350
10 Index

Hill Descent Control............................ 121 Check engine light..................................... 76 Compass in rearview mirror..................... 102
warning light......................................... 78 Child restraints Conserving electrical current................... 247 10
Bulbs recalls and registration......................... 48 Controls, center console.......................... 241
cargo area lighting.............................. 313 Child restraint systems.............................. 39 Convertible seats....................................... 43
headlights........................... 308, 309, 310 booster cushions.................................. 45
introduction......................................... 308 Coolant............................................ 306, 343
convertible seats.................................. 43
license plate lights.............................. 313 infant seats........................................... 41 Cooling system, general information....... 247
side marker lights............................... 311 ISOFIX/LATCH anchors........................ 46 Courtesy lighting.................................. 92, 93
specifications...................................... 314 top tether anchors................................ 47 Crash mode............................................... 36
taillight................................................ 312
Child safety.......................................... 37, 38 Cruise control.................................. 147, 148
booster cushions.................................. 45 adaptive.............................................. 149
child restraint systems.......................... 39
C convertible seats.................................. 43
Curb weight............................................. 280
infant seats........................................... 41 Current, conserving................................. 247
Camera, Park Assist................................ 185
Child safety locks...................................... 52
Capacity weight....................................... 280
City Safety™............................................ 162
Cargo area
Climate system........................................ 139
D
changing bulbs................................... 313
steel grid............................................. 259 air distribution............................. 135, 141 Defroster.................................................. 139
air vents.............................................. 136
Cargo area cover..................................... 259 Detachable key blade................................ 60
Interior Air Quality System.................. 135
Cargo area net......................................... 260 introduction......................................... 134 Dimensions.............................................. 338
Catalytic converter................................... 253 passenger compartment filter............ 134 Disconnecting the front passenger’s air-
refrigerant........................................... 134 bag....................................................... 26, 27
Cell phone, hands-free connection......... 229
Clock, setting............................................. 80 Dome lighting....................................... 92, 93
Cell phone voice control.......................... 237
Cold weather driving................................ 248 Door mirrors............................................. 100
Central locking system, introduction......... 56
Collision warning system................. 168, 169 Driver alert............................................... 175
Chains...................................................... 283

351
10 Index

Driver distraction warning.......................... 13 Engine oil Fuel requirements............................ 250, 251


Driving economically................................ 246 checking............................................. 304 Fuel tank volume..................................... 343
10
low pressure warning light.............. 77, 78
Driving in cold weather............................ 248 Fuses............................... 320, 321, 324, 327
specifications...................................... 342
Driving through water.............................. 247 volumes.............................................. 343

G
Environment............................................... 12

E
Eyelets for anchoring loads..................... 257
Gasoline requirements............................. 251
ECC................................................. 139, 140 Gas tank volume...................................... 343
Economical driving.................................. 246 F Gauges...................................................... 75
Electric parking brake.............................. 118 Federal Clean Air Act............................... 300 Geartronic................................................ 113
Electronic Climate Control....... 137, 139, 140 Fluid specifications.................................. 343 Geartronic automatic transmission.. 112, 113
air distribution table............................ 141 Generator warning light............................. 78
Fog lights
Interior Air Quality System.................. 140
front/rear............................................... 91 Glossary of tire terminology..................... 279
Emergency locking retractor...................... 38 rear...................................................... 312 Grocery bag holder.................................. 257
Emergency starting.................................. 110 Four C (active chassis system)................ 146 Gross vehicle weight............................... 280
Emergency towing........................... 265, 266 Front airbags.............................................. 22
Emission inspection readiness................ 301 disconnecting passenger’s side air-
Engine bag.................................................. 26, 27
H
overheating........................................... 79 Front park assist.............................. 181, 183
specifications...................................... 340 Hazard warning flashers............................ 91
Front seats........................................... 82, 84
starting................................................ 109 HD digital radio........................................ 212
Fuel filler cap........................................... 253
switching off....................................... 110 Headlights
Fuel filler door, opening........................... 252
Engine compartment overview................ 303 Active Bending Lights........................... 90
Fuel level warning light.............................. 77 changing bulbs........................... 309, 310
Engine Drag Control (EDC)...................... 144

352
10 Index

high/low beams.................................... 89 Inflation pressure tables.................. 275, 276 J


high beam flash.................................... 89 Information and warning symbols, table 10
Headlight washers..................................... 96 of.............................................................. 345 Jack
attaching............................................. 291
Head restraints, rear seat.......................... 85 Information lights..................... 75, 76, 77, 78
location of........................................... 291
Heated oxygen sensors........................... 254 Information symbol.................................... 77
Jump starting........................................... 110
Heated rear seats.................................... 138 Infotainment system................................ 200
High beams................................................ 89 AUX/USB sockets............................... 223
indicator light........................................ 77 BluetoothŸ devices.............................
Bluetooth® hands-free system...........
226
229
K
Hill Descent Control................................. 121
general functions................................ 207 Key blade....................................... 56, 60, 63
Hoisting the vehicle................................. 301 getting started.................................... 202
Keyless drive
Home safe lighting..................................... 93 media player....................................... 219
general description............................... 63
Hood, opening/closing............................ 303 menus................................................. 241
starting the vehicle............................. 109
radio functions.................................... 210
Horn........................................................... 88
sound settings.................................... 208
voice control....................................... 237
L
I Inspection readiness................................ 301
Instrument lighting..................................... 89 Labels
Ignition modes........................................... 81 Instrument overview............................ 74, 75 list of................................................... 337
Immobilizer................................................ 57 location of........................................... 336
Instrument panel...................................... 126
Important information.................................. 8 Laminated panoramic roof...................... 103
Integrated two-stage booster cushion...... 49
Indicator lights......................... 75, 76, 77, 78 LATCH anchors......................................... 46
Interior Air Quality System....................... 135
Infant seats................................................ 41 Leather care............................................. 330
Interior lighting..................................... 92, 93
Inflatable Curtain........................................ 32 Lighting panel............................................ 89
iPodŸ connector (audio system)............. 223
Inflation pressure..................................... 273 Load anchoring eyelets........................... 257
ISOFIX/LATCH anchors............................. 46

353
10 Index

Loading the vehicle.......................... 255, 280 retractable........................................... 100 Overheating, engine................................... 79


roof loads............................................ 258 vanity.................................................. 195 Oxygen sensors, heated.......................... 254
10
Locking...................................................... 66 Motor oil
tailgate.................................................. 67 checking............................................. 304
Locking the vehicle.................................... 58 specifications...................................... 342
volumes.............................................. 343
P
Locks, child safety..................................... 52
MY CAR................................................... 128 Paint, touching up.................................... 331
Low beams................................................ 89
Park assist....................................... 181, 183
Low fuel level warning light........................ 77
Park Assist Camera................................. 185
Low oil pressure warning light................... 78 N Parking brake
electric, applying/releasing................. 118
Net in cargo area..................................... 260
warning light......................................... 78
M Parking lights............................................. 91
Main instrument panel............................. 126 O Personal Car Communicator, unique func-
Maintenance............................................ 300 tions........................................................... 59
hoisting the vehicle............................. 301 Occupant safety........................................ 16 Polishing.................................................. 329
performed by the owner..................... 301 Occupant weight sensor...................... 26, 27 Power front seat
Malfunction indicator light......................... 76 Octane recommendations....................... 251 memory function................................... 83
Media player (infotainment system)......... 219 Odometer, trip........................................... 80 with keyless drive................................. 84

Menu........................................................ 128 Oil Power mirrors.......................................... 100


checking............................................. 304 defroster............................................. 101
Messages in the instrument panel........... 126
specifications...................................... 342 Power steering
Mirrors
volumes.............................................. 343 fluid..................................................... 307
defroster............................................. 101
On Call Roadside Assistance.................. 348 speed-dependent............................... 146
power door......................................... 100
rearview, auto-dim function................ 101 Overhead courtesy lighting.................. 92, 93 Power steering fluid................................. 343

354
10 Index

Power tailgate.......................................... 255 Rear window defroster............................ 101 S


Power windows......................................... 98 Recalls, child restraints.............................. 48 10
laminated glass..................................... 99 Safety, occupant........................................ 16
Refrigerant............................................... 343
Pregnancy, using seat belts during........... 20 Safety defects, reporting........................... 17
Refueling.......................................... 250, 251
PROPOSITION 65 WARNING.. 110, 319, 344 fuel filler cap....................................... 253 Seat belt
fuel filler door...................................... 252 reminder................................................ 19
fuel tank volume................................. 343 Seat belts
R Registering child restraints........................ 48 Automatic locking retractor/Emergency
locking retractor.................................... 38
Remote key................................................ 56
Radio buckling................................................ 18
approach lighting.................................. 58
Sirius satellite radio............................ 214 maintenance......................................... 18
immobilizer........................................... 57
Radio functions........................................ 210 pretensioners........................................ 18
key blade........................................ 56, 60
HD digital radio................................... 212 reminder................................................ 18
key memory.......................................... 57
reminder warning light.......................... 78
Rain sensor................................................ 95 locking the vehicle................................ 58
securing child restraint sys-
READ button............................................ 126 Personal Car Communicator.......... 58, 59
tems.......................................... 41, 43, 45
replacing the battery............................. 61
Rear fog light..................................... 91, 312 unbuckling............................................ 18
unlocking the vehicle............................ 58
use during pregnancy........................... 20
Rear park assist............................... 181, 183
Remote key/PCC using..................................................... 18
Rear seat head restraints........................... 85 common functions................................ 58
Seats, front.......................................... 82, 83
Rear seats Reporting safety defects............................ 17
Shiftlock..................................................... 11
center head restraint............................. 85
Roadside Assistance............................... 348
folding................................................... 85 Side door mirrors..................................... 100
heated................................................. 138 Rollover Protection System (ROPS).......... 35
Side impact airbags................................... 30
Rearview mirror Roll Stability Control (RSC)........................ 35
Side marker lights, changing bulbs......... 311
auto-dim function............................... 101 Roof loads............................................... 258
Sirius satellite radio.................................. 214
compass............................................. 102
Snow chains............................................ 283

355
10 Index

Snow tires................................................ 283 Supplemental restraint system.................. 21 load ratings......................................... 274


Spare tire................................................. 284 warning light......................................... 78 rotation............................................... 271
10
Symbols, overview................................... 345 snow................................................... 283
Speed-dependent steering...................... 146
spare................................................... 284
Spin control............................................. 144 specifications...................................... 274

T
SRS............................................................ 21 speed ratings...................................... 274
Stability system....................................... 144 storing................................................. 271
Engine Drag Control (EDC)................. 144 Tailgate studded............................................... 283
indicator light........................................ 77 driving with it open............................. 246 tire pressure monitoring system......... 294
locking/unlocking.................................. 67 tread wear indicator............................ 272
Starting the engine.................................. 109
power operated.................................. 255 uniform tire quality grading................. 282
with keyless drive............................... 109
wiper/washer........................................ 96 Top tether anchors (child restraint sys-
Starting the vehicle
Tailgate wipers......................................... 316 tems).......................................................... 47
after a crash (crash mode).................... 36
Taillights, changing bulbs........................ 312 Touching up paint.................................... 331
Start inhibitor (immobilizer)........................ 57
Temporary spare tire............................... 284 Towing a trailer................................ 262, 263
Steel grid in cargo area............................ 259
trailer hitch.......................................... 263
Steering wheel Three-way catalytic converter................. 253
Towing the vehicle........................... 265, 266
adjusting............................................... 88 Tire designations..................................... 277
horn....................................................... 88 Traction control........................................ 144
Tire Pressure Monitoring System.... 294, 295
keypad.................................. 88, 128, 205 indicator light........................................ 77 Trailer towing................................... 262, 263
Stone chips, touching up......................... 331 trailer hitch.......................................... 263
Tires......................................................... 270
Storage spaces........................................ 193 age...................................................... 270 Transmission
changing from summer to winter........ 271 general description..................... 112, 113
Studded tires........................................... 283
glossary of terms................................ 279 oil........................................................ 343
Sunroof shiftlock override................................ 113
improving economy............................ 270
laminated panoramic roof................... 103
inflation pressure................................ 273 Tread wear indicator................................ 272
inflation pressure tables............. 275, 276 Trip computer.......................................... 142

356
10 Index

Trip odometers.......................................... 80 Vehicle maintenance................................ 300 Weights.................................................... 339


Trips, long distance................................. 248 performed by the owner..................... 301 Wheels..................................................... 270 10
Turn signals............................................... 92 Vehicle weights........................................ 339 changing............................................. 291
changing bulbs................................... 311 Voice control storing................................................. 271
indicator lights...................................... 77 cell phones......................................... 237 Whiplash Protection System..................... 33
Two-stage booster cushion....................... 49 Volvo and the environment........................ 12 Windows
Volvo maintenance.................................. 300 power.................................................... 98

Volvo On Call Roadside Assistance........ 348 Windshield


U Volvo programs....................................... 348
IR coating............................................. 97
rain sensor............................................ 95
Uniform Tire Quality Grading................... 282 washers................................................ 96
Unlocking the tailgate................................ 67 wipers/washers..................................... 95
Unlocking the vehicle.......................... 58, 66
W Windshield washer fluid................... 316, 343
Upholstery care....................................... 330 Warning flashers, hazard........................... 91 Windshield wipers.................................... 315
Warning lights.......................... 75, 76, 77, 78 Wiper blades
Warning symbol......................................... 79 replacing tailgate wiper...................... 316
V Warning system, collision................ 168, 169
replacing windshield wipers............... 315

Vanity mirror............................................ 195 Warranties................................................ 300


changing bulbs................................... 313 Washer fluid..................................... 316, 343
Vehicle dimensions.................................. 338 Washers
Vehicle Event Data..................................... 11 headlight............................................... 96
Vehicle loading................................ 255, 280 windshield............................................. 95
roof loads............................................ 258 Water, driving through............................. 247
Waxing..................................................... 329

357
10 Index

10

358
Kdakd8Vg8dgedgVi^dcIE&'+('JH68VcVYV!6I&%)+!Eg^ciZY^cHlZYZc!<ŽiZWdg\'%&%!8deng^\]i©'%%%"'%&%Kdakd8Vg8dgedgVi^dc

Das könnte Ihnen auch gefallen